Delta Fan/Pump Vector Control Drive CP2000 Series User Manual
Delta Fan/Pump Vector Control Drive CP2000 Series User Manual
Asia EMEA
Delta Electronics (Shanghai) Co., Ltd. Headquarters: Delta Electronics (Netherlands) B.V.
No.182 Minyu Rd., Pudong Shanghai, P.R.C. Sales: Sales.IA.EMEA@deltaww.com
Post code : 201209 Marketing: Marketing.IA.EMEA@deltaww.com
TEL: 86-21-6872-3988 / FAX: 86-21-6872-3996 Technical Support: iatechnicalsupport@deltaww.com
Customer Service: 400-820-9595 Customer Support: Customer-Support@deltaww.com
Service: Service.IA.emea@deltaww.com
Delta Electronics (Japan), Inc. TEL: +31(0)40 800 3800
Tokyo Office
Industrial Automation Sales Department BENELUX: Delta Electronics (Netherlands) B.V.
2-1-14 Shibadaimon, Minato-ku De Witbogt 20, 5652 AG Eindhoven, The Netherlands
Tokyo, Japan 105-0012 Mail: Sales.IA.Benelux@deltaww.com
TEL: 81-3-5733-1155 / FAX: 81-3-5733-1255 TEL: +31(0)40 800 3800
CP2000 Series
Samutprakarn 10280, Thailand Ufficio di Milano Via Senigallia 18/2 20161 Milano (MI)
TEL: 66-2709-2800 / FAX : 662-709-2827 Piazza Grazioli 18 00186 Roma Italy
Mail: Sales.IA.Italy@deltaww.com
Delta Energy Systems (Australia) Pty Ltd. TEL: +39 02 64672538
User Manual
Unit 20-21/45 Normanby Rd., Notting Hill Vic 3168, Australia
TEL: 61-3-9543-3720 Russia: Delta Energy System LLC
Vereyskaya Plaza II, office 112 Vereyskaya str.
Americas 17 121357 Moscow Russia
Mail: Sales.IA.RU@deltaww.com
Delta Electronics (Americas) Ltd.
TEL: +7 495 644 3240
Raleigh Office
P.O. Box 12173, 5101 Davis Drive, Turkey: Delta Greentech Elektronik San. Ltd. Sti. (Turkey)
Research Triangle Park, NC 27709, U.S.A. Şerifali Mah. Hendem Cad. Kule Sok. No:16-A
TEL: 1-919-767-3813 / FAX: 1-919-767-3969 34775 Ümraniye – İstanbul
Mail: Sales.IA.Turkey@deltaww.com
Delta Greentech (Brasil) S/A TEL: + 90 216 499 9910
São Paulo Office
Rua Itapeva, 26 – 3˚ Andar - Bela Vista GCC: Delta Energy Systems AG (Dubai BR)
CEP: 01332-000 – São Paulo – SP - Brasil P.O. Box 185668, Gate 7, 3rd Floor, Hamarain Centre
TEL: 55-11-3530-8642 / 55-11-3530-8640 Dubai, United Arab Emirates
Mail: Sales.IA.MEA@deltaww.com
Delta Electronics International Mexico S.A. de C.V. TEL: +971(0)4 2690148
Mexico Office
Vía Dr. Gustavo Baz No. 2160, Colonia La Loma, Egypt + North Africa: Delta Electronics
54060 Tlalnepantla Estado de Mexico 511 Cairo Business Plaza, North 90 street,
TEL: 52-55-2628-3015 #3050/3052 New Cairo, Cairo, Egypt
Mail: Sales.IA.MEA@deltaww.com
*We reserve the right to change the information in this manual without prior notice.
w w w. d e l t a w w. c o m
Copyright notice
©Delta Electronics, Inc. All rights reserved.
All information contained in this user manual is the exclusive property of Delta Electronics Inc.
(hereinafter referred to as "Delta ") and is protected by copyright law and all other laws. Delta retains the
exclusive rights of this user manual in accordance with the copyright law and all other laws. No parts in
this manual may be reproduced, transmitted, transcribed, translated or used in any other ways without
the prior consent of Delta.
Limitation of Liability
The contents of this user manual are only for the use of the AC motor drives manufactured by Delta. Except
as defined in special mandatory laws, Delta provides this user manual “as is” and does not offer any kind
of warranty through this user manual for using the product, either express or implied, including but not
limited to the following: (i) this product will meet your needs or expectations; (ii) the information contained
in the product is current and correct; (iii) the product does not infringe any rights of any other person. You
shall bear your own risk to use this product.
In no event shall Delta, its subsidiaries, affiliates, managers, employees, agents, partners and licensors
be liable for any direct, indirect, incidental, special, derivative or consequential damages ( including but
not limited to the damages for loss of profits, goodwill, use or other intangible losses) unless the laws
contains special mandatory provisions to the contrary.
Delta reserves the right to make changes to the user manual and the products described in the user
manual without prior notice and afterwards.
PLEASE READ PRIOR TO INSTALLATION FOR SAFETY.
Disconnect AC input power before connecting any wiring to the AC motor drive.
Even if the power has been turned off, a charge may still remain in the DC-link
capacitors with hazardous voltages before the POWER LED is OFF. Do NOT touch the
DANGER
internal circuits and components.
There are highly sensitive MOS components on the printed circuit boards. These
components are especially sensitive to static electricity. Take anti-static measure before
touching these components or the circuit boards.
Never modify the internal components or wiring.
Ground the AC motor drive by using the ground terminal. The grounding method must
comply with the laws of the country where the AC motor drive is to be installed.
Do NOT install the AC motor drive in a location with high temperature, direct sunlight or
inflammable materials or gases.
Never connect the AC motor drive output terminals U/T1, V/T2 and W/T3 directly to the
AC mains circuit power supply.
CAU TION
After finishing the wiring of the AC motor drive, check if U/T1, V/T2, and W/T3 are
short-circuited to ground with a multimeter. Do NOT power the drive if short circuits occur.
Eliminate the short circuits before the drive is powered.
The rated voltage of power system to install motor drives is listed below. Ensure that the
installation voltage is in the correct range when installing a motor drive.
1. For 230V models, the range is between 170–264V.
2. For 460V models, the range is between 323–528V.
3. For 575V models, the range is between 446–660V.
4. For 690V models, the range is between 446–759V.
Refer to the table below for short circuit rating:
Model (Power) Short circuit rating
230V / 460V 100 kA
575V (2–20HP) 5 kA
690V (25–50HP) 5 kA
690V (60–175HP) 10 kA
690V (215–335HP) 18 kA
690V (425–600HP) 30 kA
690V (745–850HP) 42 kA
Only qualified persons are allowed to install, wire and maintain the AC motor drives.
Even if the three-phase AC motor is stopped, a charge with hazardous voltages may still
remain in the main circuit terminals of the AC motor drive.
The performance of electrolytic capacitor will degrade if it is not charged for a long time. It
is recommended to charge the drive which is stored in no charge condition every 2 years
for 3–4 hours to restore the performance of electrolytic capacitor in the motor drive. Note:
When power up the motor drive, use adjustable AC power source (ex. AC
autotransformer) to charge the drive at 70%–80% of rated voltage for 30 minutes (do not
run the motor drive). Then charge the drive at 100% of rated voltage for an hour (do not
run the motor drive). By doing these, restore the performance of electrolytic capacitor
before starting to run the motor drive. Do NOT run the motor drive at 100% rated voltage
right away.
Pay attention to the following precautions when transporting and installing this package
(including wooden crate and wood stave)
1. If you need to deworm the wooden crate, do NOT use fumigation or you will damage
the drive. Any damage to the drive caused by using fumigation voids the warranty.
I
2. Use other methods, such as heat treatment or any other non-fumigation treatment, to
deworm the wood packaging material.
3. If you use heat treatment to deworm, leave the packaging materials in an environment
of over 56°C for a minimum of thirty minutes.
Connect the drive to a three-phase three-wire or three-phase four-wire Wye system to
comply with UL standards.
If the motor drive generates leakage current over AC 3.5 mA or over DC 10 mA on a
grounding conductor, compliance with local grounding regulations or IEC61800-5-1
standard is the minimum requirement for grounding.
NOTE
The content of this manual may be revised without prior notice. Please consult our distributors or download
the latest version at http://www.deltaww.com/iadownload_acmotordrive
II
Table of Contents
CHAPTER 1 INTRODUCTION ..................................................................................................................1-1
3-1 Unpacking.........................................................................................................................3-2
3-2 The Lifting Hook..............................................................................................................3-25
7-1 All Brake Resistors and Brake Units Used in AC Motor Drives................................................7-2
7-2 Magnetic Contactor / Air Circuit Breaker and Non-fuse Circuit Breaker....................................7-7
7-3 Fuse Specification Chart ....................................................................................................7-11
7-4 AC / DC Reactor..............................................................................................................7-13
7-5 Zero Phase Reactor.........................................................................................................7-56
7-6 EMC Filter.......................................................................................................................7-59
III
7-7 Panel Mounting...............................................................................................................7-72
7-8 Conduit Box Kit...............................................................................................................7-74
7-9 Fan Kit.........................................................................................................................7-89
7-10 Flange Mounting Kit ....................................................................................................7-107
7-11 Power Terminal Kit………………………………………………………………………..……7-122
7-12 USB/RS-485 Communication Interface IFD6530….........................................................7-124
IV
CHAPTER 12 DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETER SETTINGS ................................................................12-1
Issued Edition: 03
Firmware Version: V2.06
(Refer to Parameter 00-06 on the product to get the firmware version.)
Issued Date: 2019/07
VI
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Chapter 1 Introduction
1-6 Dimensions
1-1
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Figure 1-1
1-2
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
1-3
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame A–H
Service link label (Service Label) will be pasted on the upper-right corner of the side where keypad
is installed on the case body, as below drawing shown:
Figure 1-2
Figure 1-3
1-4
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
(2) In the models with built-in EMC filter the RFI jumper connects the filter capacitors to ground to form a
return path for high frequency noise to isolate the noise from contaminating the mains power.
Removing the RFI jumper strongly reduces the effect of the built-in EMC filter. Although a single drive
complies with the international standards for leakage current, an installation with several drives with
built-in EMC filter can trigger the RCD. Removing the RFI jumper helps, but the EMC performance of
each drive would be no longer guaranteed.
Frame A–C
Screw Torque: 8–10kg-cm / [6.9–8.7 lb -in.] / [0.8–1.0 Nm]
Loosen the screws and remove the MOV-PLATE. Fasten the screws back to the original position after
MOV-PLATE is removed.
Frame D0–H
Remove the MOV-PLATE by hands, no screws need to be loosen
Figure 1-6
1-5
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
1-6
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
L2
L2
L3 L3
Figure 1-9 Figure 1-10
3. Grounding at one end in a single-phase 4. No stable neutral grounding in a three-phase
configuration autotransformer configuration
L1
L1
L1
L2
L2
L3
N L3
1-7
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
1-6 Dimensions
Frame A
See Detail B
Figure 1-14
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 D1* S1 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
130.0 250.0 170.0 116.0 236.0 45.8 6.2 22.2 34.0 28.0
A
[5.12] [9.84] [6.69] [4.57] [9.29] [1.80] [0.24] [0.87] [1.34] [1.10]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-8
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame B
See
See Detail
Detail AA
See Detail
See DetailB B
Detail
DetailAA(Mounting Hole)
(Mounting Hole)
Detail
DetailBB(Mounting Hole)
(Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-15
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 D1* S1 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
190.0 320.0 190.0 173.0 303.0 77.9 8.5 22.2 34.0 43.8
B
[7.48] [12.60] [7.48] [6.81] [11.93] [3.07] [0.33] [0.87] [1.34] [1.72]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-9
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame C
See Detail
See Detail A A
See Detail
See Detail B B
Detail A A(Mounting
Detail Hole)
(Mounting Hole)
Detail B (Mounting
Detail Hole)
B (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-16
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 D1* S1 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
250.0 400.0 210.0 231.0 381.0 92.9 8.5 22.2 34.0 50.0
C [9.84] [15.75] [8.27] [9.09] [15.00] [3.66] [0.33] [0.87] [1.34] [1.97]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-10
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame D
D
W SEE
See DETAIL
Detail A A D1
W1 D2
H1
H2
H3
S2
See DETAIL
SEE Detail B B
S1 S1
DETAIL
Detail AA DETAIL
Detail B B
(MOUNTING HOLE) (MOUNTING HOLE)
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-17
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H1 D W1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1 S2
280.0 500.0 255.0 235.0 475.0 442.0 94.2 16.0 11.0 18.0
D0-1
[11.02] [19.69] [10.04] [9.25] [18.70] [17.40] [3.71] [0.63] [0.43] [0.71]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-11
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame D
H1
H2
H3
H
S2
SeeDETAIL
SEE Detail BB
2 3 3 2
1 1
S1 S1
DETAIL
Detail AA DETAIL
Detail BB
(MOUNTING HOLE) (MOUNTING HOLE)
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-18
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1 S2 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
280.0 614.4 255.0 235.0 500.0 475.0 442.0 94.2 16.0 11.0 18.0 62.7 34.0 22.0
D0-2
[11.02] [24.19] [10.04] [9.25] [19.69] [18.70] [17.40] [3.71] [0.63] [0.43] [0.71] [2.47] [1.34] [0.87]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-12
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame D
D
W SeeDETAIL
SEE Detail A
A D1
W1 D2
H1
H2
H3
S2
SeeDETAIL
SEE DetailBB
S1 S1
DETAIL A DETAIL B
Detail A
(MOUNTING HOLE)
Detail B
(MOUNTING HOLE)
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-19
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1 S2 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
330.0 275.0 285.0 550.0 525.0 492.0 107.2 16.0 11.0 18.0
D1 - - - -
[12.99] [10.83] [11.22] [21.65] [20.67] [19.37] [4.22] [0.63] [0.43] [0.71]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-13
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame D
D
W SeeDETAIL
SEE DetailAA D1
W1 D2
H1
H2
H3
H
S2
SeeDETAIL
SEE DetailBB
1 1
3 3
2 2
S1 S1
DETAIL A DETAIL B
Detail AHOLE)
(MOUNTING Detail BHOLE)
(MOUNTING
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-20
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1 S2 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
330.0 688.3 275.0 285.0 550.0 525.0 492.0 107.2 16.0 11.0 18.0 76.2 34.0 22.0
D2
[12.99] [27.10] [10.83] [11.22] [21.65] [20.67] [19.37] [4.22] [0.63] [0.43] [0.71] [3.00] [1.34] [0.87]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-14
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame E
W D
W1 See
Se DetaililAA
e Deta D1
H1
H2
H3
See
Se Detail ilBB
e Deta
DDetail
etai lAA D etai lBB
Detail
(Mou ntin gHole)
(Mounting Hol e) (Mou ntin gHole)
(Mounting Hol e)
Figure 1-21
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1/S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
370.0 300.0 335.0 589.0 560.0 528.0 143.0 18.0 13.0 18.0
E1 - - - -
[14.57] [11.81] [13.19] [23.19] [22.05] [20.80] [5.63] [0.71] [0.51] [0.71]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-15
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame E
W D
W1 See Detail A D1
H1
H2
H3
H
See Detail B
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
?
Detail A Detail B
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-22
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1, S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
370.0 715.8 300.0 335.0 589.0 560.0 528.0 143.0 18.0 13.0 18.0 22.0 34.0 92.0
E2
[14.57] [28.18] [11.81] [13.19 [23.19] [22.05] [20.80] [5.63] [0.71] [0.51] [0.71] [0.87] [1.34] [3.62]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-16
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame F
W D
W1 D1
Seee Detail
Se DetaAil A
H1
H2
H3
Se e Deta
See DetaililBB S3 D2
S1
S2
De tailAA(Mounting
Detail (Moun ting H ole )
Hole)
S1
De tail BB(Mounting
Detail (Mou ntinHole)
g Hol e)
Figure 1-23
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1 S2 S3
420.0 300.0 380.0 800.0 770.0 717.0 124.0 18.0 13.0 25.0 18.0
F1 -
[16.54] [11.81] [14.96] [31.50] [30.32] [28.23] [4.88] [0.71] [0.51] [0.98] [0.71]
Frame Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
F1 - - -
D1*: Flange mounting
1-17
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame F
W D
W1 D1
See
Se e Detail
Deta ilA A
H1
H2
H3
H
Se
Seee Detail
Deta ilBB S3 D2
S1
2
2
1
1
3
3
2
S2
Deta il A
Detail (Mo unti ng
A (Mounting Ho le)
Hole)
S1
D etai l BB (Mo
Detail unti ng
(Mounting Hol e)
Hole)
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 D1* D2 S1 S2 S3
420.0 940.0 300.0 380.0 800.0 770.0 717.0 124.0 18.0 13.0 25.0 18.0
F2
[16.54] [37.00] [11.81] [14.96] [31.50] [30.32] [28.23] [4.88] [0.71] [0.51] [0.98] [0.71]
Frame Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
92.0 35.0 22.0
F2
[3.62] [1.38] [0.87]
D1*: Flange mounting
1-18
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame G
W D
W1 See
See De tailAA
Detail
H2
H1
H3
S3
See
See De tailBB
Detail
Deta il A
Detail A Deta
Detailil B
B
(Moun ting H ole ) (Mou ntin g Hol e)
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 S1 S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
500.0 397.0 440.0 1000.0 963.0 913.6 13.0 26.5 27.0
G1 - - - -
[19.69] [15.63] [217.32] [39.37] [37.91] [35.97] [0.51] [1.04] [1.06]
1-19
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame G
W D
W1
See Detail A
H3
H2
H1
H
S3
See Detail B
Detail A Detail B
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-26
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 H1 H2 H3 S1 S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
500.0 1240.2 397.0 440.0 1000.0 963.0 913.6 13.0 26.5 27.0 22.0 34.0 117.5
G2
[19.69] [48.83] [15.63] [217.32] [39.37] [37.91] [35.97] [0.51] [1.04] [1.06] [0.87] [1.34] [4.63]
1-20
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame H
See Detail A
See Detail B
Detail A Detail B
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-27
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 W2 W3 W4 W5 W6 H1 H2 H3 H4
700.0 1435.0 398.0 630.0 290.0 1403.0 1346.6
H1 - - - - - -
[27.56] [56.5] [15.67] [24.8] [11.42] [55.24] [53.02]
Frame H5 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 S1 S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
45.0 13.0 26.5 25.0
H1 - - - - - - - - -
[1.77] [0.51] [1.04] [0.98]
1-21
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame H
See Detail A
Detail A Detail B
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-28
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 W2 W3 W4 W5 W6 H1 H2 H3 H4
700.0 1745.0 404.0 630.0 500.0 630.0 760.0 800.0 1729.0 1701.6
H2 - - -
[27.56] [68.70] [15.90] [24.8] [19.69]- [24.80] [29.92] [31.5] [68.07] [66.99]
Frame H5 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 S1 S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
51.0 38.0 65.0 204.0 68.0 137.0 13.0 26.5 25.0
H2 - - - -
[2.00] [1.50] [2.56] [8.03] [2.68] [5.40] [0.51] [1.04] [0.98]
1-22
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Frame H
See Detail A
Detail A Detail B
(Mounting Hole) (Mounting Hole)
Figure 1-29
Unit:mm [inch]
Frame W H D W1 W2 W3 W4 W5 W6 H1 H2 H3 H4
700.0 1745.0 404.0 630.0 500.0 630.0 760.0 800.0 1729.0 1701.6
H3 - - -
[27.56] [68.70] [15.91] [24.80] [19.69] [24.80] [29.92] [31.5] [68.07] [66.99]
Frame H5 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 S1 S2 S3 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
51.0 38.0 65.0 204.0 68.0 137.0 13.0 26.5 25.0 22.0 34.0 117.5
H3 -
[2.00] [1.50] [2.56] [8.03] [2.68] [5.40] [0.51] [1.04] [0.98] [0.87] [1.34] [4.63]
1-23
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
690V
Frame H
D
W SeeDETAIL
SEE DetailAA D1
H2
H3
H1
H
W2
W1 S4
SEE DETAIL B
See Detail B
S2
S3
S2
S1
Detail A Detail B
DETAIL A DETAIL B
(MountingHOLE)
(MOUNTING Hole) (Mounting HOLE)
(MOUNTING Hole)
Figure 1-30
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W W1 W2 H H1 H2 H3 D D1 S1 S2 S3 S4
700.0 630.0 290.0 1435.0 1389.0 1346.6 1375.0 398.0 45.0 26.5 13.0 14.0 25.0
H1
[27.56] [24.80] [11.42] [56.50] [54.68] [53.02] [54.13] [15.67] [1.77] [1.04] [0.51] [0.55] [0.98]
1-24
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
690V
Frame H
S4
H
H1
H3
H3
H2
W2
See
See Detail
Detail B B S2
3
1
2
3
1
2
1 1
S3
D3
D5
3 S5
3
S1
D3
D4
Detail A Detail B
D2
W3 DETAIL A DETAIL B
(MountingHOLE)
(MOUNTING Hole) (MountingHOLE)
(MOUNTING Hole)
W4
W5
Figure 1-31
Unit: mm [inch]
Frame W W1 W2 W3 W4 W5 H H1 H2 H3 D D1 D2
700.0 630.0 800.0 500.0 630.0 760.0 1745.0 1715.0 74.5 137.0 404.0 51.0 68.0
H2
[27.56] [24.80] [31.50] [19.69] [24.80] [29.92] [68.70] [67.52] [2.93] [5.39] [15.91] [2.01] [2.68]
Frame D3 D4 D5 S1 S2 S3 S4 S5 Φ1 Φ2 Φ3
137.0 103.0 204.0 26.5 13.0 14.0 25.0 13.0 22.0 34.0 117.50
H2
[5.39] [4.06] [8.03] [1.04] [0.51] [0.55] [0.98] [0.51] [0.87] [1.34] [4.63]
1-25
Chapter 1 IntroductionCP2000
Digital Keypad
KPC-CC01
Figure 1-32
1-26
Chapter 2 InstallationCP2000
Chapter 2 Installation
2-1
Chapter 2 InstallationCP2000
The appearances shown in the following figures are for reference only.
Figure 2-3
Figure 2-4
2-2
Chapter 2 InstallationCP2000
Figure 2-5
(Frame D0–G)
Install metal separation between the drives.
Figure 2-6
2-3
Chapter 2 InstallationCP2000
NOT E
※ The mounting clearances stated in the figure is for installing the drive in an
open area. To install the drive in a confined space (such as cabinet or
electric box), please follow the following three rules: (1) Keep the minimum
mounting clearances. (2) Install a ventilation equipment or an air
conditioner to keep surrounding temperature lower than operation
temperature. (3) Refer to parameter setting and set up Pr.00-16, Pr.00-17,
and Pr.06-55.
※ The following table shows the heat dissipation and the required air volume
when installing a single drive in a confined space. When installing multiple
drives, the required air volume shall be multiplied by the number of the
drives.
※ Refer to the chart (Air flow rate for cooling) for ventilation equipment
design and selection.
※ Refer to the chart (Power dissipation) for air conditioner design and
selection.
※ Different control mode will affect the derating. See Pr.06-55 for more
Figure 2-7
information.
※ Ambient temperature derating curve shows the derating status in different
temperature in relation to different protection level.
※ If UL Type 1 models need side by side installation, please remove top
cover of Frame A–C, and please do not install conduit box of Frame D and
above.
※ Refer to Section 9-7 for ambient temperature derating curve and derating
curves under different control mode.
2-4
Chapter 2 InstallationCP2000
2-5
Chapter 2 InstallationCP2000
2-6
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Chapter 3 Unpacking
3-1 Unpacking
3-1
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
The AC motor drive should be kept in the shipping carton or crate before installation. In order to retain the
warranty coverage, the AC motor drive should be stored properly when it is not to be used for an extended
period of time.
3-1 Unpacking
Follow these steps to unpack the AC motor drive:
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs, rubber
manual, and then loosen the four screws. and the manual, and then loosen the six screws.
3-2
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now
ready for installation. ready for installation.
3-3
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Take out the EPEs and the manual. Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs, rubber
and the manual.
Figure 3-8
Figure 3-12
Figure 3-9
3-4
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now Loosen the ten screws fasten the drive on the
ready for installation. pallet, and then remove the wood plate.
Figure 3-13
Figure 3-14
3-5
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Frame E
Unpacking 1 (VFDXXXCPXXX-00) Unpacking 2 (VFDXXXCPXXX-21)
Loosen the 16 screws at the four corners of the Loosen the 16 screws at the four corners of the
crate, and then remove the iron plates. crate, and then remove the iron plates.
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs, rubber
manual. and the manual.
3-6
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now
ready for installation. ready for installation.
3-7
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Frame F
Unpacking 1 (VFDXXXCPXXX-00) Unpacking 2 (VFDXXXCPXXX-21)
Remove the six buckles fixed on the crate with a Remove the six buckles fixed on the crate with a
flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below. flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below.
6 5 6
5
4
4
1
1 2
2
Figure 3-23 3 Figure 3-27
3
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs, rubber
manual. and the manual.
Loosen the five screws fasten the drive on the Loosen the five screws fasten the drive on the
pallet, see the figure below. pallet, and then remove the wood plates and the
conduit box.
5
4 9
8
3 wood plate2 7
6
2 5
wood plate1 4
1 3
2
1
3-8
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now
ready for installation ready for installation.
3-9
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Frame G
Unpacking 1 (VFDXXXXCPXXA-00) Unpacking 2 (VFDXXXXCPXXA-21)
Remove the six buckles fixed on the crate with a Remove the six buckles fixed on the crate with a
flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below. flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below.
4 4
5 5
6 6
1 1
2
2
3 Figure 3-31 Figure 3-35
3
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs, rubber
manual. and the manual.
3-10
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now
ready for installation. ready for installation.
3-11
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Frame H
Unpacking 1 (VFDXXXXCPXXA-00) Unpacking 2 (VFDXXXXCPXXC-00)
Remove the eight buckles fixed on the crate with Remove the eight buckles fixed on the crate with
a flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below. a flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below.
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the
manual. manual.
3-12
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now Loosen the six M6 screws and the iron plates
ready for installation. (see the figure below). You can use the removed
screws and iron plates to fix the drive from
outside.
Figure 3-47
Figure 3-48
3-13
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Frame H
Unpacking 3 (VFDXXXXCPXXC-21)
Remove the eight buckles fixed on the crate with a flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below.
Figure 3-49
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the manual.
Figure 3-50
Loosen the six screws fasten the drive on the pallet, and then remove six metal washers and six plastic
washers. See the figure below.
Figure 3-51
3-14
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Loosen the six M6 screws and the iron plates (see the figure below). You can use the removed screws
and iron plates to fix the drive from the outside.
Figure 3-52
Fix the drive from the inside Fix the drive from the outside
Loosen the 18 M6 screws and remove the covers Loosen the eight M8 screws, and then use these
(see the figure 3-54). After fixing the drive and the eight M8 screws to fix the iron plates (removed at
cover for cables (see the figure 3-53), fasten the the last step) to the drive, see the figure below.
other covers back (see the figure 3-54) Torque: 150–180 kg-cm / [130.20–156.24 lb-in.] /
Torque: 35–45 kg-cm / [30.38–39.06 lb-in.] / [14.7–17.6 Nm]
[3.4–4.4 Nm]
Figure 3-53
Cover for cables (use M12 screws)
Figure 3-56
Figure 3-54
3-15
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Fasten the six M6 screws back, see the figure Fasten the six M6 screws back, see the figure
below. below.
Torque: 35–45 kg-cm / [30.8–39.06 lb-in] /
[3.4–4.4 Nm]
Figure 3-58
3-16
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
690V Frame H
Unpacking 1 (VFDXXXXCP63A-00)
Remove the eight buckles fixed on the crate with a flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below.
Figure 3-59
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the manual.
Figure 3-60
Loosen the six screws fasten the drive on the pallet, and then remove six metal washers and six plastic
washers. See the figure below.
Figure 3-61
3-17
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now ready for installation.
Figure 3-62
3-18
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
690V Frame H
Unpacking 2 (VFDXXXXCP63A-21)
Remove the eight buckles fixed on the crate with a flat-head screwdriver, see the figure below.
Figure 3-63
Remove the top cover, take out the EPEs and the manual.
Figure 3-64
Loosen the six screws fasten the drive on the pallet, and then remove six metal washers and six plastic
washers. See the figure below.
Figure 3-65
3-19
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Loosen the six M6 screws and the iron plates (see the figure below). You can use the removed screws
and iron plates to fix the drive from the outside.
Figure 3-66
Fix the drive from the inside. Fix the drive from the outside.
Loosen the 18 M6 screws and remove the covers Loosen the eight M8 screws, and then use these
(see the figure 3-68). After fixing the drive and the eight M8 screws to fix the iron plates (removed at
cover for cables (see the figure 3-67), fasten the the last step) to the drive, see the figure below.
other covers back (see the figure 3-68) Torque: 150–180 kg-cm / [130.20–156.24 lb-in.] /
Torque: 35–45 kg-cm / [30.38–39.06 lb-in.] / [14.7–17.6 Nm]
[3.4–4.4 Nm]
Figure 3-67
Cover for cables (use M12 screws)
Figure 3-70
Figure 3-68
3-20
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Fasten the six M6 screws back, see the figure Fasten the six M6 screws back, see the figure
below. below.
Lift the drive by hooking the lifting hole. It is now ready for installation.
Figure 3-72
3-21
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
H1: VFDXXXXCPXXA-00
Screw M12*6
Torque: 340–420 kg-cm / [295.1–364.6 lb-in.] /
[33.3–41.2 Nm]
Figure 3-73
H2: VFDXXXXCPXXC-00
Figure 3-74
3-22
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
H3:VFDXXXXCPXXC-21
Figure 3-75
H1: VFDXXXXCP63A-00
Screw M12*6
Torque: 340–420 kg-cm / [295.1–364.6 lb-in.] /
[33.3–41.2 Nm]
Figure 3-76
3-23
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
H2: VFDXXXXCP63A-21
Figure 3-77
3-24
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Figure 3-78
Frame D
Applicable models:
D
D
VFD370CP23A-00; VFD450CP23A-00;
VFD750CP43B-00; VFD900CP43A-00;
VFD450CP63A-00; VFD550CP63A-00;
VFD370CP23A-21; VFD450CP23A-21;
VFD750CP43B-21; VFD900CP43A-21;
VFD450CP63A-21; VFD550CP63A-21
Figure 3-79
Frame E
E
E
Applicable models:
VFD550CP23A-00; VFD750CP23A-00;
VFD900CP23A-00; VFD1100CP43A-00;
VFD1320CP43B-00; VFD750CP63A-00;
VFD900CP63A-00; VFD1100CP63A-00;
VFD1320CP63A-00; VFD550CP23A-21;
VFD750CP23A-21; VFD900CP23A-21;
VFD1100CP43A-21; VFD1320CP43B-21;
VFD750CP63A-21; VFD900CP63A-21;
VFD1100CP63A-21; VFD1320CP63A-21
Figure 3-80
3-25
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Frame F
Applicable models: FF
VFD1600CP43A-00; VFD1850CP43B-00;
VFD1600CP63A-00; VFD2000CP63A-00;
VFD1600CP43A-21; VFD1850CP43B-21;
VFD1600CP63A-21; VFD2000CP63A-21
Figure 3-81
Frame G
Applicable models: GG
VFD2200CP43A-00; VFD2800CP43A-00;
VFD2500CP63A-00; VFD3150CP63A-00;
VFD2200CP43A-21; VFD2800CP43A-21;
VFD2500CP63A-21; VFD3150CP63A-21
Figure 3-82
Frame H H
Applicable models:
VFD3150CP43A-00; VFD3550CP43A-00;
VFD4000CP43A-00; VFD5000CP43A-00;
VFD5600CP43A-00; VFD6300CP43A-00;
VFD3150CP43C-00; VFD3550CP43C-00;
VFD4000CP43C-00; VFD5000CP43C-00;
VFD3150CP43C-21; VFD3550CP43C-21;
VFD4000CP43C-21; VFD5000CP43C-21;
VFD5600CP43C-21; VFD6300CP43C-21;
VFD4000CP63A-00; VFD4500CP63A-00;
VFD5600CP63A-00; VFD6300CP63A-00
Figure 3-83
3-26
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
690V Frame H2
Applicable models:
VFD4000CP63A-21; VFD4500CP63A-21;
VFD5600CP63A-21; VFD6300CP63A-21
Figure 3-84
3-27
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Ensure the lifting hook properly goes through the Ensure the angle between the lifting holes and the
lifting hole, as shown in the following diagram. lifting device is within the specification, as shown
in the following figure.
Applicable to Frame D0–E
Applicable to Frame D0–E
Figure 3-85
Figure 3-87
Figure 3-86
Figure 3-88
3-28
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
Weight
VFDXXX X C XX A V FD XXX X C XX E
VFDXXXXCPXXS-00: 27 kg / [59.5 lbs]
27 kg(59.5 Ibs.) VFDXXXXCPXXS-21:
29 kg(63. 929 kg / [63.9 lbs]
Ibs.)
D0
E X
3-29
Chapter 3 UnpackingCP2000
H1
Figure 3-99
VFD28 00C4 3E-1; VFD3 150C 43E-1 ; VFD3550 C43E-1; VFD450 0C43 E-1
VFDXXXXCP43C-00: 260 kg / [573.2 lbs]
257kg(566.6 Ibs)
H2
Figure 3-100
Figure 3-101
H3
Figure 3-102
3-30
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
Chapter 4 Wiring
4-2 Wiring
4-1
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
After removing the front cover, please check if the power and control terminals are clearly noted.
Please read following precautions to avoid wiring mistakes.
It is crucial to cut off the AC motor drive power before any wiring installation are
made. A charge may still remain in the DC BUS capacitors with hazardous voltages
even if the power has been turned off. Therefore, it is suggested for users to
measure the remaining voltage by DC voltage meter before wiring. For your
personnel safety, please do not perform any wiring before the voltage drops to a
safe level < 25 VDC. Wiring installation with remaining voltage condition may cause
sparks and short circuit.
Only qualified personnel familiar with AC motor drives is allowed to perform
installation, wiring and commissioning. Make sure the power is turned off before
wiring to prevent electric shock.
Make sure that power is only applied to the R/L1, S/L2, and T/L3 terminals. Failure
to comply may result in damage to the equipment. The voltage and current should
lie within the range as indicated on the nameplate (Chapter 1-1 Nameplate
Information).
All the units must be grounded directly to a common ground terminal to prevent
lightning strike or electric shock.
Please make sure to fasten the screw of the main circuit terminals to prevent
sparks which is made by the loose screws due to vibration.
When wiring, please choose the wires with specification that complies with local
regulation for your personnel safety.
Check following items after finishing the wiring:
1. Are all connections correct?
2. Any loosen wires?
3. Any short-circuits between the terminals or to ground?
4-2
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
4-3
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
4-2 Wiring
Figure 4-2
Figure 4-3
*1 Please refer to Chapter 7-1 for brake units and resistors selection
4-4
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
Figure 4-4
*1 Please refer to Chapter 7-1 for brake units and resistors selection
NOTE When wiring for 12 Pulse Input, please strictly follow above wiring diagram.
4-5
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
Figure 4-5
4-6
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
4-7
Chapter 4 WiringCP2000
4-8
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
5-1
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Fasten the screws in the main circuit terminal to prevent sparks condition made by the
loose screws due to vibration.
When it needs to install the filter at the output side of terminals U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 on
the AC motor drive, please use inductance filter. Do not use phase-compensation
capacitors or L-C (Inductance-Capacitance) or R-C (Resistance-Capacitance), unless
approved by Delta.
DO NOT connect phase-compensation capacitors or surge absorbers at the output
terminals of AC motor drives.
DO NOT connect [+1, -], [+2, -], [+1/DC+, -/DC-] or brake resistor directly to prevent
drive damage.
Ensure the insulation of the main circuit wiring in accordance with the relevant safety
regulations.
Figure 5-1
5-2
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Terminals for connecting DC reactor, external brake resistor, external brake resistor
and DC circuit
This is the terminals used to connect the DC reactor to improve the power factor. For
the factory setting, it connects the short-circuit object. Please remove this short-circuit
object before connecting to the DC reactor.
Figure 5-2
Figure 5-3
The external brake resistor of Frame A, B and C should connect to the terminals (B1,
B2) of AC motor drives.
For those models without built-in brake resistor, please connect external brake unit
and brake resistor (both of them are optional) to increase brake torque.
When the terminals +1, +2 and - are not used, please leave the terminals open.
DC+ and DC- are connected by common DC BUS, please refer to Section 5-1 (Main
Circuit Terminal) for the wiring terminal specification and the wire gauge information.
Please refer to the VFDB manual for more information on wire gauge when installing
the brake unit.
5-3
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Figure 5-4
Figure 5-5
Figure 5-6
*1 Please refer to Section 7-1 for brake units and resistors selection
5-4
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Figure 5-7
*1 Please refer to Section 7-1 for brake units and resistors selection
Note: When wiring for 12 Pulse Input, please strictly follow above wiring diagram.
NOTE
If the wiring between motor drive and motor is over 75 meters, please refer to Section 7-4 Specifications of limits
for motor cable length.
Please remove short circuit plate of Frame G and H if 12 pulse is implemented. Before implementing 12 pulse,
consult Delta for more detail.
Detail A
See
Detail A
Figure 5-8
5-5
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Terminals Descriptions
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3 AC line input terminals 3-phase
U/T1, V/T2, W/T3 AC drive output terminals for connecting 3-phase induction motor
Applicable to frame A–C
+1, +2 Connections for DC reactor to improve the power factor. It needs to remove the
jumper for installation.
Connections for brake module (VFDB series)
(for 230V models: ≤ 22 kW, built-in brake module)
+1/DC+, -/DC- (for 460V models: ≤ 30 kW, built-in brake module)
(for 690V models: ≤ 37 kW, built-in brake module)
Common DC BUS
B1, B2 Connections for brake resistor (optional)
Earth connection, please comply with local regulations.
Table 5-1
5-6
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Terminal specification
The part number of the ring lugs (produced by K.S. Terminals Inc.) in the table below are for reference
only. You can by the ring lugs of your choice to match with different frame sizes.
A B C D d2 E F W t
Frame AWG Kit P/N
(MAX) (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MIN) (MIN) (MAX) (MAX)
16
RNBL2-4
14
A 12 20 5 5.5 9 4.3 8 5.5 10 1.5
RNBL5-4
10
8 RNBS8-4
8 RNBM8-5
B 6 RNB14-5 28.0 7.0 7.5 14.0 5.2 13.0 12.0 14.0 1.5
4 RNBS22-5
6 RNB14-8
4 RNB22-8
C 40 12 12.5 22 8.3 13 12.5 24 2.5
2 RNBS38-8
1/0 RNB60-8
4 RNB22-8
44.0 13.0 10.0 15.0 8.3 13.0 17.0 26.0 3.0
2 RNBS38-8
D0
1/0 SQNBS60-8
40.0 11.0 10.0 23.0 8.3 13.0 14.0* 24.0 4.5
2/0 SQNBS80-8
4 RNB22-8
2 RNBS38-8
1/0 RNB60-8
2/0 RNB70-8
D 50.0 16.0 10.0 27.0 8.3 13.0 14.0 28.0 6.0
3/0 RNB80-8
4/0 SQNBS100-8
250MCM SQNBS150-8
300MCM SQNBS150-8
4/0 RNB100-8
3/0 RNB80-8
E 53.0 16.0 17.0 26.5 8.4 13.0 17.0 31.0 5.0
2/0 RNB70-8
1/0 RNB60-8
3/0 RNB80-8
F 4/0 SQNBS100-8 55.0 15.0 10.0 27.0 8.3 13.0 17.5 31.0 6.0
300MCM SQNBS150-8
1/0 SQNB60-6
2/0
SQNBS80-8
G 3/0 54 15.5 18 26.5 8.2 13 18 31 3.5
4/0 SQNBS100-8
250MCM SQNBS150-8
5-7
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
A B C D d2 E F W t
Frame AWG Kit P/N
(MAX) (MAX) (MIN) (MAX) (MIN) (MIN) (MIN) (MAX) (MAX)
300MCM SQNBS180-12
400MCM 70 21 27 32.7 12.2 13 27 42 4.0
SQNBS200-12
500MCM
3/0 SQNBS80-8
4/0 SQNBS100-8
250MCM 54 15.5 18 26.5 8.2 13 18 31 3.5
H 300MCM SQNBS150-8
350MCM
400MCM SQNBS200-12
70.0 21.0 27.0 32.7 12.2 13.0 27.0 42.0 4.0
500MCM SQNBS200-12
*F (MAX.)=16.5 Unit: mm
*AWG: Refer to the table below for the wire size specification for models in each frame.
5-8
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame A
-/DC- +2/DC+ +1/DC+ B1 B2
5-9
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame B
-/DC- +2/DC+ +1/DC+ B1 B2
5-10
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame C
-/DC- +2/DC+ +1/DC+ B1 B2
5-11
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame D0
R/L1 S/L2 T/L3 +1/DC+ -/DC- U/T1 V/T2 W/T3
If you install at Ta 40°C environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 75°C or 90°C.
If you install at Ta 40°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on
temperature resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire
gauge when using higher temperature wire.
5-12
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame D
R/L1 S/L2 T/L3 +1/DC+ -/DC- U/T1 V/T2 W/T3
If you install at Ta 40°C environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 75°C or 90°C.
If you install at Ta 40°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For VFD450CP23A-21 and VFD900CP43A-21, if you install at Ta 30°C above environment, please
select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on
temperature resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire
gauge when using higher temperature wire.
5-13
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame E
R/L1 S/L2 T/L3 +1/DC+ -/DC- U/T1 V/T2 W/T3
If you install at Ta 40°C environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 75°C or 90°C.
If you install at Ta 40°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on
temperature resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire
gauge when using higher temperature wire.
Main Circuit Terminals
R/L1, S/L2, T/L3, U/T1, V/T2, W/T3, DC-, Terminal
DC+/+1, +2/B1, B2
Model Name Screw Screw
Max. Wire Spec. and Spec. and
Min. Wire Gauge Max. Wire Gauge Min. Wire Gauge
Gauge Torque Torque
(±10%) (±10%)
VFD550CP23A-00 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70mm2*1 [2/0 AWG*1]
VFD750CP23A-00 95mm2*2 [3/0 AWG*2] 95mm2*2 [3/0 AWG*2] 95 mm2*1 [3/0 AWG*1]
2
VFD900CP23A-00 120mm *2 [4/0AWG*2] 120mm2*2 [4/0AWG*2] 120 mm2*1 [4/0AWG*1]
VFD1100CP43A-00 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70 mm2*1 [2/0 AWG*1]
VFD1320CP43A-00 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70 mm2*1 [2/0 AWG*1]
2
VFD550CP23A-21 70mm *2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70 mm2*1 [2/0 AWG*1]
VFD750CP43A-21 95mm2*2 [3/0 AWG*2] 95mm2*2 [3/0 AWG*2] 95 mm2*1 [3/0 AWG*1]
2
VFD900CP43A-21 120mm *2 [4/0AWG*2] M8 120mm2*2 [4/0AWG*2] 120 mm2*1 [4/0AWG*1] M8
2 2 2 2
VFD1100CP23A-21 120 mm *2 70mm *2 [2/0 AWG*2] 180kg-cm 70mm *2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70 mm *1 [2/0 AWG*1] 180kg-cm
VFD1320CP43A-21 [4/0 AWG*2] 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] [156.2lb-in.] 70mm2*2 [2/0 AWG*2] 70 mm2*1 [2/0 AWG*1] [156.2lb-in.]
VFD750CP63A-00 25mm2*2 [4 AWG*2] [17.65Nm] 25mm2*2 [4 AWG*2] 25mm2*1 [4 AWG*1] [17.76Nm]
2 2 2
VFD900CP63A-00 35mm *2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm *2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm *1 [2 AWG*1]
VFD1100CP63A-00 35mm2*2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm2*2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm2*1 [2 AWG*1]
2 2
VFD1320CP63A-00 50mm *2 [1/0 AWG*2] 50mm *2 [1/0 AWG*2] 50mm2*1 [1/0 AWG*1]
VFD750CP63A-21 25mm2*2 [4 AWG*2] 25 mm2*2 [4 AWG*2] 25 mm2*1 [4 AWG*1]
2 2
VFD900CP63A-21 35mm *2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm *2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm2*1 [2 AWG*1]
VFD1100CP63A-21 35mm2*2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm2*2 [2 AWG*2] 35mm2*1 [2 AWG*1]
VFD1320CP63A-21 50mm2*2 [1/0 AWG*2] 50mm2*2 [1/0 AWG*2] 50mm2*1 [1/0 AWG*1]
5-14
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame F
R/L1 S/L2 T/L3 +1/DC+ -/DC- U/T1 V/T2 W/T3
If you install at Ta 40°C environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 75°C or 90°C.
If you install at Ta 40°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For VFD1850CP43B-21, if you install at Ta 30°C above environment, please select copper wire with
voltage rating 600V and temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on
temperature resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire
gauge when using higher temperature wire.
5-15
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame G
R/L11 R/L12 S/L21 S/L22 T/L31 T/L32 +1/D C+ -/DC- U/T1 V/T 2 W/T3
If you install at Ta 40°C environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 75°C or 90°C.
If you install at Ta 40°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on
temperature resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire
gauge when using higher temperature wire.
5-16
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame H
R/L11 R/L12 S/L21 S/L22 T/L31 T/L32 +1/DC + -/DC - U/T1 V/T2 W/T 3
If you install at Ta 40°C environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and temperature
resistant at 75°C or 90°C.
If you install at Ta 40°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For VFD5000CP43A-00, VFD5000CP43C-00, VFD5000CP43C-21, if you install at Ta 30°C above
environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on temperature
resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire gauge when using
higher temperature wire.
Main Circuit Terminals
R/L11, R/L12, S/L21, S/L22, T/L31, T/L32, U/T1, Terminal
V/T2, W/T3, +1/DC+, -/DC-
Model Name
Screw Spec. Screw Spec.
Max. Wire Max. Wire
Min. Wire Gauge and Torque Min. Wire Gauge and Torque
Gauge Gauge
(±10%) (±10%)
120mm2*4
VFD3150CP43A-00 120mm2*4 [4/0AWG*4] 120mm2*2 [4/0AWG*2]
[4/0AWG*4]
120mm2*4
VFD3550CP43A-00 120mm2*4 [250MCM*4] 120mm2*2 [250MCM*2]
[250MCM*4]
150mm2*4
VFD4000CP43A-00 150mm2*4 [300MCM*4] 150mm2*2 [300MCM*2]
[300MCM*4]
185mm2*4
VFD5000CP43A-00 185mm2*4 [350MCM*4] 185mm2*2 [350MCM*2]
[350MCM*4]
120mm2*4
VFD3150CP43C-00 120mm2*4 [4/0AWG*4] 120mm2*2 [4/0AWG*2]
[4/0AWG*4]
120mm2*4
VFD3550CP43C-00 120mm2*4 [250MCM*4] 120mm2*2 [250MCM*2]
[250MCM*4]
150mm2*4
VFD4000CP43C-00 150mm2*4 [300MCM*4] 150mm2*2 [300MCM*2]
[300MCM*4]
185mm2*4
VFD5000CP43C-00 185mm2*4 [350MCM*4] 185mm2*2 [350MCM*2]
[350MCM*4]
120mm2*4
VFD3150CP43C-21 120mm2*4 [4/0AWG*4] 120mm2*2 [4/0AWG*2]
[4/0AWG*4]
M8 120mm2*4 M8
VFD3550CP43C-21 120mm2*4 [250MCM*4] 120mm2*2 [250MCM*2]
185mm2*4 180kg-cm [250MCM*4] 180kg-cm
[350MCM*4] [156.2lb-in.] 150mm2*4 [156.2lb-in.]
VFD4000CP43C-21 150mm2*4 [300MCM*4] 150mm2*2 [300MCM*2]
[17.65Nm] [300MCM*4] [17.65Nm]
185mm2*4
VFD5000CP43C-21 185mm2*4 [350MCM*4] 185mm2*2 [350MCM*2]
[350MCM*4]
95mm2*4
VFD4000CP63A-00 95mm2*4 [3/0AWG*4] 95mm2*2 [3/0AWG*2]
[3/0AWG*4]
95mm2*4
VFD4500CP63A-00 95mm2*4 [3/0AWG*4] 95mm2*2 [3/0AWG*2]
[3/0AWG*4]
120mm2*4
VFD5600CP63A-00 120mm2*4 [250MCM*4] 120mm2*2 [250MCM*2]
[250MCM*4]
150mm2*4
VFD6300CP63A-00 150mm2*4 [300MCM*4] 150mm2*2 [300MCM*2]
[300MCM*4]
150mm2*4
VFD4000CP63A-21 150mm2*4 [300MCM*4] 150mm2*2 [300MCM*2]
[300MCM*4]
95mm2*4
VFD4500CP63A-21 95mm2*4 [3/0AWG*4] 95mm2*2 [3/0AWG*2]
[3/0AWG*4]
120mm2*4
VFD5600CP63A-21 120mm2*4 [250MCM*4] 120mm2*2 [250MCM*2]
[250MCM*4]
150mm2*4
VFD6300CP63A-21 150mm2*4 [300MCM*4] 150mm2*2 [300MCM*2]
[300MCM*4]
5-17
Chapter 5 Main Circuit TerminalsCP2000
Frame H
+1/DC+ -/DC-
If you install at Ta 30°C above environment, please select copper wire with voltage rating 600V and
temperature resistant at 90°C or above.
For UL installation compliant, please use copper wires for installation, the wire gauge is based on
temperature resistant at 75°C which is requested and recommended from UL. Do not reduce the wire
gauge when using higher temperature wire.
5-18
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
6-1
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Figure 6-1
6-2
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
When the photo-coupler is using internal power supply, the switch connection for Sink
and Source as below:
MI-DCM: Sink mode
MI-+24V: Source mode
When the photo-coupler is using external power supply, please remove the short circuit
cable between the +24V and COM terminals. The connection mode is Sink mode or
Source mode according to the below:
The “+” of 24V connecting to “COM: Sink mode
The “-“ of 24V connecting to COM: Source mode
6-3
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Applicable models:
VFD007CP23A-21; VFD015CP23A-21; VFD022CP23A-21; VFD037CP23A-21; VFD055CP23A-21;
VFD007CP43A-21; VFD015CP43B-21; VFD022CP43B-21; VFD037CP43B-21; VFD040CP43A-21;
VFD055CP43B-21; VFD075CP43B-21; VFD007CP4EA-21; VFD015CP4EB-21; VFD022CP4EB-21;
VFD037CP4EB-21; VFD040CP4EB-21; VFD055CP4EB-21; VFD075CP4EB-21; VFD015CP53A-21;
VFD022CP53A-21; VFD037CP53A-21; VFD075CP23A-21; VFD110CP23A-21; VFD150CP23A-21;
VFD110CP43B-21; VFD150CP43B-21; VFD185CP43B-21; VFD110CP4EB-21; VFD150CP4EB-21;
VFD185CP4EB-21; VFD055CP53A-21; VFD075CP53A-21; VFD110CP53A-21; VFD150CP53A-21
Figure 6-6
Frame C
Applicable models:
VFD185CP23A-21; VFD220CP23A-21; VFD300CP23A-21; VFD220CP43A-21; VFD300CP43B-21;
VFD370CP43B-21; VFD220CP4EA-21; VFD300CP4EB-21; VFD370CP4EB-21; VFD185CP63A-21;
VFD220CP63A-21; VFD300CP63A-21; VFD370CP63A-21
Figure 6-7
6-4
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Frame D0 & D
Applicable models:
VFD450CP43S-00; VFD550CP43S-00; VFD450CP43S-21; VFD550CP43S-21; VFD370CP23A-00/-21;
VFD450CP23A-00/-21; VFD750CP43B-00/-21; VFD900CP43A-00/-21; VFD450CP63A-00/-21;
VFD550CP63A-00/-21
Figure 6-8
Frame E
Applicable models:
VFD550CP23A-00/-21; VFD750CP23A-00/-21; VFD900CP23A-00/-21; VFD1100CP43A-00/-21;
VFD1320CP43B-00/-21; VFD750CP63A-00/-21; VFD900CP63A-00/-21; VFD1100CP63A-00/-21;
VFD1320CP63B-21
Figure 6-9
6-5
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Frame F
Applicable models:
VFD1600CP43A-00/-21; VFD1850CP43B-00/-21; VFD1600CP63A-00/-21; VFD2000CP63A-00/-21
Figure 6-10
Frame G
Applicable models:
VFD2200CP43A-00/-21; VFD2800CP43A-00/-21; VFD2500CP63A-00/-21; VFD3150CP63A-00/-21
Figure 6-11
6-6
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Frame H
Applicable models:
VFD3150CP43A-00; VFD3550CP43A-00; VFD4000CP43A-00; VFD5000CP43A-00; VFD5600CP43A-00;
VFD6300CP43A-00; VFD3150CP43C-00/-21; VFD3550CP43C-00/-21; VFD4000CP43C-00/-21;
VFD5000CP43C-00/-21; VFD5600CP43C-21; VFD6300CP43C-21
Figure 6-12
690V Frame H
Applicable models:
VFD4000CP63A-00/-21; VFD4500CP63A-00/-21; VFD5600CP63A-00/-21; VFD6300CP63A-00/-21
Figure 6-13
6-7
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Figure 6-14
Wiring precautions:
In the figure above, the default for STO1, STO2, +24V and SCM1, SCM2, DCM are short circuit.
The +24V from section Ⓒ of above figure is for STO only, and cannot be used for other
purposes. The default for +24V-COM is short circuit and SINK mode (NPN); please refer to
Section 4 Wiring for more detail.
Tighten the wiring with slotted screwdriver:
Ⓐ Ⓑ is 3.5 mm (wide) x 0.6 mm (thick); Ⓒ is 2.5 mm (wide) x 0.4 mm (thick)
When wiring bare wires, make sure they are perfectly arranged to go through the wiring holes.
Terminals Terminal Function Default (NPN mode)
Digital control signal common
+24V +24V 5% 200mA
(Source)
COM Digital control signal common (Sink) Common for multi-function input terminals
FWD-DCM:
FWD Forward-Stop command ON forward running
OFF deceleration to stop
REV-DCM:
REV Reverse-Stop command ON reverse running
OFF deceleration to stop
6-8
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Impedance: 20 kΩ
Range: 0–20 mA / 4–20 mA / 0–10 V = 0–Max. Output
AVI 1
Frequency (Pr.01-00)
AVI1 switch, default is 0–10 V
Figure 6-16
Analog current input
Impedance: 250 Ω
Range: 0–20 mA / 4–20 mA / 0–10 V = 0–Max. Output
ACI
Frequency (Pr.01-00)
ACI Switch, default is 4–20 mA
Figure 6-17
6-9
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Impedance: 20 kΩ
AVI2
Range: 0–+10 VDC=0–Max. Output Frequency (Pr.01-00)
Figure 6-18
Multi-function analog voltage output
AFM1
0–10 V Max. output current 2 mA, Max. load 5 kΩ
0–20 mA Max. load 500 Ω
Output current: 20 mA max
Resolution: 0–10 V corresponds to Max. operation frequency
Range: 0–10 V 4–20 mA
AFM2
AFM1/ AFM2 Switch, default is 0–10 V
Figure 6-19
ACM Analog Signal Common Common for analog terminals
STO1 Default setting is shorted
SCM1 Power removal safety function for EN ISO 13849 and IEC 61508
STO2 When STO1–SCM1; STO2–SCM2 is activated, the voltage of STO1–SCM1 / STO2–SCM2 must be
≥ 11 VDC, the internal resistance for STO1–SCM1 / STO2–SCM2 is 3.6 kΩ
SCM2
Note: Please refer to Section 18 Safe Torque Off Function.
SG+ Modbus RS-485
SG- Note: Please refer to Section 12 DESCRIPTION OF PARAMETER SETTINGS group 09
SGND Communication Parameters for more information.
PIN 1, 2, 7, 8 : Reserved PIN 3, 6: SGND
RJ45
PIN 4: SG- PIN 5: SG+
NOTE: Wire size of analog control signals: 0.75 mm2 [18 AWG] with shielded wire
6-10
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
Figure 6-19
2. Remove the control board by pulling it out for a distance 6–8 cm (as 1 in the figure) then lift the control
board upward (as 2 in the figure).
Figure 6-20
6-11
Chapter 6 Control TerminalsCP2000
6-12
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-4 AC / DC Reactor
7-1
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
The optional accessories listed in this chapter are available upon request. Installing additional
accessories to your drive would substantially improve the drive’s performance. Please select an
applicable accessory according to your need or contact the local distributor for suggestion.
7-2
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable
125%Braking Torque 10%ED *1 Max. Brake Torque *2
Motor
Braking Brake Braking Resistor series for each Resistor value Total Min. Max. Total Peak
HP kW Torque Unit Brake Unit *4 spec. for each Braking Resistor Braking Power
[kg-m] VFDB *3 P/N Q’ty Usage AC motor Drive Current [A] Value [Ω] Current [A] [kW]
6 parallel,
250 185 108.3 4160*1 BR1K5W012 12 18000W 4Ω 190 4.0 190 144.4
2 series
7 parallel,
300 220 125.2 4185*1 BR1K5W012 14 21000W 3.4Ω 225 3.4 225 172.0
2 series
5 parallel,
375 280 148.9 4110*2 BR1K2W015 10 24000W 3Ω 252 3.0 252 191.5
2 series
6 parallel,
425 315 189.6 4160*2 BR1K5W012 12 36000W 2Ω 380 2.0 380 288.8
2 series
6 parallel,
475 355 213.3 4160*2 BR1K5W012 12 36000W 2Ω 380 2.0 380 288.8
2 series
7 parallel,
536 400 240.3 4185*2 BR1K5W012 14 42000W 1.7Ω 450 1.7 450 344.2
2 series
6 parallel,
675 500 304.7 4185*3 BR1K5W012 12 54000W 1.3Ω 600 1.1 675 513.0
2 series
7 parallel,
745 560 379.1 4185*3 BR1K5W012 14 63000W 1.1Ω 675 1.1 675 513.0
2 series
6 parallel,
850 630 426.5 4160*4 BR1K5W012 12 72000W 1.0Ω 760 1.0 760 577.6
2 series
Table 7-2
575V Model
Applicable
125%Braking Torque 10%ED *1 Max. Brake Torque *2
Motor [kW]
Braking Brake Braking Resistor series for each Resistor value Total Min. Max. Total Peak
ND LD Torque Unit Brake Unit *4 spec. for each Braking Resistor Braking Power
[kg-m] VFDB *3 P/N Q’ty Usage AC motor Drive Current [A] Value [Ω] Current [A] [kW]
7-3
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable
*1 125%Braking Torque 10%ED *2 Max. Brake Torque
Motor [kW]
Braking Brake *3 Braking Resistor series for each Resistor value Total Min. Max. Total Peak
LD ND Torque Unit Brake Unit spec. for each Braking Resistor Braking Power
[kg-m] *4 VFDB P/N Q’ty Usage AC motor Drive Current [A] Value [Ω] Current [A] [kW]
5 parallel,
160 132 89.4 6160*1 BR1K5W027 10 15000W 10.8Ω 103.7 8.2 136 152.3
2 series
6 parallel,
200 160 108.3 6200*1 BR1K5W027 12 18000W 9.0Ω 124.4 6.9 162 181.4
2 series
4 parallel,
250 200 135.4 6110*2 BR1K5W027 8 24000W 6.8Ω 165.9 6.1 184 206.1
2 series
5 parallel,
315 250 169.3 6160*2 BR1K5W027 10 30000W 5.4Ω 207.4 4.1 272 304.6
2 series
6 parallel,
400 315 213.3 6200*2 BR1K5W027 12 36000W 4.5Ω 248.9 3.5 324 362.9
2 series
7 parallel,
450 355 240.3 6200*2 BR1K5W027 14 42000W 3.9Ω 290.4 3.5 324 362.9
2 series
6 parallel,
560 450 304.7 6200*3 BR1K5W027 12 54000W 3.0Ω 373.3 2.3 486 544.3
2 series
6 parallel,
630 630 426.5 6200*4 BR1K5W027 12 72000W 2.3Ω 497.8 1.7 648 725.8
2 series
Table 7-4
*1 Calculation for 125% brake toque: (kW)*125%*0.8; where 0.8 is motor efficiency.
Because of the limited resistor power, the longest operation time for 10%ED is 10 seconds (on: 10 sec. / off: 90 sec.).
*2 Refer to Chapter 7 “Brake Module and Brake Resistors” in application manual for “Operation Duration & ED” vs. “Braking
Current”.
*3 For heat dissipation, a resistor of 400 W or lower should be fixed to the frame and maintain the surface temperature below
250°C; a resistor of 1000W and above should maintain the surface temperature below 350°C.
*4 Please refer to VFDB series Braking Module Instruction for more detail on braking resistor.
NOTE
1. Specification and Appearance of Brake Resistors
1-1 Wire wound resistors: For 1000 W and above. Refer to the following appearance of wire wound resistor
(Figure 7-1) and its model and specification comparison table (Table 7-5) for details.
H
F
G
L
E
A
B
C
Figure 7-1
K
Table 7-5
7-4
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
1-2 Aluminum housed resistors: for below 1000 W. Refer to the following appearance of aluminum-housed
resistor (Figure 7-2) and its model and specification comparison table (Table 7-6) for details.
L1
L2
W
A
L 1 6A WG, 1. 31 8 M M2
L3
H
Unit: mm
Table 7-6
2. Select the resistance value, power and brake usage (ED %) according to Delta rules.
Figure 7-3
For safety concern, install a thermal overload relay (O.L) between the brake unit and the brake resistor in
conjunction with the magnetic contactor (MC) before the drive for additional protection. The thermal overload
relay protects the brake resistor from damage due to frequent or continuous braking. Under such
circumstances, turn off the power to prevent damage to the brake resistor, brake unit and drive.
Figure 7-4
7-5
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
3. Any damage to the drive or other equipment caused by using brake resistors and brake modules that are not
provided by Delta voids the warranty.
4. Consider environmental safety factors when installing the brake resistors. If you use the minimum resistance
value, consult local dealers for the power calculation.
5. When using more than two brake units, the equivalent resistor value of the parallel brake unit cannot be less
than the value in the column “Minimum Resistor Value (Ω)”. Read the wiring information in the brake unit
instruction sheet thoroughly prior to operation. Visit the following links to get the instruction sheets for the
wiring in the brake unit:
VFDB2015 / 2022 / 4030 / 4045 / 5055 Braking Modules Instruction Sheet
http://www.deltaww.com/filecenter/Products/download/06/060101/Option/DELTA_IA-MDS_VFDB_I_EN_
20070719.pdf
VFDB4110 / 4160 / 4185 Braking Modules Instruction Sheet
http://www.deltaww.com/filecenter/Products/download/06/060101/Option/DELTA_IA-MDS_VFDB4110-41
60-4185_I_EN_20101011.pdf
VFDB6055 / 6110 / 6160 / 6200 Braking Modules Instruction Sheet
http://www.deltaww.com/filecenter/Products/download/06/060101/Option/DELTA_IA-MDS_VFDB6055-61
10-6160-6200_I_TSE_20121030.pdf
6. This chart is for normal usage; if the AC motor drive is applied for frequent braking, it is suggested to enlarge
2–3 times of the Watts.
7. Thermal Overload Relay (TOR), for 230V / 460V / 690V models:
Choosing a thermal overload relay is based on whether its overload capability is appropriate for the CP2000.
The standard braking capacity of the CP2000 is 10%ED (Tripping time=10s). As shown in the figure below, a
460V, 110 kW CP2000 has a braking current of 126 A (refer to the tables in this section), so it can use the
thermal overload relay with a rated current of 50 A. The property of each thermal relay may vary among
different manufacturer, please carefully read specification.
Figure 7-5
7-6
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-2 Magnetic Contactor / Air Circuit Breaker and Non-fuse Circuit Breaker
Magnetic Contactor (MC) and Air Circuit Breaker (ACB)
It is recommended the surrounding temperature for MC should be ≥ 60°C and that for ACB should be
≥ 50°C. In the meanwhile, consider temperature derating for components with ON/OFF switch in
accordance with the ambient temperature of the on-site distribution panel.
230V Series
Light duty output Light duty input current MC/ACB selection
Frame Model
current [A] [A] [A]
VFD007CP23A 5 6.4 11
A VFD022CP23A 10 15 22
VFD037CP23A 15 22 40
VFD055CP23A 21 25 40
VFD075CP23A 31 34 55
B VFD110CP23A 46 51 85
VFD150CP23A 61 67 105
VFD185CP23A 75 83 130
C VFD220CP23A 90 99 150
460V Series
Light duty output Light duty input current MC/ACB selection
Frame Model
current [A] [A] [A]
VFD007CP43A-21 3.0 4.3 7
VFD040CP43A-21 10.5 16 32
VFD055CP43B-21 13 20 32
VFD075CP43B-21 18 22 40
VFD110CP43B-21 24 26 40
B VFD150CP43B-21 32 35 55
VFD185CP43B-21 38 42 65
VFD220CP43A-21 45 50 75
C VFD300CP43B-21 60 66 105
VFD370CP43B-21 73 80 130
7-7
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
VFD220CP63A-21 30 36 65
C
VFD300CP63A-21 36 43 75
VFD370CP63A-21 45 54 100
VFD450CP63A-00/A-21 54 65 130
D
VFD550CP63A-00/A-21 67 81 150
VFD750CP63A-00/A-21 86 84 150
7-8
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Table 7-10
Non-fuse Circuit Breaker
Comply with UL standard: Per UL 508, paragraph 45.8.4, part a,
The rated current of the breaker shall be 1.6–2.6 times (575V / 690V models: 2–4 times) of the
maximum rated input current of AC motor drive.
3-phase 230V 3-phase 460V
Recommended Recommended
Model Model
non-fuse breaker [A] non-fuse breaker [A]
VFD007CP23A-21 15 VFD007CP43A-21/4EA-21 10
VFD015CP23A-21 20 VFD015CP43B-21/4EB-21 10
VFD022CP23A-21 30 VFD022CP43B-21/4EB-21 15
VFD037CP23A-21 40 VFD040CP43A-21/4EA-21 25
VFD055CP23A-21 50 VFD037CP43B-21/4EB-21 30
VFD075CP23A-21 60 VFD055CP43B-21/4EB-21 40
VFD110CP23A-21 100 VFD075CP43B-21/4EB-21 40
VFD150CP23A-21 125 VFD110CP43B-21/4EB-21 50
VFD185CP23A-21 150 VFD150CP43B-21/4EB-21 60
VFD220CP23A-21 200 VFD185CP43B-21/4EB-21 75
VFD300CP23A-21 225 VFD220CP43A-21/4EA-21 100
VFD370CP23A-00/23A-21 250 VFD300CP43B-21/4EB-21 125
VFD450CP23A-00/23A-21 300 VFD370CP43B-21/4EB-21 150
VFD550CP23A-00/23A-21 400 VFD450CP43S-00/43S-21 175
VFD750CP23A-00/23A-21 450 VFD550CP43S-00/43S-21 250
VFD900CP23A-00/23A-21 600 VFD750CP43B-00/43B-21 300
Table 7-11 VFD900CP43A-00/43A-21 300
VFD1100CP43A-00/43A-21 400
VFD1320CP43B-00/43B-21 500
VFD1600CP43A-00/43A-21 600
VFD1850CP43B-00/43B-21 600
VFD2200CP43A-00/43A-21 800
VFD2800CP43A-00/43A-21 1000
VFD3150CP43A-00/43C-00/43C-21 1200
VFD3550CP43A-00/43C-00/43C-21 1350
VFD4000CP43A-00/43C-00/43C-21 1500
VFD5000CP43A-00/43C-00/43C-21 2000
VFD5600CP43A-00/43C-21 2000
VFD6300CP43A-00/43C-21 2000
Table 7-12
7-9
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-10
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-11
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-12
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-4 AC / DC Reactor
AC Input Reactor
Installing an AC reactor on the input side of an AC motor drive can increase line impedance, improve
the power factor, reduce input current, and reduce interference generated from the motor drive. It also
reduces momentary voltage surges or abnormal current spikes. For example, when the main power
capacity is higher than 500 kVA, or when using a switching capacitor bank, momentary voltage and
current spikes may damage the AC motor drive’s internal circuit. An AC reactor on the input side of the AC
motor drive protects it by suppressing surges.
Installation
Install an AC input reactor in series with the main power to the three input phases R S T as shown
below:
200V–230V, 50 / 60 Hz
Rated Amps Max. 3% 5% 3%
of AC Reactor continuous Impedance Impedance Built-in Input AC reactor
Model kW HP (Arms) Amps (Arms) (mH) (mH) DC Delta part #
Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light reactor Normal Light
Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty
VFD007CP23A-21 0.75 1 4.6 5 7.36 6 2.536 2.536 4.227 4.227 No DR005A0254 DR005A0254
VFD015CP23A-21 1.5 2 5 7.5 8 9 2.536 1.585 4.227 2.642 No DR005A0254 DR008A0159
VFD022CP23A-21 2.2 3 8 10 12.8 12 1.585 1.152 2.642 1.92 No DR008A0159 DR011A0115
VFD037CP23A-21 3.7 5 11 15 17.6 18 1.152 0.746 1.92 1.243 No DR011A0115 DR017AP746
VFD055CP23A-21 5.5 7.5 17 21 27.2 25.2 0.746 0.507 1.243 0.845 No DR017AP746 DR025AP507
VFD075CP23A-21 7.5 10 25 31 40 37.2 0.507 0.38 0.845 0.633 No DR025AP507 DR033AP320
VFD110CP23A-21 11 15 33 46 52.8 55.2 0.38 0.26 0.633 0.433 No DR033AP320 DR049AP215
VFD150CP23A-21 15 20 49 61 78.4 73.2 0.26 0.196 0.433 0.327 No DR049AP215 DR065AP162
VFD185CP23A-21 18.5 25 65 75 104 90 0.196 0.169 0.327 0.282 No DR065AP162 DR075AP170
VFD220CP23A-21 22 30 75 90 120 108 0.169 0.141 0.282 0.235 No DR075AP170 DR090AP141
VFD300CP23A-21 30 40 90 105 144 126 0.141 0.12 0.235 0.2 No DR090AP141 DR105AP106
VFD370CP23A-00/-21 37 50 120 146 192 175.2 0.12 0.087 0.2 0.145 Yes DR105AP106 DR146AP087
VFD450CP23A-00/-21 45 60 146 180 233.6 216 0.087 0.07 0.145 0.117 Yes DR146AP087 DR180AP070
VFD550CP23A-00/-21 55 75 180 215 288 258 0.07 0.059 0.117 0.098 Yes DR180AP070 DR215AP059
VFD750CP23A-00/-21 75 100 215 276 344 331.2 0.059 0.049 0.098 0.082 Yes DR215AP059 DR276AP049
VFD900CP23A-00/-21 90 125 255 322 408 386.4 0.049 0.037 0.082 0.062 Yes DR276AP049 DR346AP037
Table 7-19
7-13
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
380V–460V, 50 / 60 Hz
Rated Amps 3% 5% 3%
Max. continuous
of AC Reactor Impedance Impedance Built-in Input AC reactor
Amps (Arms)
Model kW HP (Arms) (mH) (mH) DC Delta part #
Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light reactor Normal Light
Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty
VFD007CP43A-21/4EA-21 0.75 1 2.8 3 4.48 3.6 9.058 8.102 15.097 13.503 No DR003A0810*1 DR003A0810
VFD015CP43B-21/4EB-21 1.5 2 3 4.2 4.8 5.04 8.102 6.077 13.503 10.128 No DR003A0810 DR004A0607
VFD022CP43B-21/4EB-21 2.2 3 4 5.5 6.4 6.6 6.077 4.05 10.128 6.75 No DR004A0607 DR006A0405
VFD040CP43A-21/4EA-21 3.7 5 6 8.5 9.6 10.2 4.05 2.7 6.75 4.5 No DR006A0405 DR009A0270
VFD037CP43B-21/4EB-21 4 5 9 10.5 14.4 12.6 2.7 2.315 4.5 3.858 No DR009A0270 DR010A0231
VFD055CP43B-21/4EB-21 5.5 7.5 10.5 13 16.8 15.6 2.315 2.025 3.858 3.375 No DR010A0231 DR012A0202
VFD075CP43B-21/4EB-21 7.5 10 12 18 19.2 21.6 2.025 1.35 3.375 2.25 No DR012A0202 DR018A0117
VFD110CP43B-21/4EB-21 11 15 18 24 28.8 28.8 1.35 1.01 2.25 1.683 No DR018A0117 DR024AP881
VFD150CP43B-21/4EB-21 15 20 24 32 38.4 38.4 1.01 0.76 1.683 1.267 No DR024AP881 DR032AP660
VFD185CP43B-21/4EB-21 18.5 25 32 38 51.2 45.6 0.76 0.639 1.267 1.065 No DR032AP660 DR038AP639
VFD220CP43A-21/4EA-21 22 30 38 45 60.8 54 0.639 0.541 1.065 0.902 No DR038AP639 DR045AP541
VFD300CP43B-21/4EB-21 30 40 45 60 72 72 0.541 0.405 0.902 0.675 No DR045AP541 DR060AP405
VFD370CP43B-21/4EB-21 37 50 60 73 96 87.6 0.405 0.334 0.675 0.557 No DR060AP405 DR073AP334
VFD450CP43S-00/43S-21 45 60 73 91 116.8 109.2 0.334 0.267 0.557 0.445 Yes DR073AP334 DR091AP267
VFD550CP43S-00/43S-21 55 75 91 110 145.6 132 0.267 0.221 0.445 0.368 Yes DR091AP267 DR110AP221
VFD750CP43B-00/43B-21 75 100 110 150 176 180 0.221 0.162 0.368 0.27 Yes DR110AP221 DR150AP162
VFD900CP43A-00/43A-21 90 125 150 180 240 216 0.162 0.135 0.27 0.225 Yes DR150AP162 DR180AP135
VFD1100CP43A-00/43A-21 110 150 180 220 288 264 0.135 0.11 0.225 0.183 Yes DR180AP135 DR220AP110
VFD1320CP43B-00/43B-21 132 175 220 260 352 312 0.11 0.098 0.183 0.163 Yes DR220AP110 DR260AP098
VFD1600CP43A-00/43A-21 160 215 260 310 416 372 0.098 0.078 0.163 0.13 Yes DR260AP098 DR310AP078
VFD1850CP43B-00/43B-21 185 250 310 370 496 444 0.078 0.066 0.13 0.11 Yes DR310AP078 DR370AP066
VFD2200CP43A-00/43A-21 220 300 370 460 592 552 0.066 0.054 0.11 0.09 Yes DR370AP066 DR460AP054
VFD2800CP43A-00/43A-21 280 375 460 530 736 636 0.054 0.044 0.09 0.073 Yes DR460AP054 DR550AP044
VFD3150CP43A-00/43C-00
315 420 550 616 880 739.2 0.044 0.039 0.073 0.065 Yes DR550AP044 DR616AP039
/ VFD3150CP43A-21
VFD3550CP43A-00/43C-00
355 475 616 683 985.6 819.6 0.039 0.036 0.065 0.06 Yes DR616AP039 DR683AP036
/ VFD3550CP43A-21
VFD4000CP43A-00/43C-00
400 536 683 770 1092.8 924 0.036 0.028 0.06 0.047 Yes DR683AP036 DR866AP028
/ VFD4000CP43A-21
VFD5000CP43A-00/43C-00 DR866AP028*
500 930 866 912 1385.6 1094.4 0.028 0.028 0.047 0.043 Yes DR866AP028 2
/ VFD5000CP43A-21
VFD5600CP43A-00/43C-21 560 650 930 1094 1488 1318.2 0.026 0.022 0.043 0.037 Yes Please contact Delta for more
information
VFD6300CP43A-00/43C-21 630 750 1094 1212 1750.4 1454.4 0.022 0.020 0.037 0.033 Yes
*Note 1: Use with DR003A0810, but the inductance value will be 3% short.
*Note 2: Use with DR866AP028, the value is 5.3% greater than the rated current, which may cause slightly over-heat.
Table 7-20
7-14
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-15
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Marking
PE bolt
Tightening torque: 6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in.] / [0.6–0.8 Nm] Tightening torque: F Nm
Figure 7-7
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A B C D1*D2 E G1 G2 PE D
Delta part #
DR005A0254 100 115 65 6*9 45 60 40 M4
DR008A0159 100 115 65 6*9 45 60 40 M4
DR011A0115 130 135 95 6*12 60 80.5 60 M4
DR017AP746 130 135 100 6*12 65 80.5 60 M4
Table 7-23
7-16
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Installing screw M5
PE screw
Tightening torque: F Nm
Figure 7-8
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A B C D1*D2 H G1 G2 PE D
Delta part #
DR025AP215 130 195 100 6*12 65 80.5 60 M4
DR033AP163 130 195 100 6*12 65 80.5 60 M4
DR049AP163 160 200 125 6*12 90 107 75 M4
Table 7-24
7-17
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Installing screw M6
PE M6
Tightening torque: 3±1.5 Nm
Figure 7-9
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR065AP162 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-25
7-18
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque: 8.2–10.2 kg-cm /
[7.1–8.9 lb-in] / [0.8–1.0 Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3 Nm
Figure 7-10
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR075AP170 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-26
7-19
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals 4mm2
Tightening torque: 0.8–1.0Nm
PE bolt
PE M8x23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3Nm
Figure 7-11
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR090AP141 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-27
7-20
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque: 8.2–10.2 kg-cm /
[7.1–8.9 lb-in] / [0.8–1.0Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3Nm
Figure 7-12
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR105AP106 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-28
7-21
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque:
6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3Nm
Figure 7-13
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR146AP087 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-29
7-22
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque:
6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3N
Figure 7-14
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR180AP070 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-30
7-23
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque:
6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3N
Figure 7-15
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR215AP059 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-31
7-24
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque:
6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3
Figure 7-16
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR215AP059 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-32
7-25
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque:
6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3
Figure 7-17
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR346AP037 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-33
7-26
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
PE MD
Tightening torque: 6.1–8.2 kg-cm / Tightening torque: F Nm
[5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8Nm]
Figure 7-18
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A B C D1*D2 H G1 G2 PE D
Delta part #
DR003A0810 100 125 65 6*9 43 60 40 M4
DR004A0607 100 125 65 6*9 43 60 40 M4
DR006A0405 130 15 95 6*12 60 80.5 60 M4
DR009A0270 160 160 105 6*12 75 107 75 M4
DR010A0231 160 160 115 6*12 90 107 75 M4
DR012A0202 160 160 115 6*12 90 107 75 M4
DR018A0117 160 160 115 6*12 90 107 75 M4
Table 7-34
7-27
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Installing screw M5
PE MD
Tightening torque: F Nm
Figure 7-19
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A B C D1*D2 H G1 G2 PE D
Delta part #
DR024AP881 160 175 115 6*12 90 107 75 M4
DR032AP660 195 200 145 6*12 115 122 85 M6
DR038AP639 190 200 145 6*12 115 122 85 M6
DR045AP541 190 200 145 6*12 115 122 85 M6
Table 7-35
7-28
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Installing screw M6
PE M6
Tightening torque: 3±1.5 N
Figure 7-20
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
Dimensions
Delta part #
DR060AP405 Refer to the diagram above
Table 7-36
7-29
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque: 8.2–10.2 kg-cm /
[7.1–8.9 lb-in] / [0.8–1.0Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3 Nm
Figure 7-21
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A A1 B B1 B2 C D D1*D2 E C1 G1 G2 H
Delta part #
DR073AP334 228 240 215 40 170 133 8.5 7*13 152 75 176 200 97
DR091AP267 228 240 245 40 195 133 8.8 7*13 152 90 176 200 97
DR110AP221 228 240 245 40 195 138 8.5 7*13 152 75 176 200 102
Table 7-37
7-30
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque: 8.2–10.2 kg-cm /
[7.1–8.9 lb-in] / [0.8–1.0Nm]
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque: 6±0.3 Nm
Figure 7-22
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A A1 B B1 B2 C C1 D D1*D2 F G1 G2 H M*T
Delta part #
DR150AP162 240 250 245 40 200 151 105 9 11*18 160 190 220 125 20*3
DR180AP135 240 250 245 40 200 151 105 9 11*18 160 190 220 125 20*3
DR220AP110 264 270 275 50 230 151 105 9 10*18 176 200 230 106 30*3
DR260AP098 264 270 285 50 240 151 105 9 10*18 176 200 230 106 30*3
DR310AP078 300 300 345 55 295 153 105 9 10*18 200 224 260 113 30*3
DR370AP066 300 300 345 55 295 158 120 9 10*18 200 224 260 118 50*4
Table 7-38
7-31
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
PE M8 x 23
Tightening torque:
6±0.3 Nm
Terminals: 4 mm2
Tightening torque: 8.2–10.2 kg-cm /
[7.1–8.9 lb-in] / [0.8–1.0Nm]
Figure 7-23
Unit: mm
Input AC reactor
A A1 B B1 B2 C C1 D1*D2 E G1 G2 H M*T
Delta part #
DR460AP054 300 300 425 95 355 220 170 11*21 200 240 300 190 50*4
DR550AP044 300 300 445 95 375 220 170 11*21 200 240 300 190 50*4
DR616AP039 360 360 465 105 385 252 190 11*21 240 246 316 220 50*5
DR683AP036 360 360 465 105 385 252 195 11*21 240 246 316 220 50*5
DR866AP028 360 360 520 105 435 272 200 11*21 240 246 316 240 60*6
Table 7-39
7-32
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
DC Reactor
A DC reactor can also improve the power factor, reduce input current, and reduce interference
generated from the motor drive. A DC reactor stabilizes the DC bus voltage. Compared to an AC input
reactor, the advantages are smaller size, lower price, and lower voltage drop (lower power dissipation)
Installation
Install the DC reactor between terminals +2/DC+ and +1/DC+. Remove the jumper (shown below)
before installing the DC reactor.
Figure 7-24
Wiring of DC reactor
7-33
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-34
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-35
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
R
D
B
Figure 7-25
DC reactor A B C D E
Dimensions [mm]
Delta part # [mm) [mm] [mm] [mm] [mm]
DR005D0585 79 78 112 64±2 56±2 9.5*5.5
DR008D0366 79 78 112 64±2 56±2 9.5*5.5
DR011D0266 79 92 112 64±2 69.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR017D0172 79 112 112 64±2 89.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR025D0117 99 105 128 79±2 82.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR033DP851 117 110 156 95±2 87±2 10*6.5
DR049DP574 117 120 157 95±2 97±2 10*6.5
DR065DP432 117 140 157 95±2 116.5±2 10*6.5
DR075DP391 136 135 178 111±2 112±2 10*6.5
DR090DP325 136 135 179 111±2 112±2 10*6.5
DR003D1870 79 78 112 64±2 56±2 9.5*5.5
DR004D1403 79 92 112 64±2 69.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR006D0935 79 92 112 64±2 69.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR009D0623 79 112 112 64±2 89.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR010D0534 99 93 128 79±2 70±2 9.5*5.5
DR012D0467 99 105 128 79±2 82.5±2 9.5*5.5
DR018D0311 117 110 144 95±2 87±2 10*6.5
DR024D0233 117 120 144 95±2 97±2 10*6.5
DR032D0175 117 140 157 95±2 116.5±2 10*6.5
DR038D0147 136 135 172 111±2 112±2 10*6.5
DR045D0124 136 135 173 111±2 112±2 10*6.5
DR060DP935 136 150 173 111±2 127±2 10*6.5
Table 7-44
7-36
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Following table is the THDi value of Delta motor drive matching AC/DC reactors:
Models without built-in DC reactor Models with built-in DC reactor
Current No input
harmonic No AC/DC 3% input AC 5% input AC 4% DC 3% input AC 5% input AC
AC
reactor reactor reactor reactor reactor reactor
reactor
5th 73.3% 38.5% 30.8% 25.5% 31.16% 27.01% 25.5%
7th 52.74% 15.3% 9.4% 18.6% 23.18% 9.54% 8.75%
11th 7.28% 7.1% 6.13% 7.14% 8.6% 4.5% 4.2%
13th 0.4% 3.75% 3.15% 0.48% 7.9% 0.22% 0.17%
THDi 91% 43.6% 34.33% 38.2% 42.28% 30.5% 28.4%
Note THDi may have some difference due to different installation conditions (like wires or motors) and environment.
Table 7-45
AC Output Reactor
When using drives in long wiring output application, ground fault (GFF), over-current (oc) and motor
over-voltage (ov) often occur. GFF and oc cause errors due to the drive’s self-protective mechanism;
over-voltage damages motor insulation.
The excessive length of the output wires makes the grounded stray capacitance too large, increase
the three-phase output common mode current, and the reflected wave of the long wires makes the motor
dv / dt and the motor terminal voltage too high. Thus, installing a reactor on the drive’s output side can
increase the high-frequency impedance to reduce the dv / dt and terminal voltage to protect the motor.
Installation
Install an AC output reactor in series between the three output phases U V W and the motor, as
shown in the figure below:
7-37
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
200V–230V, 50 / 60 Hz
Rated Amps
Max. continuous 3% Impedance 5% Impedance 3% Input AC reactor
of AC Reactor Built-in
Amps (Arms) (mH) (mH) Delta part #
Model kW HP (Arms) DC
Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light reactor Normal Light
Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty
007 0.75 1 4.6 5 7.36 6 2.536 2.536 4.227 4.227 No DR005L0254 DR005L0254
055 5.5 7.5 17 21 27.2 25.2 0.746 0.507 1.243 0.845 No DR017LP746 DR025LP507
300 30 40 90 105 144 126 0.141 0.12 0.235 0.2 No DR090LP141 DR105LP106
370 37 50 120 146 192 175.2 0.12 0.087 0.2 0.145 Yes DR105LP106 DR146LP087
450 45 60 146 180 233.6 216 0.087 0.07 0.145 0.117 Yes DR146LP087 DR180LP070
550 55 75 180 215 288 258 0.07 0.059 0.117 0.098 Yes DR180LP070 DR215LP059
750 75 100 215 276 344 331.2 0.059 0.049 0.098 0.082 Yes DR215LP059 DR276LP049
900 90 125 255 322 408 386.4 0.049 0.037 0.082 0.062 Yes DR276LP049 DR346LP037
Table 7-46
380V–460V, 50 / 60 Hz
Rated Amps
Max. continuous 3% impedance 5% impedance 3% Input AC reactor
of AC Reactor Built-in
Amps (Arms) (mH) (mH) Delta part #
Model kW HP (Arms) DC
Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light reactor Normal Light
Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty
007 0.75 1 2.8 3 4.48 3.6 9.058 8.102 15.097 13.503 No DR003L0810*1 DR003L0810
015 1.5 2 3 4.2 4.8 5.04 8.102 6.077 13.503 10.128 No DR003L0810 DR004L0607
022 2.2 3 4 5.5 6.4 6.6 6.077 4.050 10.128 6.75 No DR004L0607 DR006L0405
037 3.7 5 6 8.5 9.6 10.2 4.050 2.700 6.75 4.5 No DR006L0405 DR009L0270
040 4 5 9 10.5 14.4 12.6 2.700 2.315 4.5 3.858 No DR009L0270 DR010L0231
055 5.5 7.5 10.5 13 16.8 15.6 2.315 2.025 3.858 3.375 No DR010L0231 DR012L0202
075 7.5 10 12 18 19.2 21.6 2.025 1.35 3.375 2.25 No DR012L0202 DR018L0117
110 11 15 18 24 28.8 28.8 1.35 1.01 2.25 1.683 No DR018L0117 DR024LP881
150 15 20 24 32 38.4 38.4 1.01 0.76 1.683 1.267 No DR024LP881 DR032LP660
185 18.5 25 32 38 51.2 45.6 0.76 0.639 1.267 1.065 No DR032LP660 DR038LP639
220 22 30 38 45 60.8 54 0.639 0.541 1.065 0.902 No DR038LP639 DR045LP541
300 30 40 45 60 72 72 0.541 0.405 0.902 0.675 No DR045LP541 DR060LP405
370 37 50 60 73 96 87.6 0.405 0.334 0.675 0.557 No DR060LP405 DR073LP334
450 45 60 73 91 116.8 109.2 0.334 0.267 0.557 0.445 Yes DR073LP334 DR091LP267
550 55 75 91 110 145.6 132 0.267 0.221 0.445 0.368 Yes DR091LP267 DR110LP221
750 75 100 110 150 176 180 0.221 0.162 0.368 0.27 Yes DR110LP221 DR150LP162
900 90 125 150 180 240 216 0.162 0.135 0.27 0.225 Yes DR150LP162 DR180LP135
1100 110 150 180 220 288 264 0.135 0.110 0.225 0.183 Yes DR180LP135 DR220LP110
7-38
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Rated Amps
Max. continuous 3% impedance 5% impedance 3% Input AC reactor
of AC Reactor Built-in
Amps (Arms) (mH) (mH) Delta part #
Model kW HP (Arms) DC
Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light Normal Light reactor Normal Light
Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty Duty
1320 132 175 220 260 352 312 0.110 0.098 0.183 0.163 Yes DR220LP110 DR260LP098
1600 160 215 260 310 416 372 0.098 0.078 0.163 0.13 Yes DR260LP098 DR310LP078
1850 185 250 310 370 496 444 0.078 0.066 0.13 0.11 Yes DR310LP078 DR370LP066
2200 220 300 370 460 592 552 0.066 0.054 0.11 0.09 Yes DR370LP066 DR460LP054
2800 280 375 460 530 736 636 0.054 0.044 0.09 0.073 Yes DR460LP054 DR550LP044
3150 315 420 550 616 880 739.2 0.044 0.039 0.073 0.065 Yes DR550LP044 DR616LP039
3550 355 475 616 683 985.6 819.6 0.039 0.036 0.065 0.06 Yes DR616LP039 DR683LP036
4500 450 600 683 770 1092.8 924 0.036 0.028 0.06 0.047 Yes DR683LP036 DR866LP028
5000 500 675 866 912 1385.6 1094.4 0.028 0.028 0.047 0.047 Yes DR866LP028 DR866LP028*2
5600 560 650 930 1094 1488 1318.2 0.026 0.022 0.043 0.037 Yes Contact Delta for more
6300 630 760 1094 1212 1750.4 1454.4 0.022 0.020 0.037 0.033 Yes information
*Note 1: Use with DR003A0810, but the inductance value will be 3% short.
*Note 2: Use with DR866AP028, the value is 5.3% greater than the rated current, which may cause slightly over-heat.
Table 7-47
575V, 50 / 60 Hz, 3-phase
Rated Amps of Max.
3% impedance (mH) 5% impedance (mH)
AC Reactor (Arms) continuous
Model kW HP
Normal Light Amps Normal Light Normal Light
Duty Duty (Arms) Duty Duty Duty Duty
015 1.5 2 2.5 3 4.2 10.567 8.806 17.612 14.677
022 2.2 3 3.6 4.3 5.9 7.338 6.144 12.230 10.239
037 3.7 5 5.5 6.7 9.1 4.803 3.943 8.005 6.572
055 5.5 7.5 8.2 9.9 13.7 3.222 2.668 5.369 4.447
075 7.5 10 10 12.1 16.5 2.642 2.183 4.403 3.639
110 11 15 15.5 18.7 25.7 1.704 1.413 2.841 2.355
150 15 20 20 24.2 33.3 1.321 1.092 2.201 1.819
Table 7-48
690V, 50 / 60 Hz, 3-phase
Rated Amps of Max. continuous
3% impedance (mH) 5% impedance (mH)
Model kW HP AC Reactor (Arms) Amps (Arms)
Normal Duty Light Duty Normal Duty Light Duty Normal Duty Light Duty Normal Duty Light Duty
185 18.5 25 20 24 30.0 28.8 1.902 1.585 3.170 2.642
220 22 30 24 30 36.0 36.0 1.585 1.268 2.642 2.113
300 30 40 30 36 45.0 43.2 1.268 1.057 2.113 1.761
370 37 50 36 45 54.0 54.0 1.057 0.845 1.761 1.409
450 45 60 45 54 67.5 64.8 0.845 0.704 1.409 1.174
550 55 75 54 67 81.0 80.4 0.704 0.568 1.174 0.946
750 75 100 67 86 100.5 103.2 0.568 0.442 0.946 0.737
900 90 125 86 104 129.0 124.8 0.442 0.366 0.737 0.610
1100 110 150 104 125 156.0 150.0 0.366 0.304 0.610 0.507
1320 132 175 125 150 187.5 180.0 0.304 0.254 0.507 0.423
1600 160 215 150 180 225.0 216.0 0.254 0.211 0.423 0.352
2000 200 270 180 220 270.0 264.0 0.211 0.173 0.352 0.288
2500 250 335 220 290 330.0 348.0 0.173 0.131 0.288 0.219
7-39
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-40
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
PE Screw
Torque: 10.2–12.3 kg-cm / [8.9–10.6 lb-in] /
Torque: 6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8 Nm] [1.0–1.2 Nm]
Figure 7-27
Unit: mm
Output AC reactor Delta
A B C D1*D2 E G1 G2 PE D
part #
DR005L0254 96 110 70 6*9 42 60 40 M4
DR008L0159 120 135 96 6*12 60 80.5 60 M4
DR011L0115 120 135 96 6*12 60 80.5 60 M4
DR017LP746 120 135 105 6*12 65 80.5 60 M4
DR025LP507 150 160 120 6*12 88 107 75 M4
DR033LP320 150 160 120 6*12 88 107 75 M4
Table 7-50
7-41
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 16mm2
Tightening torque: 1.2–1.4Nm
Figure 7-28
Unit: mm
Output AC reactor
A B C D1*D2 H G G1 Q M PE D
Delta part #
DR049LP215 180 205 175 6*12 115 85 122 16 1.2–1.4 M4
DR065LP162 180 215 185 6*12 115 85 122 35 2.5–3.0 M4
Table 7-51
7-42
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-29
Unit: mm
DR075LP170 240 228 215 44 170 151 100 7*13 152 176 85 20*3
DR090LP141 240 228 215 44 170 151 100 7*13 152 176 85 20*3
DR105LP106 240 228 215 44 170 165 110 7*13 152 176 97 20*3
DR146LP087 240 228 240 45 202 165 110 7*13 152 176 97 30*3
DR180LP070 250 240 250 46 205 175 110 11*18 160 190 124 30*5
DR215LP059 250 240 275 51 226 180 120 11*18 160 190 124 30*5
Table 7-52
7-43
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-30
Unit: mm
Output AC reactor Delta
A A1 B B1 B2 C C1 D1*D2 E H M*T
part #
DR276LP049 270 260 320 50 265 200 140 10*18 176 106 30*5
DR3466LP037 270 265 340 50 285 200 140 10*18 176 106 30*5
Table 7-53
7-44
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
PE screw
Torque: 10.2–12.3 kg-cm / [8.9–10.6 lb-in] /
Torque: 6.1–8.2 kg-cm / [5.3–7.1 lb-in] / [0.6–0.8 Nm]
[1.0–1.2 Nm]
Figure 7-31
Unit: mm
Output AC reactor Delta
A B C D1*D2 H G1 G2 PE D
part #
DR003L0810 96 115 65 6*9 42 60 40 M4
DR004L0607 120 135 95 6*12 60 80.5 60 M4
DR006L0405 120 135 95 6*12 60 80.5 60 M4
DR009L0270 150 160 100 6*12 74 107 75 M4
DR010L0231 150 160 115 6*12 88 107 75 M4
DR012L0202 150 160 115 6*12 88 107 75 M4
DR018L0117 150 160 115 6*12 88 107 75 M4
DR024LP881 150 160 115 6*12 88 107 75 M4
DR032LP660 180 190 145 6*12 114 122 85 M6
Table 7-54
7-45
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Terminals: 16mm2
Tightening torque: 1.2–1.4Nm
Figure 7-32
Unit: mm
7-46
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-33
Unit: mm
Output AC reactor Delta
A A1 B B1 B2 C C1 D1*D2 E G1 H M*T
part #
DR060LP405 240 228 215 44 170 163 110 7*13 152 176 97 20*3
DR073LP334 250 235 235 44 186 174 115 11*18 160 190 124 20*3
DR091LP267 250 240 235 44 186 174 115 11*18 160 190 124 20*3
DR110LP221 270 260 245 50 192 175 115 10*18 176 200 106 20*3
Table 7-56
7-47
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-34
Unit: mm
Output AC reactor Delta
A A1 B B1 B2 C C1 D1*D2 E G1 G2 H M*T
part #
DR150LP162 270 264 265 51 208 192 125 10*18 176 200 / 118 30*3
DR180LP135 300 295 310 55 246 195 125 11*22 200 230 190 142 30*3
DR220LP110 300 298 310 57 248 210 140 11*22 200 230 190 142 30*5
DR260LP098 300 295 330 56 270 227 140 11*22 200 230 190 160 30*5
DR310LP078 300 298 350 54 288 233 145 11*22 200 230 190 160 30*5
DR370LP066 300 298 350 54 289 268 170 11*22 200 230 190 185 40*5
Table 7-57
7-48
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-35
Unit: mm
7-49
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
The following table list the suggested motor shielded cable length that comply with IEC 60034-17,
which is suitable for the motor with rated voltage under 500 VAC, and the insulation level of peak-to-peak
over (including) 1.35 kV
Rated current
Without AC output reactor 3% With AC output reactor
230V (Arms)
kW HP
Model Normal Light Shielded Cable Non-shielded cable Shielded Cable Non-shielded cable
Duty Duty [meter] [meter] [meter] [meter]
007 0.75 1 4.6 5 50 75 75 115
015 1.5 2 5 7.5 50 75 75 115
022 2.2 3 8 10 50 75 75 115
037 3.7 5 11 15 50 75 75 115
040 4 5 17 21 50 75 75 115
055 5.5 7.5 25 31 100 150 150 225
075 7.5 10 33 46 100 150 150 225
150 15 20 49 61 100 150 150 225
185 18.5 25 65 75 100 150 150 225
220 22 30 75 90 100 150 150 225
300 30 40 90 120 100 150 150 225
370 37 50 120 146 100 150 150 225
450 45 60 146 180 150 225 225 325
550 55 75 180 215 150 225 225 325
750 75 100 215 276 150 225 225 325
900 90 125 255 322 150 225 225 325
Table 7-59
7-50
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Rated current
Without AC output reactor 3% With AC output reactor
460V (Arms)
kW HP
Model Normal Light Shielded Cable Non-shielded cable Shielded Cable Non-shielded cable
Duty Duty [meter] [meter] [meter] [meter]
007 0.75 1 1.7 3 50 75 75 115
015 1.5 2 3 4.2 50 75 75 115
022 2.2 3 4 5.5 50 75 75 115
037 3.7 5 6 8.5 50 75 75 115
040 4 5 9 10.5 50 75 75 115
055 5.5 7.5 10.5 13 50 75 75 115
075 7.5 10 12 18 100 150 150 225
110 11 15 18 24 100 150 150 225
150 15 20 24 32 100 150 150 225
185 18.5 25 32 38 100 150 150 225
220 22 30 38 45 100 150 150 225
300 30 40 45 60 100 150 150 225
370 37 50 60 73 100 150 150 225
450 45 60 73 91 150 225 225 325
550 55 75 91 110 150 225 225 325
750 75 100 110 150 150 225 225 325
900 90 125 150 180 150 225 225 325
1100 110 150 180 220 150 225 225 325
1320 132 175 220 260 150 225 225 325
1600 160 215 260 310 150 225 225 325
1850 185 250 310 370 150 225 225 325
2200 220 300 370 460 150 225 225 325
2800 280 375 460 530 150 225 225 325
3150 315 420 550 616 150 225 225 325
3550 355 475 616 683 150 225 225 325
4000 400 536 683 770 150 225 225 325
5000 500 675 866 912 150 225 225 325
5600 560 650 930 1094 150 225 225 325
6300 630 750 1094 1212 150 225 225 325
Table 7-60
7-51
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-36
Figure 7-37
7-52
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Sine-wave filter
When there is longer cable length connected between the motor drive and the motor, the damping
leads to high frequency resonator, and makes impedance matching poor to enlarge the voltage
reflection. This phenomenon will generate twice-input voltage in the motor side, which will easily make
motor voltage overshoot to damage insulation.
To prevent this, installing sine-wave filter can transform PWM output voltage to smooth and
low-ripple sin wave, and motor cable length can be longer than 1000 meters.
Installation
Sine-wave filter is serially connected between motor drive UVW output side and motor, which is
shown as below:
AC motor drive
Figure 7-39
Wiring of non-shielded cable
AC motor drive
Figure 7-40
Wiring of shielded cable
7-53
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-54
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-55
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-56
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
G
B
C
D F
A E
Unit: mm [inch]
G
B
H
C
D E
Unit: mm [inch]
Unit: mm [inch]
Model A B C D E F G[Ø] H I
241 217[ 114 155 42 220 6.5 7.0 20
RF300X00A
[9.488] 8.543] [4.488] [6.102] [1.654] [8.661] [0.256] [0.276] [0.787]
Table 7-69
7-57
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-43
Model A B C Application
T60006L2040W453 22.5 43.1 18.5 Motor cable
T60006L2050W565 36.3 53.5 23.4 Motor cable
T60006L2160V066 166.9 123.9 30.5 Motor cable
T60004L2016W620 10.7 17.8 8.0 Signal cable
T60004L2025W622 17.5 27.3 12.3 Signal cable
Table 7-70
Diagram A
Please put all wires through at least one core without winding.
Zero Phase Reactor
R/L1 U/T1
S/L2 V/T1 MOTOR
T/L3 W/T1
Note 1: The table above gives approximate wire size for the zero phase reactors, but the selection is ultimately
governed by the type and diameter of cable fitted i.e. the cable must fit through the center hole of zero
phase reactors.
Note 2: Only the phase conductors should pass through, not the earth core or screen.
Note 3: When using long motor output cables, an output zero phase reactor may be required to reduce radiated
emissions from the cable.
7-58
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
230V/460V Series
CE Cable Radiation
Input Zero Phase* Reactor
Applicable EMC Carrier Length Emission
Frame Model Current
Filter Input Side Output Side Frequency default carrier frequency
[A]
(R/S/T) (U/V/W) C1 C2 EN61800-3
VFD007CP23A 6.4
VFD015CP23A 9.6
EMF021A23A
A VFD022CP23A 15 RF008X00A RF008X00A
VFD037CP23A 22
≦8kHz
VFD055CP23A 25
VFD075CP23A 35 EMF056A23A
B VFD110CP23A 50 RF004X00A RF004X00A
VFD150CP23A 65
VFD185CP23A 83 KMF3100A
C VFD220CP23A 100
VFD300CP23A 116 N/A RF002X00A ≦6kHz
B84143D0150R127
VFD370CP23A 146
D
VFD450CP23A 180
B84143B0250S020
VFD550CP23A 215
E VFD750CP23A 276 N/A RF300X00A ≦4kHz
B84143B0400S020 50m 100m C2
VFD900CP23A 322
VFD007CP43A 4.3
VFD015CP43B 6
EMF014A43A
VFD022CP43B 8.1
≦8kHz
A VFD037CP43B 12.4 RF008X00A RF008X00A
VFD040CP43A 16
VFD055CP43B 20
VFD075CP43B 22 EMF039A43A
VFD110CP43B 26
≦8kHz
B VFD150CP43B 35 RF004X00A RF004X00A
VFD185CP43B 42
VFD220CP43A 50 KMF370A
C VFD300CP43B 66
N/A RF002X00A ≦6kHz
VFD370CP43B 80
B84143D0150R127
D0 VFD450CP43S 91
D0 VFD550CP43S 110
B84143D0150R127 ≦6kHz
VFD750CP43B 150 N/A RF002X00A
D
VFD900CP43A 180
B84143D0200R127
VFD1100CP43A 220
E
VFD1320CP43B 260
VFD1600CP43A 310 MIF3400B
F
VFD1850CP43B 370 50m 100m Pass
VFD2200CP43A 460 ≦4kHz
G N/A RF300X00A
VFD2800CP43A 530
VFD3150CP43A 616 MIF3800
VFD3550CP43A 683
VFD4000CP43A 770
VFD5000CP43A 930 B84143B1000S020
H
VFD5600CP43A-00 1094
VFD5600CP43C-21 1094
B84143B1600S020 Contact Delta for more information
VFD6300CP43A-00 1212
VFD6300CP43C-21 1212
Table 7-71
7-59
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
460V Series
Radiation
CP2000 Zero Phase Reactor Conducted Emission
Emission
Rated Applicable EMC Carrier Output Shielded
Input Filter Input Side Output Side Freq. Cable Length
Frame Model EN61800-3
Current (R/S/T) (U/V/W)
EN618000-3 C2
[A]
VFD450CP43S 91
D0 B84143B0120R110 N/A *C2
VFD550CP43S 110 ≤6kHz 25m
VFD750CP43B 150 N/A
D B84143B0180S020 *C3
VFD900CP43A 180
VFD1100CP43A 220 B84143B0250S020
E
VFD1320CP43B 260 B84143B0320S020 B64290L0084X830 ≤4kHz
VFD1600CP43A 310
F B84143B0400S020 RF300X00A C2
VFD1850CP43B 370
or
VFD2200CP43A 460 T60006L2160V066 13m
G B84143B0600S020
VFD2800CP43A 530
VFD3150CP43A 616
≤2kHz
VFD3550CP43A 683
B84143B1000S020 *C3
VFD4000CP43A 770
VFD5000CP43A 930
H
VFD5600CP43A-00 1094
VFD4500CP43C-21 1094
B84143B1600S020 Contact Delta for more information
VFD6300CP43A-00 1212
VFD6300CP43C-21 1212
*For radiated emission, the drive needs to be placed inside a cabinet. Table 7-72
Radiation
CP2000 Zero Phase Reactor Conducted Emission
Emission
Rated Applicable EMC Carrier Output Shielded
Input Filter Input Side Output Side Freq. Cable Length
Frame Model EN61800-3
Current (R/S/T) (U/V/W)
EN618000-3 C3
[A]
VFD450CP43S 91
D0 B84143A0120R105 C3
VFD550CP43S 110 ≤6kHz
VFD750CP43B 150
D B84143B0180S080 *C3
VFD900CP43A 180
VFD1100CP43A 220 B84143B0250S080
E 150m
VFD1320CP43B 260 B84143B0320S080
VFD1600CP43A 310
F B84143B0400S080 N/A N/A
VFD1850CP43B 370
VFD2200CP43A 460 ≤4kHz
G B84143B0600S080 C3
VFD2800CP43A 530
VFD3150CP43A 616
VFD3550CP43A 683
B84143B1000S080 100m
VFD4000CP43A 770
VFD5000CP43A 930
H
VFD5600CP43A-00 1094
VFD4500CP43C-21 1094
B84143B1600S080 Contact Delta for more information
VFD6300CP43A-00 1212
VFD6300CP43C-21 1212
*For radiated emission, the drive needs to be placed inside a cabinet. Table 7-73
7-60
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
575V/690V Series
Input CE Cable Length Radiation Emission
Zero Phase*
Frame Model Current Applicable EMC Filter default carrier frequency
Reactor
[A] C1 C2 EN61800-3
VFD022CP53A-21 5.4 EMF008A63A
A
VFD037CP53A-21 10.4 EMF014A63A
VFD055CP53A-21 14.9
RF008X00A
VFD075CP53A-21 16.9
B EMF027A63A
VFD110CP53A-21 21.3
VFD150CP53A-21 26.3
VFD185CP63A-21 29
VFD220CP63A-21 36
C
VFD300CP63A-21 43
VFD370CP63A-21 54 B84143A0050R021 RF002X00A
50m 100m C2
VFD450CP63A-00
54
VFD450CP63A-21
D
VFD550CP63A-00
67
VFD550CP63A-21
VFD750CP63A-00
84
VFD750CP63A-21
B84143A0120R021
VFD900CP63A-00
102
VFD900CP63A-21
E
VFD1100CP63A-00
122
VFD1100CP63A-21
B84143B0150S021 RF300X00A
VFD1320CP63A-00
147
VFD1320CP63A-21
VFD1600CP63A-00
178
VFD1600CP63A-21
F B84143B0250S021
VFD2000CP63A-00
217
VFD2000CP63A-21
VFD2500CP63A-00
292
VFD2500CP63A-21
G B84143B0400S021
VFD3150CP63A-00
353
VFD3150CP63A-21
VFD4000CP63A-00
454
VFD4000CP63A-21
H B84143B0600S021 RF300X00A 50m 100m C2
VFD4500CP63A-00
469
VFD4500CP63A-21
VFD5600CP63A-00
595 B84143B0600S021
VFD5600CP63A-21
H
VFD6300CP63A-00
681 B84143B1000S021
VFD6300CP63A-21
* For Frame A–C: On both input and output side, a zero phase reactor is required to be wired to the motor drive. Table 7-74
There should be in total 2 zero phase reactors.
For Frame D–H: Only one zero phase reactor is required to be wired on the output side of the motor drive.
7-61
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-45
7-62
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-46
7-63
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-47
7-64
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-48
7-65
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-49
7-66
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-50
7-67
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-51
Figure 7-52
7-68
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 7-53
Figure 7-54
Unit: mm
7-69
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Following table is the suggested shielded cable length of EMC built-in models. User can choose
corresponding shielded cable length in accord to required noise emission and electromagnetic
interference level.
Comply with EMC (IEC 61800-3) Comply with EMC (IEC 61800-3)
EMC built-in model Rated current Class C3 Class C2
(ND)
Frame Model Shielded cable length Fc Shielded cable length Fc
VFD007CP4EA-21 3.5
VFD015CP4EB-21 4.3
VFD022CP4EB-21 5.9
A
VFD037CP4EB-21 8.7
VFD040CP4EA-21 14 ≤ 8kHz ≤ 8kHz
VFD055CP4EB-21 15.5
30m 10m
VFD075CP4EB-21 17
B VFD110CP4EB -21 20
VFD150CP4EB -21 26
VFD185CP4EB -21 35
C VFD220CP4EA -21 40 ≤ 6kHz ≤ 6kHz
VFD300CP4EB -21 47
Table 7-75
* Shielded cable length of Frame A should not longer than 30m and Frame B, C not longer than 50m to prevent cable length
from being too long, which may cause built-in EMC filter malfunction due to overheat resulting from leakage current and
larger wires parasitic capacitance.
7-70
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 1
Figure 2
7-71
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-72
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-73
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Model number『MKC-D0N1CB』
ITEM Description Qty.
1 Screw M5*0.8*10L 4
2 Bushing Rubber 28 2
3 Bushing Rubber 44 2
4 Bushing Rubber 73 2
5 Conduit box cover 1
6 Conduit box base 1
Table 7-78
Frame D
Applicable models:
VFD370CP23A-00, VFD450CP23A-00, VFD750CP43B-00, VFD900CP43A-00, VFD370CP23A-21,
VFD450CP23A-21, VFD750CP43B-21, VFD900CP43A-21, VFD450CP63A-00, VFD550CP63A-00,
VFD450CP63A-21, VFD550CP63A-21
Model number『MKC-DN1CB』
ITEM Description Qty.
1 Screw M5*0.8*10L 4
2 Bushing Rubber 28 2
3 Bushing Rubber 44 2
4 Bushing Rubber 88 2
5 Conduit box cover 1
6 Conduit box base 1
Table 7-79
Frame E
Applicable models:
VFD550CP23A-00, VFD750CP23A-00, VFD900CP23A-00, VFD1100CP43A-00, VFD1320CP43B-00,
VFD550CP23A-21, VFD750CP23A-21, VFD900CP23A-21, VFD1100CP43A-21, VFD1320CP43B-21,
VFD750CP63A-00, VFD900CP63A-00, VFD1100CP63A-00, VFD1320CP63A-00, VFD750CP63A-21,
VFD900CP63A-21, VFD1100CP63A-21, VFD1320CP63A-21
Model number『MKC-EN1CB』
ITEM Description Qty.
1 Screw M5*0.8*10L 6
2 Bushing Rubber 28 2
3 Bushing Rubber 44 4
4 Bushing Rubber 100 2
5 Conduit box cover 1
6 Conduit box base 1
Table 7-80
7-74
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame F
Applicable models:
VFD1600CP43A-00, VFD1850CP43B-00, VFD1600CP43A-21, VFD1850CP43B-21, VFD1600CP63A-00,
VFD2000CP63A-00, VFD1600CP63A-21, VFD2000CP63A-21
Model number『MKC-FN1CB』
ITEM Description Qty.
1 Screw M5*0.8*10L 8
2 Bushing Rubber 28 2
3 Bushing Rubber 44 4
4 Bushing Rubber 100 2
5 Conduit box cover 1
6 Conduit box base 1
Table 7-81
Frame G
Applicable models:
VFD2200CP43A-00, VFD2800CP43A-00, VFD2200CP43A-21, VFD2800CP43A-21,
VFD2500CP63A-00, VFD3150CP63A-00, VFD2500CP63A-21, VFD3150CP63A-21
型號『MKC-GN1CB』
ITEM Description Qty.
1 Screw M5*0.8*10L 12
2 Bushing Rubber 28 2
3 Bushing Rubber 44 2
4 Bushing Rubber 130 3
5 Conduit box cover 1
6 Conduit box base 1
Table 7-82
7-75
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame H
Applicable models:
VFD3150CP43A-00, VFD3550CP43A-00, VFD4000CP43A-00, VFD5000CP43A-00, VFD5600CP43A-00,
VFD6300CP43A-00, VFD3150CP43C-00, VFD3550CP43C-00, VFD4000CP43C-00, VFD5000CP43C-00,
VFD3150CP43C-21, VFD3550CP43C-21, VFD4000CP43C-21, VFD5000CP43C-21, VFD5600CP43C-21,
VFD6300CP43C-21, VFD4000CP63A-00, VFD4500CP63A-00, VFD5600CP63A-00, VFD6300CP63A-00,
VFD4000CP63A-21, VFD4500CP63A-21, VFD5600CP63A-21, VFD6300CP63A-21
Model number『MKC-HN1CB』
ITEM Description Qty.
ITEM 1
1 Screw M6*1.0*25L 8
ITEM 2
2 Screw M8*1.25*30L 3 ITEM 3
ITEM 14
3 NUT M8 4 ITEM 4
4 NUT M10 4
5 Bushing Rubber 28 4
6 Bushing Rubber 44 2
7 Bushing Rubber 130 4
8 Conduit box cover 1 1
9 Conduit box cover 2 2 ITEM 6
ITEM 5
10 Conduit box cover 3 2 ITEM 5
11 Conduit box cover 4 2
ITEM 6
12 Conduit box base 1 ITEM 5
13 Accessories 1 2 ITEM 5
14 Accessories 2 1
Table 7-83
ITEM 7
ITEM 7
ITEM 10
ITEM 7
ITEM 10
ITEM 9 ITEM 7
ITEM 13
ITEM 12
ITEM 11
ITEM 11
ITEM 8
ITEM 9
ITEM 13
7-76
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
2. Remove the 5 screws shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] /
[2.4–2.5 Nm]
3. Install the conduit box by fasten the 5 screws shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm /
[20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
4. Fasten the 2 screws shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
7-77
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame D
1. Loosen the cover screws and press the tabs on each side of the cover to remove the cover, as shown in the
following figure. Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
2. Remove the 5 screws shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] /
[2.4–2.5 Nm]
3. Install the conduit box by fasten the 5 screws shown in the following figure.
Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
4. Fasten the 2 screws shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
7-78
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame E
1. Loosen the 4 cover screws and lift the cover; Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
2. Fasten the 6 screws shown in the following figure and place the cover back to the original position. Screw
torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
3. Fasten the 4 screws shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
7-79
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame F
1. Loosen the cover screws and press the tabs on each side of the cover to remove the cover, as shown in the
following figure. Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
1
2
2. Install the conduit box by fastens the 4 screws, as shown in the following figure.
Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
3. Install the conduit box by fasten all the screws shown in the following figure
Screw 9–12 torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
Screw 13–16 torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
12
15
9
10
13
14
16
11
7-80
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame G
1. On the conduit box, loosen 7 of the cover screws and remove the cover.
Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm].
2. On the drive, loosen 4 of the cover screws and press the tabs on each side of the cover to remove the cover,
as shown in the following figure. Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
1
2
4 Install the conduit box by fastening all the screws shown in the following figure.
M5 Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
M8 Screw torque: 100–120 kg-cm / [86.7–104.1 Ib-in] / [9.8–11.8 Nm]
7-81
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
5. Fasten all the screws. Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
6. Place the cover back to the top and fasten the screws (as shown in the figure).
Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
7-82
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame H
Assembly for Frame H3 (Conduit Box Kit)
1. Loosen the screws and remove the cover of conduit box H3 as preparation.
7-83
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
4. Install the conduit box by fasten all the screws shown in the following figure
Screw 1–6: M6 screw torque: 55–65 kg-cm / [47.7–56.4 Ib-in] / [5.4–6.4 Nm]
Screw 7–9: M8 screw torque: 100–110 kg-cm / [86.7–95.4 Ib-in] / [9.8–10.8 Nm]
Screw 10–13: M10 screw torque: 250–300 kg-cm / [216.9–260.3 Ib-in] / [24.5–29.4 Nm]
Screw 14–17: M8 screw torque: 100–110 kg-cm / [86.7–95.4 Ib-in] / [9.8–10.8 Nm]
7 8 9
3 6
2 5
1 4
14
15
16
10 11 12 13 17
3
7
2
12
7-84
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
5. Fasten the 3 covers and screws, which are loosen from step1, to the original location.
Screw torque: 35–45 kg-cm / [30.3–39 Ib-in.] / [3.4–4.4 Nm]
6. Installation complete.
7-85
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
2. Remove the 4 covers of conduit box, and fasten the loosen screws back to the original location.
Screw torque: 100–110 kg-cm / [86.7–95.4 Ib-in] / [9.8–10.8 Nm]
7-86
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
5. Install conduit box and accessories by fasten all the screws shown in the following figure.
Screws 1–6: M6 screw torque: 55–65 kg-cm / [47.7–56.4 Ib-in] / [5.4–6.4 Nm]
Screws 7–9: M8 screw torque: 100–110 kg-cm / [86.7–95.4 Ib-in] / [9.8–10.8 Nm]
Screws 10–13: M10 screw torque: 250–300 kg-cm / [216.9–260.3 Ib-in] / [24.5–29.4 Nm]
Screws 14–17: M8 screw torque: 100–110 kg-cm / [86.7–95.4 Ib-in] / [9.8–10.8 Nm]
7 8 9
3 6
2 5
1 4
14
15
10 11 12 13 16
17
3
7
2
12
7-87
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
6. Installation complete.
7-88
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable Model
VFD022CP23A-21; VFD037CP23A-21;
VFD055CP23A-21; VFD022CP43B-21;
VFD022CP4EB-21; VFD037CP43B-21;
VFD037CP4EB-21; VFD040CP43A-21;
VFD040CP4EA-21; VFD055CP43B-21;
VFD055CP4EB-21; VFD015CP53A-21;
VFD022CP53A-21; VFD037CP53A-21
Applicable Model
VFD075CP43B-21; VFD075CP4EB-21
Applicable Model
VFD075CP23A-21; VFD110CP43B-21;
VFD110CP4EB-21; VFD055CP53A-21;
VFD075CP53A-21; VFD110CP53A-21;
VFD150CP53A-21
Applicable Model
MKC-BFKM2:
VFD110CP23A-21; VFD150CP43B-21;
VFD150CP4EB-21; VFD185CP43B-21;
VFD185CP4EB-21
MKC-BFKM3:
VFD150CP23A-21
(The MKC-BFKM2 and MKC-BFKM 3 have the same shape)
7-89
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable Model
VFD075CP23A-21; VFD110CP23A-21;
VFD110CP43B-21; VFD110CP4EB-21;
VFD150CP23A-21; VFD150CP43B-21;
VFD150CP4EB-21; VFD185CP43B-21;
VFD185CP4EB-21; VFD055CP53A-21;
VFD075CP53A-21; VFD110CP53A-21;
VFD150CP53A-21
Applicable Model
VFD185CP23A-21; VFD220CP23A-21;
VFD300CP23A-21; VFD185CP63A-21;
VFD220CP63A-21; VFD300CP63A-21;
VFD370CP63A-21
Applicable Model
VFD220CP43A-21; VFD220CP4EA-21;
VFD300CP43B-21; VFD300CP4EB-21;
VFD370CP43B-21; VFD370CP4EB-21
7-90
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
VFD185CP63A-21; VFD220CP63A-21;
VFD300CP63A-21; VFD370CP63A-21
Applicable Model
VFD450CP43S-00; VFD450CP43S-21;
VFD550CP43S-00; VFD550CP43S-21
VFD370CP23A-00; VFD370CP23A-21;
VFD450CP23A-00; VFD450CP23A-21;
VFD750CP43B-00; VFD750CP43B-21;
VFD900CP43A-00; VFD900CP43A-21
VFD450CP63A-00; VFD450CP63A-21;
VFD550CP63A-00; VFD550CP63A-21
Applicable Model
VFD550CP23A-00; VFD550CP23A-21;
VFD750CP23A-00; VFD750CP23A-21
7-91
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable Model
VFD900CP23A-00; VFD900CP23A-21;
VFD1100CP43A-00; VFD1100CP43A-21;
VFD1320CP43B-00; VFD1320CP43B-21
Applicable Model
VFD750CP63A-00; VFD750CP63A-21;
VFD900CP63A-00; VFD900CP63A-21;
VFD1100CP63A-00; VFD1100CP63A-21;
VFD1320CP63A-00; VFD1320CP63A-21
Applicable Model
VFD550CP23A-00; VFD550CP23A-21;
VFD750CP23A-00; VFD750CP23A-21;
VFD900CP23A-00; VFD900CP23A-21;
VFD1100CP43A-00; VFD1100CP43A-21;
VFD1320CP43B-00; VFD1320CP43B-21;
VFD900CP63A-00; VFD900CP63A-21;
VFD1100CP63A-00; VFD1100CP63A-21;
VFD1320CP63A-00; VFD1320CP63A-21
Applicable Model
VFD1600CP43A-00; VFD1600CP43A-21;
VFD1850CP43B-00; VFD1850CP43B-21;
VFD1600CP63A-00; VFD1600CP63A-21;
VFD2000CP63A-00; VFD2000CP63A-21
7-92
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable Model
VFD1600CP43A-00; VFD1600CP43A-21;
VFD1850CP43B-00; VFD1850CP43B-21
VFD1600CP63A-00; VFD1600CP63A-21;
VFD2000CP63A-00; VFD2000CP63A-21
Applicable Model
VFD2200CP43A-00; VFD2200CP43A-21;
VFD2800CP43A-00; VFD2800CP43A-21
VFD2500CP63A-00; VFD2500CP63A-21;
VFD3150CP63A-00; VFD3150CP63A-21
Applicable Model
Applicable Model
7-93
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Applicable Model
7-94
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Fan Removal
Frame A
Model『MKC-AFKM』: Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
VFD022CP23A-21; VFD037CP23A-21; VFD055CP23A-21; VFD022CP43B-21; VFD022CP4EB-21;
VFD037CP43B-21; VFD037CP4EB-21; VFD040CP43A-21; VFD040CP4EA-21; VFD055CP43B-21;
VFD055CP4EB-21; VFD015CP53A-21; VFD022CP53A-21; VFD037CP53A-21
1. Refer to Figure 1, press the tabs on both side of the 2. Disconnect the power terminal before removing the
fan to successfully remove the fan. fan. (As shown below.)
Figure 1
Figure 2
Frame B
Model『MKC-BFKM1』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
VFD075CP23A-21; VFD110CP43B-21; VFD110CP4EB-21; VFD055CP53A-21; VFD075CP53A-21;
VFD110CP53A-21; VFD150CP53A-21
Figure 1 Figure 2
7-95
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame B
Model『MKC-BFKB』Capacitor Fan
Applicable model
VFD075CP23A-21; VFD110CP23A-21; VFD110CP43B-21; VFD110CP4EB-21; VFD150CP23A-21;
VFD150CP43B-21; VFD150CP4EB-21; VFD185CP43B-21; VFD185CP4EB-21; VFD055CP53A-21;
VFD075CP53A-21; VFD110CP53A-21; VFD150CP53A-21
Disconnect fan power and pull out the fan by using flathead screwdriver. (As shown in the larger picture)
Frame C
Model『MKC-CFKM』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
Single fan kit applicable models (only fan kit 1 is required to be installed):
VFD220CP43A-21; VFD220CP4EA-21; VFD300CP43B-21; VFD300CP4EB-21; VFD370CP43B-21;
Dual fan kit applicable models (both fan kit 1 and 2 are required to be installed):
VFD185CP23A-21; VFD220CP23A-21; VFD300CP23A-21; VFD370CP4EB-21
Figure 1
7-96
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
2. (As shown in Figure 2), remove the power connector, loosen the screw and remove the fan kit. When installing
the fan kit, have the label on the fan kit facing inside of the motor drive.
Screw’s torque: 10–12 kg-cm / [8.7–10.4 lb-in.] / [1.0–1.2 Nm]
Figure 2
Frame C
Model『MKC-CFKB1』Capacitor Fan
Applicable model
VFD185CP23A-21; VFD220CP23A-21; VFD300CP23A-21; VFD185CP63A-21; VFD220CP63A-21;
VFD300CP63A-21; VFD370CP63A-21
Model『MKC-CFKB2』Capacitor Fan
Applicable model
VFD220CP43A-21; VFD220CP4EA-21; VFD300CP43B-21; VFD300CP4EB-21; VFD370CP43B-21;
VFD370CP4EB-21
Model『MKC-CFKB3』Capacitor Fan
Applicable model
VFD185CP63A-21; VFD220CP63A-21; VFD300CP63A-21; VFD370CP63A-21
Disconnect fan power and pull out the fan by using flathead screwdriver. (As shown in the larger picture)
Figure 1
7-97
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame D0
Model『MKC-DFKB』Capacitor Fan
Applicable model
VFD450CP43S-00; VFD450CP43S-21; VFD550CP43S-00; VFD550CP43S-21
1. Loosen screw 1 and screw 2, press the tabs on the 2. (Figure 2) Loosen screw 3, press the tabs on the
right and left to remove the cover, follow the right and the left to remove the cover. Screw 3
direction the arrows indicate. Press on top of digital Torque: 6–8 kg-cm / [5.2–6.9 lb-in.] / [0.6–0.8 Nm]
keypad to properly remove it. Screw 1, 2 Torque:
12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 lb-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
3
1
2
Figure 1 Figure 2
3. Loosen screw 4 (figure 3) and disconnect fan power and pull out the fan. (As shown in the enlarged picture 3)
Screw 4 Torque: 10–12 kg-cm / [8.7–10.4 lb-in.] / [1.0–1.2 Nm]
Figure 3
Frame D0
Model『MKC-D0FKM』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
VFD450CP43S-00; VFD450CP43S-21; VFD550CP43S-00; VFD550CP43S-21
1. Loosen the screw and remove the fan kit. Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 lb-in. / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
2. (As shown Figure 1) Before removing the fan, remove the cover by using a slotted screwdriver.
1
2
3
4
Figure 1
7-98
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame D
Model『MKC-DFKB』Capacitor Fan
Applicable model
VFD370CP23A-00; VFD370CP23A-21; VFD450CP23A-00; VFD450CP23A-21; VFD750CP43B-00;
VFD750CP43B-21; VFD900CP43A-00; VFD900CP43A-21; VFD450CP63A-00; VFD450CP63A-21;
VFD550CP63A-00; VFD550CP63A-21
1. Loosen screw 1 and screw 2, press the tab on the 2. (Figure 2) Loosen screw 3, press the tab on the right
right and the left to remove the cover, follow the and the left to remove the cover.
direction the arrows indicate. Press on top of digital Screw 3, 4 Torque: 6–8 kg-cm / [5.2–6.9 lb-in.] /
keypad to properly remove it. Screw 1, 2 Torque: [0.6–0.8 Nm]
12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 lb-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
4
3
1
2
Figure 2
Figure 1
3. Loosen screw 5 (figure 3) and disconnect fan power and pull out the fan. (As shown in the enlarged picture 3)
Screw 5 Torque: 10–12 kg-cm / [8.6–10.4 lb-in.] / [1.0–1.2 Nm]
Figure 3
Frame D
Model『MKC-DFKM』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
VFD370CP23A-00; VFD370CP23A-21; VFD450CP23A-00; VFD450CP23A-21; VFD750CP43B-00;
VFD750CP43B-21; VFD900CP43A-00; VFD900CP43A-21; VFD450CP63A-00; VFD450CP63A-21;
VFD550CP63A-00; VFD550CP63A-21
1. Loosen the screw and remove the fan kit. Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 lb-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
2. (As shown Figure 1) Before removing the fan, remove the cover by using a slotted screwdriver.
1
2
3
4
Figure 1
7-99
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame E
Applicable models for MKC-EFKM1:
VFD550CP23A-00; VFD550CP23A-21; VFD750CP23-00; VFD750CP23A-21
1 1
2 2
3 3
4 4
Figure 1 Figure 2
Model『MKC-EFKB』: Heat Sink Fan
1. Loosen screw 1–2 and disconnect fan power and pull out the fan. (As shown in the enlarged picture 3)
Screw1–2 Torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 lb-in] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
Figure 3
7-100
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame F
Applicable model
VFD1600CP43A-00; VFD1600CP43A-21; VFD1850CP43B-00; VFD1850CP43B-21; VFD1600CP63A-00;
VFD1600CP63A-21; VFD2000CP63A-00; VFD2000CP63A-21
Fan model『MKC-FFKM』Heat Sink Fan
1. Loosen the screws and plug out the power of fan before removing it (figure 1). Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm /
[20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
Figure 1
Fan model 『MKC-FFKB』Capacitor Fan
1. Loosen the screw (figure 1) and remove the cover. 2. Loosen the screw (figure 2) and remove the cover.
Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] /
[1.2–1.5 Nm] [2.4–2.5 Nm]
7
Figure 1 Figure 2
3. Loosen the screws and remove the fan. (figure 3 and figure 4)
Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 Ib-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
11
10
9
11
10
9
Figure 3 Figure 4
7-101
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame G
Fan model『MKC-GFKM』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
VFD2200CP43A-00; VFD2200CP43A-21; VFD2800CP43A-00; VFD2800CP43A-21; VFD2500CP63A-00;
VFD2500CP63A-21; VFD3150CP63A-00; VFD3150CP63A-21;
1. Loosen the screw (figure 1) and remove the cover. 2. For 1–8 shown in the figure 2: Loosen the screws
Screw torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13.1 Ib-in.] / Screw M6 torque: 35–40 kg-cm / [30.4–34.7 Ib-in.] /
[1.2–1.5 Nm] [3.4–3.9 Nm]
3. For 9–10 shown in the figure 2: Loosen the screws
and remove the cover. Screw M4 torque: 14–16
kg-cm / [12.2–13.9 Ib-in.] / [1.4–1.6 Nm]
Figure 1 Figure 2
4. Loosen screw 1–3 and remove the protective ring (as 5. Lift the fan by putting your finger through the protective
shown in figure 3) Screw torque: 14–16 kg-cm / holes, as indicates in 1 and 2 on the figure 4.
[12.2–13.9 Ib-in.] / [1.4–1.6 Nm]
.
Figure 3 Figure 4
5. If you are switching new fan on old AC motor drive, 6. Add cable model 3864483201 to connect the power
follow the steps below: board and fan connector. (The cable 3864483201
Loosen screws 1–5, remove the cover (as shown in goes with the fan as accessory.)
figure below). M4 screw torque: 14–16 kg-cm /
[12.2–13.9 lb-in] / [1.4–1.6 Nm]
Cable 3864483201
Figure 5 Figure 6
7-102
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame H
Fan model『MKC-HFKM』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
VFD3150CP43A-00; VFD3150CP43C-00; VFD3150CP43C-21; VFD3550CP43A-00; VFD3550CP43C-00;
VFD3550CP43C-21; VFD4000CP43A-00; VFD4000CP43C-00; VFD4000CP43C-21; VFD5000CP43A-00;
VFD5000CP43C-00; VFD5000CP43C-21; VFD5600CP43A-00; VFD5600CP43C-21; VFD6300CP43A-00;
VFD6300CP43C-21
1. Loosen the screw 1–4 and remove the top cover 2. Loosen the screw 5–12 and remove the top cover
(figure 1). Screw torque: 14–16 kg-cm / [12.2–13.9 (figure 2). Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6
lb-in] / [1.4–1.6 Nm] lb-in] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
3
1
Figure 1 Figure 2
3. Press the latch to disconnect fan power (as shown in 4. Loosen the screw 13–18 and remove the fan.
the enlarged picture of figure 3). Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 lb-in] /
[2.4–2.5 Nm] (as shown in figure 4)
15
15 14
14
13 13
18
17 18
16
17
16
Figure 3 Figure 4
7-103
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame H
Fan model『MKCHS-HFKM』Heat Sink Fan
Applicable model
Following models use three sets of MKCHS-HFKM:
VFD5000CP43A-00; VFD5000CP43C-00; VFD5000CP43C-21; VFD5600CP43A-00; VFD5600CP43C-21;
VFD6300CP43A-00; VFD6300CP43C-21
1. Loosen the screw 1–4 and remove the top cover 2. Loosen the screw 5–12 and remove the top cover
(figure 1) Screw torque: 14–16 kg-cm / [12.2–13.9 (figure 2). Screw torque: 24–26kg-cm / [20.8–22.6
Ib-in.] / [1.4–1.6 Nm] Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
7
8
9
10
11
12
4 5
3 6
1
Figure 1
Figure 2
3. Press the latch to disconnect fan power, and cut the cable tie
Figure 3
4. Loosen the screw 13–24 and remove the fan.
Figure 4
7-104
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 1 Figure 2
3. Disconnect the fan (figure 3). 4. Loosen the screw 1–4 (as shown below) and remove
the fan. Make sure fan power is disconnected before
removal. Screw torque: 24–26kg-cm / [20.8–22.6
Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
Figure 3 Figure 4
7-105
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Figure 1 Figure 2
3. Disconnect the fan (figure 3). 4. Loosen the screw 1–6 (as shown below) and remove
the fan. Make sure fan power is disconnected before
removal. Screw torque: 24–26kg-cm / [20.8–22.6
Ib-in.] / [2.4–2.5 Nm]
Figure 3 Figure 4
7-106
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Screw 1 *4
M3*P 0.5; L=6mm
Screw 2*8
M6*P 1.0; L=16mm
『MKC-AFM』
Applicable model
VFD007CP4EA-21; VFD015CP23A-21; VFD015CP43B-21; VFD015CP4EB-21; VFD022CP23A-21;
VFD037CP43B-21; VFD037CP4EB-21; VFD055CP23A-21; VFD040CP43A-21; VFD040CP4EA-21;
VFD055CP43B-21; VFD055CP4EB-21; VFD075CP43B-21; VFD075CP4EB-21
Screw *8
M6*P 1.0; L=16mm
7-107
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
『MKC-AFM1』Installation
1. Install accessory 1 by fastening 4 of the screw 1(M3) (figure 1). Screw torque: 6–8 kg-cm / [5.21–6.94 Ib-in.] /
[0.6–0.8 Nm]
Figure 1
2. Install accessory 2&3 by fastening 2 of the screw 2 (M6) (figure 2). Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.]
/ [2.5–2.9 Nm]
Figure 2
3. Install accessory 2&3 by fastening 2 of the screw 2(M6) (figure 3). Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.]
/ [2.5–2.9 Nm]
Figure 3
4. Plate installation, place 4 of the screw 2 (M6) (figure 4) through accessory 2&3 and the plate then fasten the
screws. Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.] / [2.5–2.9 Nm]
Figure 4
7-108
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
『MKC-AFM』 Installation
1. Install accessory 2 & 3 by fastening 2 of the screw 2 (M6). Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.] / [2.5–2.9
Nm] (figure 1)
Figure 1
2. Install accessory 2 & 3 by fastening 2 of the screw 2 (M6). Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.] /
[2.5–2.9 Nm] (figure 2)
Figure 2
3. Plate installation, place 4 of the screw *4 (M6) through accessory 2&3 and the plate, then fasten the screws.
Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.] / [2.5–2.9 Nm] (figure 3)
Figure 3
7-109
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame B
『MKC-BFM』
Applicable model
VFD075CP23A-21; VFD110CP23A-21; VFD110CP43B-21; VFD110CP4EB-21; VFD150CP23A-21;
VFD150CP43B-21; VFD150CP4EB-21; VFD185CP43B-21; VFD185CP4EB-21; VFD055CP53A-21;
VFD075CP53A-21; VFD110CP53A-21; VFD150CP53A-21
7-110
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
246.8[9.72]
173.0 [6.81] 36.9 [1.45]
184.5[7.26]
350.0 [13.78]
369.0[14.53]
7-111
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
『MKC-BFM』Installation
1. Install accessory 1& 2 by fastening 4 of the screw 1 (M8). Screw torque: 40–45 kg-cm / [34.7–39.0 Ib-in.] /
[3.9–4.4 Nm] (As shown in the following figure)
2. Plate installation, place 6 of the screw 2 (M6) through accessory 1&2 and the plate, then fasten the screws.
Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.] / [2.5–2.9 Nm] (As shown in the following figure)
7-112
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame C
『MKC-CFM』
Applicable model
VFD185CP23A-21; VFD220CP23A-21; VFD220CP43A-21; VFD220CP4EA-21; VFD300CP23A-21;
VFD300CP43B-21; VFD300CP4EB-21; VFD370CP43B-21; VFD370CP4EB-21; VFD185CP63A-21;
VFD220CP63A-21; VFD300CP63A-21; VFD370CP63A-21
286.0 [11.26]
258.0 [10.16]
231.0 [9.09]
402.0 [15.83]
430.0 [16.93]
140.0 [5.51]
M6*1.0 (8X) or
6.5 [ 0.26] (8X)
7-113
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
306.0 [12.05]
231.0 [9.09] 37.5 [1.48]
155.5 [6.12]
430.0 [16.93]
451.0 [17.76]
140.0 [5.51]
7-114
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
『MKC-CFM』Installation
1. Install accessory 1 & 2 by fastening 4 of the screw 1 (M8). Screw torque: 50–55 kg-cm / [43.4–47.7 Ib-in.] /
[4.9–5.4 Nm] (As shown in the following figure)
2. Plate installation, place 8 of the screw 2 (M6) through Accessory 1&2 and the plate, then fasten the screws.
Screw torque: 25–30 kg-cm / [21.7–26 Ib-in.] / [2.5–2.9 Nm] (As shown in the following figure)
7-115
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame D0
Applicable model
VFD450CP43S-00; VFD450CP43S-21; VFD550CP43S-00; VFD550CP43S-21
M10*P1.5(4X)
OR 11.0[0.43](4X)
7-116
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame D
Applicable model
VFD370CP23A-00; VFD370CP23A-21; VFD450CP23A-00; VFD450CP23A-21; VFD750CP43B-00;
VFD750CP43B-21; VFD900CP43A-00; VFD900CP43A-21; VFD450CP63A-00; VFD450CP63A-21;
VFD550CP63A-00; VFD550CP63A-21
M10*P1.5(4X)
OR 11.0[0.43](4X)
7-117
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame E
Applicable model
VFD550CP23A-00; VFD550CP23A-21; VFD750CP23A-00; VFD750CP23A-21; VFD900CP23A-00;
VFD900CP23A-21; VFD1100CP43A-00; VFD1100CP43A-21; VFD1320CP43B-00; VFD1320CP43B-21;
VFD750CP63A-00; VFD750CP63A-21; VFD900CP63A-00; VFD900CP63A-21; VFD1100CP63A-00;
VFD1100CP63A-21; VFD1320CP63A-00
7-118
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
3. Fasten 4 screws (as shown in the following figure). 4. Fasten 5 screws (as shown in the following figure).
Screw torque: 30–32 kg-cm / [26.0–27.8 Ib-in.] / Screw torque: 30–32 kg-cm / [26.0–27.8 Ib-in.] /
[2.9–3.1 Nm] [2.9–3.1 Nm]
5. Fasten 4 screws (as shown in the following figure). 6. Fasten 5 screws (as shown in the following figure).
Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] / Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] /
[2.4–2.5 Nm] [2.4–2.5 Nm]
7. Place 4 screws (M10) through Fixture 1&2 and the plate then fasten the screws. (as shown in the following
figure)
Frame D0/D M10*4 Screw torque: 200–240 kg-cm / [173.6–208.3 Ib-in.] / [19.6–23.5 Nm]
Frame E M12*4 Screw torque: 300–400 kg-cm / [260–347 Ib-in.] / [29.4–39.2 Nm]
7-119
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame F Installation
Applicable model
M12*P1.75(4X)
OR 13.0[0.51](4X)
7-120
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Frame F
1. Loosen 12 screws and remove Fixture 2. 2. Loosen 12 screws and remove Fixture 2.
Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] /
[2.4–2.5 Nm]
1
6
5 1
6
4 5
12 3
2
7
8
12 4
FIXTURE 2 3
9 7 2
10 8
11 FIXTURE2
9
10
11
3. Loosen screw 13–26 and remove Fixture 1. 4. Install Fixture 1 by fasten screw 13–26
Screw torque: 24–26 kg-cm / [20.8–22.6 Ib-in.] /
[2.4–2.5 Nm]
13
19
18 13
19
17
18
20 17
16
26 20
14
26
15 16
25 14
25 15
24
24
FIXTURE1
FIXTURE1
23
21 23
21
22 22
5. Place 4 of the M12 screws through Fixture 1&2 and plate then fasten the screws.
Screw torque: 300–400 kg-cm / [260–347 Ib-in.] / [29.4–39.2 Nm]
Screws M12*4
7-121
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
『MKC-PTCG』Installation
1. Loosen the 4 screws on the cover, as shown in the following figure. Screw Torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13
lb-in] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
2. Remove the 5 screws from the FR4 board, as shown in the following figure. (The FR4 board is not needed
after the installation of the power terminal kit). Screw Torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 lb-in] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
FR4 Board
7-122
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
3. Loosen the upper M8 nuts (1–6) with a sleeve wrench (12mm of the sleeve). M8 Torque: 90 kg / [78.1 lb-in] /
[8.8 Nm]
4. Install the 3pcs copper assy., as shown in the following figure 1. Fasten the upper M8 nuts (1–6) with a sleeve
wrench (12 mm of the sleeve), as shown in the figure 2 below.
M8 Torque: 180 kg-cm / [156.2 lb-in] / [17.65 Nm]
Figure 1 Figure 2
Figure 3
5. Put the cover back and fasten the screws as shown in the figure below. Screw Torque: 12–15 kg-cm /
[10.4–13 lb-in] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
7-123
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Introduction
IFD6530 is a convenient RS-485-to-USB converter, which does not require external power-supply and
complex setting process. It supports baud rate from 75 to 115.2 kbps and auto switching direction of data
transmission. In addition, it adopts RJ45 in RS-485 connector for users to wire conveniently. And its tiny dimension,
handy use of plug-and-play and hot-swap provide more conveniences for connecting all DELTA IABG products to
your PC.
Specifications
7-124
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
RJ45
PIN Description PIN Description
1 Reserved 5 SG+
2 Reserved 6 GND
3 GND 7 Reserved
4 SG- 8 +9V
STEP 1 STEP 2
STEP 3 STEP 4
STEP 5
You should have a folder marked SiLabs under drive C. c:\ SiLabs
7-125
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
Driver Installation
After connecting IFD6530 to PC, please install driver by following steps.
7-126
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
LED Display
1. Steady Green LED ON: power is ON.
2. Blinking orange LED: data is transmitting.
7-127
Chapter 7 Optional AccessoriesCP2000
7-128
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-2 EMC-D42A -- Extension card for 4-point digital input / 2-point digital input
8-3 EMC-D611A -- Extension card for 6-point digital input (110VAC input voltage)
8-4 EMC-R6AA -- Relay output extension card (6-point N.O. output contact)
8-5 EMC-A22A -- Extension card for 2-point analog input / 2-point analog output
8-1
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
Please select applicable option cards for your drive or contact local distributor for suggestion.
To prevent drive damage during installation, please remove the digital keypad and the cover before wiring.
Refer to the following instruction.
Frame D0
Screw Torque: 8–10 kg-cm / [6.9–8.7 lb-in.] / [0.8–1.0 Nm]
Frame D
Screw Torque: 8–10 kg-cm / [6.9–8.7 lb-in.] / [0.8–1.0 Nm]
8-2
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
Frame E
Screw Torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 lb-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
Frame F
Screw Torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 lb-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
Frame G
Screw Torque: 12–15 kg-cm / [10.4–13 lb-in.] / [1.2–1.5 Nm]
8-3
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
Frame H
Screw Torque: 14–16 kg-cm / [12.15–13.89 lb-in.] / [1.4–1.6 Nm]
8-4
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
CMC-EIP01 EMC-COP01
CMC-PN01
8-5
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
I/O / Relay extension card & 24V Power extension card (Slot 3)
EMC-D42A EMC-R6AA
EMC-BPS01 EMC-D611A
EMC-A22A
8-6
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-7
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-8
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-9
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-10
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-2 EMC-D42A -- Extension card for 4-point digital input / 2-point digital input
Terminals Descriptions
Common for Multi-function input terminals
COM Select SINK (NPN) / SOURCE (PNP) in J1 jumper / external
power supply
Refer to Pr.02-26–Pr.02-29 to program the multi-function inputs
MI10–MI13.
Internal power is applied from terminal E24: +24 VDC ± 5% 200 mA,
MI10–MI13 5W
External power +24 VDC: max. voltage 30 VDC, min. voltage 19 VDC
ON: the activation current is 6.0 mA
OFF: leakage current tolerance is 10 μA
I/O Extension Multi-function output terminals (photocoupler)
Card The AC motor drive releases various monitor signals, such as drive
in operation, frequency attained and overload indication, via
transistor (open collector).
MO10–MO11
MO10
MO11
MXM
Common for multi-function output terminals MO10, MO11 (photo
MXM coupler)
Max 48 VDC 50 mA
8-3 EMC-D611A -- Extension card for 6-point digital input (110VAC input voltage)
Terminals Descriptions
AC AC power Common for multi-function input terminal (Neutral)
Refer to Pr.02-26–Pr.02-31 for multi-function input selection
Input voltage: 100–130 VAC
I/O Extension
Input frequency: 47–63 Hz
Card
MI10–MI15 Input impedance: 27 kΩ
Terminal response time:
ON: 10 ms
OFF: 20 ms
8-4 EMC-R6AA
Terminals Descriptions
Refer to Pr.02-36–Pr.02-41 for multi-function relay selection
Resistive load:
3 A (N.O.) / 250 VAC
Relay Extension 5 A (N.O.) / 30 VDC
RA10–RA15
Card Inductive load (COS 0.4)
RC10–RC15
1.2 A (N.O.) / 250 VAC
2.0 A (N.O.) / 30 VDC
It is used to output each monitor signal, such as drive is in
operation, frequency attained or overload indication.
8-11
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-5 EMC-A22A -- Extension card for 2-point analog input / 2-point analog output
Terminals Descriptions
Refer to Pr.14-00–Pr.14-01 for function selection (input), and
Pr.14-18–Pr.14-19 for mode selection.
There are two sets of AI port, SSW3 (AI10) and SSW4 (AI11),
AI10, AI11
which can be switched to Voltage or Current mode.
Voltage mode: Input 0–10 V
Current mode: Input 0–20 mA / 4–20 mA
Analog I/O
Extension Card Refer to Pr.14-12–Pr.14-13 for function selection (output), and
Pr.14-36–Pr.14-37 for mode selection.
There are two sets of AO port, SSW1 (AO10) and SSW2 (AO11),
AO10, AO11
which can be switched to Voltage or Current mode.
Voltage mode: Output 0–10 V
Current mode: Output 0–20 mA / 4–20 mA
ACM Analog signal common terminal
8-12
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-7-1 Features
1. Supports PZD control data exchange.
2. Supports PKW polling AC motor drive parameters.
3. Supports user diagnosis function.
4. Auto-detects baud rates; supports Max. 12 Mbps.
1. NET indicator
2. POWER indicator
3. Positioning hole
4. AC motor drive connection
port
5. PROFIBUS DP connection
port
6. Screw fixing hole
7. Fool-proof groove
8-7-3 Specifications
PROFIBUS DP Connector
Interface DB9 connector
Transmission method High-speed RS-485
Transmission cable Shielded twisted pair cable
Electrical isolation 500 VDC
Communication
Message type Cyclic data exchange
Module name CMC-PD01
GSD document DELA08DB.GSD
Company ID 08DB (HEX)
Serial transmission 9.6 Kbps; 19.2 Kbps; 93.75 Kbps; 187.5 Kbps; 500 Kbps; 1.5 Mbps; 3 Mbps;
speed supported
(auto-detection) 6 Mbps; 12 Mbps (bit /per second)
Electrical Specification
Power supply voltage 5 VDC (supplied by AC motor drive)
Insulation voltage 500 VDC
Power consumption 1W
Weight 28 g
8-13
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
Environment
ESD (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-2)
EFT (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-4)
Noise immunity
Surge Teat (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-5)
Conducted Susceptibility Test (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-6)
Operation: -10ºC–50ºC (temperature), 90% (humidity)
Operation /storage
Storage: -25ºC–70ºC (temperature), 95% (humidity)
Shock / vibration International standards: IEC61131-2, IEC60068-2-6 (TEST Fc) / IEC61131-2 &
resistance IEC60068-2-27 (TEST Ea)
8-7-4 Installation
PROFIBUS DP Connector
PIN PIN name Definition
1 - Not defined
2 - Not defined 9 5
3 Rxd/Txd-P Sending/receiving data P(B)
4 - Not defined
5 DGND Data reference ground
6 1
6 VP Power voltage – positive
7 - Not defined
8 Rxd/Txd-N Sending/receiving data N(A)
9 - Not defined
POWER LED
LED status Indication How to correct it?
Green light ON Power supply in normal status. --
Check if the connection between CMC-PD01 and AC
OFF No power
motor drive is normal.
NET LED
LED status Indication How to correct it?
Green light ON Normal status --
CMC-PD01 is not connected to
Red light ON Connect CMC-PD01 to PROFIBUS DP bus.
PROFIBUS DP bus.
Red light Invalid PROFIBUS communication Set the PROFIBUS address of CMC-PD01 between 1–
flashes address 125 (decimal)
Orange light CMC-PD01 fails to communicate Switch off the power and check whether CMC-PD01 is
flashes with AC motor drive. correctly and normally connected to AC motor drive.
8-14
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
1. NS indicator
2. MS indicator
3. POWER indicator
4. Positioning hole
5. DeviceNet connection port
6. Screw fixing hole
7. Fool-proof groove
8. AC motor drive connection
port
8-8-3 Specifications
DeviceNet Connector
Interface 5-PIN open removable connector of 5.08 mm PIN interval
Transmission method CAN
Transmission cable Shielded twisted pair cable (with 2 power cables)
Transmission speed 125 Kbps, 250 Kbps, 500 Kbps and extendable serial transmission speed mode
Network protocol DeviceNet protocol
8-15
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
Electrical Specification
Power supply voltage 5 VDC (supplied by AC motor drive)
Insulation voltage 500 VDC
Communication wire
0.85 W
power consumption
Power consumption 1W
Weight 23 g
Environment
ESD (IEC 61800-5-1,IEC 61000-4-2)
EFT (IEC 61800-5-1,IEC 61000-4-4)
Noise immunity
Surge Test (IEC 61800-5-1,IEC 61000-4-5)
Conducted Susceptibility Test (IEC 61800-5-1,IEC 61000-4-6)
Operation: -10ºC–50ºC (temperature), 90% (humidity)
Operation /storage
Storage: -25ºC–70ºC (temperature), 95% (humidity)
Shock / vibration International standards: IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 60068-2-6 / IEC 61800-5-1, IEC
resistance 60068-2-27
8-8-4 Installation
DeviceNet Connector
PIN Signal Color Definition
1 V+ Red DC24V 1
2
2 H White Signal+
3
3 S - Earth 4
4 L Blue Signal- 5
5 V- Black 0V
POWER LED
8-16
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
NS LED
LED status Indication How to correct it?
1. Check the power of CMC-DN01 and see if the
connection is normal.
No power supply or CMC-DN01 has 2. Make sure at least one or more nodes are on the
OFF
not completed MAC ID test yet. bus.
3. Check if the serial transmission speed of
CMC-DN01 is the same as that of other nodes.
1. Configure CMC-DN01 to the scan list of the
Green light CMC-DN01 is on-line but has not master.
flashes established connection to the master.
2. Re-download the configured data to the master.
CMC-DN01 is on-line and is normally
Green light ON --
connected to the master
Red light CMC-DN01 is on-line, but I/O 1. Check if the network connection is normal.
flashes connection is timed-out. 2. Check if the master operates normally.
1. Make sure all the MAC IDs on the network are
not repeated.
1. The communication is down. 2. Check if the network installation is normal.
2. MAC ID test failure. 3. Check if the baud rate of CMC-DN01 is
Red light ON
3. No network power supply. consistent with that of other nodes.
4. CMC-DN01 is off-line. 4. Check if the node address of CMC-DN01 is
illegal.
5. Check if the network power supply is normal.
MS LED
LED status Indication How to correct it?
Check the power supply of CMC-DN01 and see if
OFF No power supply or being off-line
the connection is normal.
Green light
Waiting for I/O data Switch the master PLC to RUN status
flashes
Green light ON I/O data are normal --
Red light 1. Reconfigure CMC-DN01
Mapping error
flashes 2. Re-power AC motor drive
1. See the error code displayed on AC motor drive.
Red light ON Hardware error
2. Send back to the factory for repair if necessary.
If the flashing lasts for a long time, turn off the
Orange light CMC-DN01 is establishing connection power and check if CMC-DN01 and AC motor drive
flashes with AC motor drive. are correctly installed and normally connected to
each other.
8-17
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-9-3 Specifications
Network Interface
Interface RJ45 with Auto MDI/MDIX
Number of ports 1 Port
Transmission method IEEE 802.3, IEEE 802.3u
Transmission cable Category 5e shielding 100M
Transmission speed 10/100 Mbps Auto-Detect
Network protocol ICMP, IP, TCP, UDP, DHCP, BOOTP, SMTP, EtherNet/IP, Modbus TCP
Electrical Specification
Weight 25 g
Insulation voltage 500 VDC
Power consumption 0.8 W
Power supply voltage 5 VDC
8-18
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
Environment
ESD (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-2)
EFT (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-4)
Noise immunity
Surge Test (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-5)
Conducted Susceptibility Test (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 61000-4-6)
Operation: -10°C–50°C (temperature), 90% (humidity)
Operation/storage
Storage: -25°C–70°C (temperature), 95% (humidity)
Vibration/shock
International standard: IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 60068-2-6/IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 60068-2-27
immunity
8-9-4 Installation
4 -- N/C 8 -- N/C
8-19
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
LED Indicators
LED Status Indication How to correct it?
ON Power supply in normal status --
POWER Green
OFF No power supply Check the power supply.
Network connection in normal
ON --
status
LINK Green Flashes Network in operation --
Check if the network cable is
OFF Network not connected
connected.
Troubleshooting
8-20
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-21
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
CMC-PN01 connects CP2000 to PROFINET, so the drive is able to exchange data with the upper unit. It
is a simple NET solution, which can reduce the cost and time of connection/ installing factory automation,
also provide compatibility of similar components from multiple suppliers.
Connect CMC-PN01 to CP2000 via PROFINET device:
1. Control the AC motor drive via PROFINET
2. Change the drive parameters via PROFINET
3. Monitor the drive status via PROFINET
Def. Explanation
8-22
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-10-3 Specifications
Network Interface
Interface RJ45
Number of ports 2 ports
Transmission method IEEE 802.3
Transmission cable Category 5e shielding 100 M
Transmission speed 10/100 Mbps auto-negotiate
Network protocol PROFINET
Electrical Specification
Power supply voltage 5 VDC
Power consumption 0.8 W
Insulation voltage 500 VDC
Weight (g) 27
Environment
ESD (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 6100-4-2)
EFT (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 6100-4-4)
Noise immunity
Surge Test (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 6100-4-5)
Conducted Susceptibility Test (IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 6100-4-6)
Operation -10°C–50°C (temperature), 90% (humidity)
Storage -25°C–70°C (temperature), 95% (humidity)
Vibration / Shock International standard: IEC 61800-5-1, IEC 60068-2-6 / IEC 61800-5-1,
immunity IEC 60068-2-27
8-23
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
When operating VFD-CP2000 via CMC-PN01, please set the control and operation command as
controlled by communication card. When CP2000 is connected to PROFINET network, please set
up the communication parameters according to the table below.
Parameter Set value (Dec) Explanation
SD Red - -
8-24
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
When the hardware is installed and power on, the current set value of Pr.09-60 will be 12, and
shows “PROFINET” on the display.If the above information does not show on the display, please
check the version of VFD-CP2000 and the connection of the card.
8-25
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-11-3 Specifications
Interface RJ45
Transmission speed 1 Mbps, 500 Kbps, 250 Kbps, 125 Kbps, 100 Kbps, 50 Kbps
8-26
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-27
Chapter 8 Option CardsCP2000
8-28
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Chapter 9 Specifications
Frequency
9-1
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Applicable motor
1 2 3 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 60 75 100 120
output [HP]
Overload tolerance 120% of rated current for 1 minute during every 5 minutes
Max. output
599.00 400.00
frequency [Hz]
Carrier frequency 2–9
*Output Rating
Applicable motor
0.5 1 2 3 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 60 75 100
output [HP]
120% of rated current for 1 minute during every 5 minutes;
Overload tolerance
160% of rated current for 3 seconds during every 25 seconds
Max. output
599.00 400.00
frequency [Hz]
Carrier frequency 2–9
2–15 ( Default: 8) 2–10 (Default: 6)
[kHz] (Default: 4)
Light duty 6.4 9.6 15 22 25 35 50 65 83 100 116 146 180 215 276 322
Input
current [A] Normal
3.9 6.4 12 16 20 28 36 52 72 83 99 124 143 171 206 245
Input Rating
duty
Rated voltage /
3 phase, 200–240 VAC [-15%– +10%], 50/60 Hz
Frequency
Operating voltage
170–264 VAC
range
Frequency tolerance 47–63 Hz
Efficiency [%] 97.8 98.2
Power Factor >0.98
Weight [Kg] 2.6± 0.3 5.4± 1 9.8± 1.5 38.5± 1.5 64.8± 1.5
Natural
Cooling method Fan cooling
cooling
Braking chopper Frame A, B, C: Built-in Frame D above: Optional
DC choke Frame A, B, C: Optional Frame D above: Built-in 3%
EMC Filter Optional
NOTE
The carrier frequency is default. Increasing the carrier frequency requires a reduction in current. Please refer to Chapter
9-7 Derating Curve of Ambient Temperature.
Select the AC motor drive with capacity one grade larger for the impact load application.
Refer to Chapter 9-6 Specification for Operation Temperature and Protection Level for the protection level of each model.
*The default setting is Light Duty, you can select Normal Duty and Light Duty by setting Pr.00-16.
9-2
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Applicable motor
1 2 3 5 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50 60 75
output [HP]
Overload tolerance 120% of rated current for 1 minute during every 5 minutes
Max.output
599.00
frequency [Hz]
Carrier frequency
Output rating
Applicable motor
0.4 0.75 1.5 2.2 3.7 4 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5 22 30 37 45
output [kW]
Normal duty
Applicable motor
0.5 1 2 3 5 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 53 60
output [HP]
120% of rated current for 1 minute during every 5 minutes;
Overload tolerance
160% of rated current for 3 seconds during every 25 seconds
Max.output
599.00
frequency [Hz]
Carrier frequency
2–15 (Default: 8) 2–10 (Default: 6)
[kHz]
Light duty 4.3 6 8.1 12.4 16 20 22 26 35 42 50 66 80 91 110
Input
current [A] Normal
3.5 4.3 5.9 8.7 14 15.5 17 20 26 35 40 47 63 74 101
Input rating
duty
Rated voltage /
3 phase, 380–480 VAC [-15%– +10%), 50/60 Hz
Frequency
Operating voltage range 323–528 VAC
Frequency tolerance 47–63 Hz
Efficiency [%] 97.8
Power factor >0.98
Weight [Kg] 2.6± 0.3 5.4± 1 9.8± 1.5 27± 1
Natural
Cooling method Fan cooling
cooling
Frame A, B, C: Built-in;
Braking chopper
Frame D0 above: Optional
Frame A, B, C: Optional;
DC choke
Frame D0 above: Built-in 3%
Frame A, B, C of VFD_ _ _ _CP4EA-_ _: Built-in;
EMC Filter Frame A, B, C of VFD_ _ _ _CP43A-_ _: no built-in;
Frame D0 above: Optional
NOTE
The carrier frequency is default. Increasing the carrier frequency requires a reduction in current. Please refer to Chapter
9-7 Derating Curve of Ambient Temperature.
Select the AC motor drive with capacity one grade larger for the impact load application.
Refer to Chapter 9-6 Specification for Operation Temperature and Protection Level for the protection level of each model.
*1 The default setting is Light Duty, you can select Normal Duty and Light Duty by setting Pr.00-16.
*2 It means the rated output current is for the models of Version B. (e.g. VFD015CP43B-21)
9-3
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
460V Series
Frame D E F G H
Model VFD_ _ _ _CP43_-_ _ 750 900 1100 1320 1600 1850 2200 2800 3150 3550 4000 5000 5600 6300
Rated output capacity
120 143 175 207 247 295 367 422 491 544 613 741 872 966
[kVA]
Rated output current
150*2 180 220 260*2 310 370*2 460 530 616 683 770 930 1094 1212
[A]
Applicable motor
75 90 110 132 160 185 220 280 315 355 400 500 560 630
output [kW]
Light duty
Applicable motor
100 120 150 175 215 250 300 375 425 475 536 675 745 850
output [HP]
Overload capacity 120% of rated output current: 1 minute for every 5 minutes
Max. output frequency
599 400
[Hz]
*1Output rating
output [kW]
Applicable motor
75 100 125 150 175 215 250 300 375 425 475 600 675 850
output [HP]
120% of rated output current: 1 minute for every 5 minutes;
Overload capacity
160% of rated output current: 3 seconds for every 25 seconds
Max. output frequency
599 400
[Hz]
Carrier frequency 2–10 2–9
[kHz] (Default: 6) (Default: 4)
Input current Light duty 150 180 220 260 310 370 460 530 616 683 770 930 1094 1212
[A] Normal duty 114 157 167 207 240 300 380 400 494 555 625 866 930 1094
Input rating
Drive weight [Kg] 38.5± 1.5 64.8± 1.5 86.5± 1.5 134± 4 228
NOTE
The carrier frequency is default. Increasing the carrier frequency requires a reduction in current. Please refer to Chapter
9-7 Derating Curve of Ambient Temperature.
Select the AC motor drive with capacity one grade larger for the impact load application.
Refer to Chapter 9-6 Specification for Operation Temperature and Protection Level for the protection level of each model.
*1 The default setting is Light Duty, you can select Normal Duty and Light Duty by setting Pr.00-16.
*2 It means the rated output current is for the models of Version B. (e.g. VFD015CP43B-21)
Model VFD5000CP43A-xx does not have UL certification.
9-4
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Rated output current [A] 3 4.3 6.7 9.9 12.1 18.7 24.2
Applicable motor output [kW] 1.5 2.2 3.7 5.5 7.5 11 15
*Output rating
Applicable motor output [kW] 0.75 1.5 2.2 3.7 5.5 7.5 11
Applicable motor output [HP] 1 2 3 5 7.5 10 15
Carrier frequency [kHz] 2–15 (Default: 4)
Light duty 3.8 5.4 10.4 14.9 16.9 21.3 26.3
Input current [A]
Normal duty 3.1 4.5 7.2 12.3 15 18 22.8
Input rating
9-5
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
690V [HP]
Applicable motor output
20 25 30 40 50 60 75 100 125 150
575V [HP]
Rated output current [A] 24 30 36 45 54 67 86 104 125 150
Overload tolerance 120% of rated current for 1 minute during every 5 minutes
Max.output frequency
599.00
*Output rating
[Hz]
Rated output capacity
24 29 36 43 54 65 80 103 124 149
[kVA]
Applicable motor output
15 18.5 22 30 37 45 55 75 90 110
690V [kW]
Applicable motor output
Normal duty
9-6
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
690V Series
Frame F G H
Model VFD_ _ _ _CP63A-_ _ 1600 2000 2500 3150 4000 4500 5600 6300
Rated output capacity
215 263 347 418 494.5 534.7 678.5 776
[kVA]
Applicable motor output
160 200 250 315 400 450 560 630
690V [kW]
Applicable motor output
215 270 335 425 530 600 745 850
Light duty
690V [HP]
Applicable motor output
150 200 250 350 400 450 500 675
575V [HP]
Rated output current [A] 180 220 290 350 430 465 590 675
Overload tolerance 120% of rated current for 1 minute during every 5 minutes
Max.output frequency
599.00
[Hz]
*Output rating
9-7
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
General Specifications
Control Mode Pulse-Width Modulation (PWM)
Control Method 1: V/F, 2: SVC, 3: PM
Starting Torque Reach up to 150% above at 0.5 Hz.
V/F Curve 4 point adjustable V/F curve and square curve
Speed Response Ability 5 Hz (vector control can reach up to 40 Hz)
Light duty: max. 130% torque current
Torque Limit
Normal duty: max. 160% torque current
Torque Accuracy 5%
230V models: 599.00 Hz (55 kW and above: 400.00 Hz)
Max. output frequency (Hz) 460V models: 599.00 Hz (90 kW and above: 400.00 Hz)
Control Characteristics
230V models: drive will stop when DC bus voltage exceeds 410V
460V models: drive will stop when DC bus voltage exceeds 820V
Over-voltage Protection
575V models: drive will stop when DC bus voltage exceeds 1016V
690V models: drive will stop when DC bus voltage exceeds 1189V
Over-temperature
Built-in temperature sensor
Protection
Stall Prevention Stall prevention during acceleration, deceleration and running independently
Restart After Instantaneous
Parameter setting up to 20 seconds
Power Failure
Grounding Leakage Current
Leakage current is higher than 50% of rated current of the AC motor drive
Protection
Short-circuit Current Rating Per UL508C, the drive is suitable for use on a circuit capable of delivering not more than 100 kA
(SCCR) symmetrical amperes (rms) when protected by fuses given in the fuse table.
Certifications
GB/T12668-2
NOTE
* The setting range of max. output frequency changes as carrier wave and control modes changes. Refer to Pr.01-00 for
more information.
Only 230V/460V models are complied with EAC certification. 575V/690V models are not yet for certified.
Model VFD5000CP43A-xx does not have UL certification.
9-8
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
9-9
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Figure 9-1
*1 When the carrier wave for light duty is 2 kHz, the maximum operation temperature can reach up to 50°C.
9-10
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
9-7 Derating Curve for Ambient Temperature, Altitude and Carrier Frequency
Protection Level Operating Environment
If the AC motor drive operats at the rated current, the ambient temperature needs to be
UL Type I / IP20 between -10–40°C. If the temperature is above 40°C, decrease 2% of the rated current
for every 1°C increase in temperature. The maximum allowable temperature is 60°C.
If the AC motor drive operats at the rated current, the ambient temperature needs to be
UL Open Type / IP20 between -10–50°C. If the temperature is above 50°C, decrease 2% of the rated current
for every 1°C increase in temperature. The maximum allowable temperature is 60°C.
If the AC motor drive is installed at an altitude of 0–1000m, follow normal operation
restrictions. For altitudes of 1000–2000m, decrease the drive’s rated current by 1% or
High Altitude lower the temperature by 0.5°C for every 100 m increase in altitude. The maximum
altitude for corner grounding is 2000 m. If installing at an altitude higher than 2000 m is
required, contact Delta for more information.
230V/460V
Figure 9-2
9-11
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
575V/690V
Figure 9-3
Figure 9-4
9-12
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Figure 9-5
Figure 9-6
9-13
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Figure 9-7
Figure 9-8
9-14
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
575V / 690V
Pr.00-16 = 2, light duty:
Pr.00-11 = 0 (IMVF)
= 2 (IM SVC, Pr.05-33 = 0)
Figure 9-9
Pr.00-16 = 0, normal duty:
Pr.00-11 = 0 (IMVF)
= 2 (IM SVC, Pr.05-33 = 0)
Figure 9-10
9-15
Chapter 09 SpecificationsCP2000
Figure 9-11
Figure 9-12
9-16
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
KPC-CC01 Keypad
10-1
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
KPC-CC01
Communication Interface
RJ45 (socket), RS-485 interface
Installation Method
1. Embedded type and can be put flat on the surface of the control
box. The front cover is water proof.
2. Buy a MKC-KPPK model to do wall mounting or embedded
mounting. Its protection level is IP66.
3. The maximum RJ45 extension lead is 5 m (16ft)
4. This keypad can only be used on Delta’s motor drive C2000
series, CH2000 and CP2000.
10-2
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Key Descriptions
Press menu to return to main menu.
Menu content:
1. Parameter Setup 7. Language Setup 13. Startup Menu
2. Quick Start 8. Time Setup 14. Main Page
3. Application Selection List 9. Keypad Locked 15. PC Link
4. Changed List 10. PLC Function 16. Start Wizard
5. Copy Parameter 11. Copy PLC
6. Fault Record 12. Display Setup
Function Key
1. The functions keys have factory settings and can be defined by users. The factory settings
of F1 and F4 work with the function list below. For example, F1 is JOG function, F4 is a
speed setting key for adding/deleting user defined parameters.
2. Other functions must be defined by TPEditor first.
(Download TPEditor software at Delta website, select TPEditor version 1.60 or above.
Refer to instruction for TPEditor in Chapter 10-3.)
HAND Key
1. This key is executed by the parameter settings of the source of Hand frequency and hand
operation. The factory settings of both source of Hand frequency and hand operation are
the digital keypad.
2. Press HAND key at stop status, the setting will switch to hand frequency source and hand
operation source. Press HAND key at operation status, it stops the AC motor drive first
(display AHSP warning), and switch to hand frequency source and hand operation source.
3. When the operation mode switches successfully, the KPC-CC01 displays HAND mode on
the screen.
AUTO Key
1. This key is executed by the parameter settings of the source of AUTO frequency and
AUTO operation. The factory setting is the external terminal (source of operation is 4–20
mA).
2. Press Auto key at stop status, the setting will switch to hand frequency source and hand
operation source. Press Auto key at operation status, it stops the AC motor drive first
(display AHSP warning), and switch to auto frequency source and auto operation source.
3. When the operation mode switches successfully, the KPC-CC01 displays AUTO on the
screen.
10-3
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
LED Descriptions
RUN LED:
LED
Condition/ State
status
CANopen at initial
OFF
No LED
CANopen at pre-operation
Blinking
CANopen– “RUN”
CANopen at stop
Single
flash
ERR LED:
LED Condition/ State
status
OFF No Error
One message fail
Single
flash
SYNC fail
Triple
flash
Bus off
ON
10-4
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
NOTE
1. Startup page can only display pictures, no flash.
2. When Power ON, the startup page displays on the screen first, then enters the main page. The main page displays
Delta’s default setting F/H/A/U, the display order can be set by Pr. 00-03 (Startup display). When the selected item is U
page, use left key and right key to switch between the items, the display order of U page is set by Pr. 00-04 (User
display).
Display Icon
Display item
10-5
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
1. Parameter Setup
Example: Setup source of master frequency command.
Press to select a
Use Up/Down key to choose a setting.
parameter group. For example: Choose “2 Analog Input”, then press the
ENTER key.
Once a parameter group is
2. Quick Start
Description:
1. VF Mode
Items
1. Parameter protection password input
(Pr.00-07)
2. Parameter protection password setting
(Pr.00-08)
Press to select. 3. Speed control mode (Pr.00-11)
Quick Start: 4. Load selection (Pr.00-16)
01:Password Decoder
1. V/F Mode 5. Carrier frequency (Pr.00-17)
2. SVC Mode 6. Master frequency command (AUTO)
3. My Mode source / Source selection of the PID
target (Pr.00-20)
7. Operation command (AUTO) source
(Pr.00-21)
8. Stop method (Pr.00-22)
9. Digital keypad STOP function (Pr.00-32)
10. Max. operation frequency (Pr.01-00)
11. Output frequency of motor 1 (Pr.01-01)
12. Output voltage of motor 1 (Pr.01-02)
13. Mid-point frequency 1 of motor 1
(Pr.01-03)
14. Mid-point voltage 1 of motor 1
(Pr.01-04)
15. Mid-point frequency 2 of motor 1
(Pr.01-05)
16. Mid-point voltage 2 of motor 1
(Pr.01-06)
17. Min. output frequency of motor 1
(Pr.01-07)
18. Min. output voltage of motor 1
(Pr.01-08)
19. Output frequency upper limit
(Pr.01-10)
20. Output frequency lower limit
10-6
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
(Pr.01-11)
21. Acceleration time 1 (Pr.01-12)
22. Deceleration time 1 (Pr.01-13)
23. Over-voltage stall prevention
(Pr.06-01)
24. Derating protection (Pr.06-55)
25. Speed tracking during start-up
(Pr.07-12)
26. Emergency stop (EF) & force to stop
selection (Pr.07-20)
27. Torque command filter time
(Pr.07-24)
28. Slip compensation filter time (Pr.07-25)
29. Torque compensation gain (Pr.07-26)
30. Slip Compensation Gain (Pr.07-27)
2. SVC Mode
Items
1. Parameter protection password input
(Pr.00-07)
2. Parameter protection password setting
(Pr.00-08)
3. Speed control mode (Pr.00-11)
4. Load selection (Pr.00-16)
01: Password Decoder
5. Carrier frequency (Pr.00-17)
6. Master frequency command (AUTO)
source / Source selection of the PID
target (Pr.00-20)
7. Operation command (AUTO) source
(Pr.00-21)
8. Stop method (Pr.00-22)
9. Digital keypad STOP function
(Pr.00-32)
10. Max. operation frequency (Pr.01-00)
11. Output frequency of motor 1
(Pr.01-01)
12. Output voltage setting of motor 1
(Pr.01-02)
13. Min. output frequency of motor 1
(Pr.01-07)
14. Min. output voltage of motor 1
(Pr.01-08)
15. Output frequency upper limit
(Pr.01-10)
16. Output frequency lower limit
(Pr.01-11)
17. Acceleration time 1 (Pr.01-12)
18. Deceleration time 1 (Pr.01-13)
19. Full-load current for induction motor 1
(Pr.05-01)
20. Rated power for induction motor 1
(Pr.05-02)
21. Rated speed for induction motor 1
(Pr.05-03)
22. Number of poles for induction motor 1
(Pr.05-04)
23. No-load current for induction motor 1
(Pr.05-05)
24. Over-voltage stall prevention
(Pr.06-01)
25. Over-current stall prevention during
acceleration (Pr.06-03)
26. Derating protection (Pr.06-55)
27. Emergency stop (EF) & Force to stop
selection (Pr.07-20)
28. Torque command filter time
10-7
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
(Pr.07-24)
29. Slip compensation filter time
(Pr.07-25)
30. Slip compensation gain (Pr.07-27)
3. My Mode
Items
It saves 01–32 sets of parameters (Pr).
Setup process
1. Go to “Parameter Setup” function.
Press ENTER to go to the parameter
Click F4 in parameter which you need to use. There is an ADD
setting page, the on the bottom right-hand corner of the
screen. Press F4 on the keypad to add
parameter is saved to this parameter to My Mode.
My Mode. To delete or
correct the parameter, 00- 10
0
enter this parameter and Speed M ode
0~3 A DD
click the “DEL” on the
bottom right corner.
00- 10
0
Speed M ode
0~3 DEL
10-8
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Example:
Select 3: Application Selection List
Select Application
Press ENTER to enter the application selection screen, the selected
application set will be “Fan”.
10-9
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
4. Changed List
This function displays the parameter that user has set.
Example:
Set Pr.13-00 Application Selection = 3: Fan
Enter the changed list screen. List PrNum=026 means there are 26
parameters that have been changed.
5. Copy Parameter
Four duplicates are provided
The steps are shown in the example below.
Example: Saved in the motor drive.
1. Go to “Copy Parameter”
2. Select the parameter group which needs to be copied
and press ENTER key.
Press ENTER key to go to
001–004: content storage 1. Select 1: Save in the motor drive.
2. Press ENTER key to go to “Save in the motor drive”
screen.
1. Go to “Copy parameter”
2. Select the parameter group which needs to be copied
and press ENTER key.
10-10
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
6. Fault Record
Able to store 6 error codes (Keypad V1.02 and previous versions)
Able to store 30 error codes (Keypad V1.20 and later version)
The most recent error record is shown as the first record. Select an error
record to see its details such as date, time, frequency, current, voltage,
DCBUS voltage)
Press Up / Down key to select an error record.
After selecting an error code, press ENTER to see
Press to select. that error record’s detail
10-11
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
NOTE
Fault actions of AC motor drive are recorded and saved to KPC-CC01. When
KPC-CC01 is removed and applied to another AC motor drive, the previous fault
records will not be deleted. The new fault records of the present AC motor drive will
accumulate to KPC-CC01.
7. Language Setup
Language setting option is displayed in the language of the user’s choice.
Language setting options:
1. English 5. Русский
2. 繁體中文 6. Español
3. 简体中文 7. Português
Use Up / Down key to select
language, than press ENTER. 4. Türkçe 8. français
8. Time Setup
Time setup
2009/01/01 Use Up / Down key to set up Year
_ _ : _ _ :_ _
10-12
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
NOTE
Limitation: The charging process of the super capacitor will finish in about 6
minutes. When the digital keypad is removed, the time setting will be in
standby status for 7 days. After this period, the time needs to be reset.
9. Keypad Locked
Keypad Locked
This function is used to lock the keypad. The main page would not display
“keypad locked” when the keypad is locked, however it will display the
message” please press ESC and then ENTER to unlock the keypad” when
any key is pressed.
10-13
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
NOTE
If “Option 1: Save in the motor drive” is selected,
verify if the PLC program is built-in to KPC-CC01
keypad. If PLC program is not available in the keypad
while “Option 1: Save in the motor drive” is selected,
an “ERR8 Warning: Type not matching” will be
displayed on the screen.
1. Go to “Copy PLC”.
2. Select the parameter group which needs to be
copied and press ENTER key.
10-14
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
2. Back-light
10-15
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
3. Text Color
1:
The setting value changes to Blue Text.
2:
3:
13. Start-up
1. Default 1 DELTA LOGO
C Series
Indu strial A uto mation
10-16
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
F 60.00Hz
H 0.00Hz
u 540.0Vdc
15. PC Link
1. TPEditor: This function allows users to connect the keypad to a computer
then to download and edit user defined pages.
10-17
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Download completed
Windows 10, right click on the icon of VFDSoft to enter <Property> (as
shown in the red color square in the image below). Then click on the
<Compatibility> tab and select the <Run this program as an
administrator.> (also as shown in the red color square in the image
below)
Waiting to connect to PC
10-18
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Before using the user defined starting screen and user defined main
screen, the starting screen setup and the main screen setup have to be
preset as user defined.
If the user defined page are not downloaded to KPC-CC01, the starting
screen and the main screen will be blank.
10-19
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
F1 F4
F1
NOTE: The Start Wizard will not show up when re-power next time.
MENU
10-20
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
ESC
F4
F4 F4 F4
F1 F1 F1
F4 F4 F4
F1 F1 F1
F4 F4
F4
F1 F1
F1
F4 F1
F1
F4
MENU
NOTE: The “16: Start Wizard” on the menu is to set whether shows start wizard when start up the
drive.
10-21
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Other display
When a fault occurs, the menu displays:
1. Press STOP / RESET button to reset the fault code. If the drive has still no response, contact local distributor or
return to the factory. To view the fault DC bus voltage, output current and output voltage, press “MENU”“Fault
Record”.
2. After resetting, if the screen returns to main page and shows no fault after pressing ESC, the fault is cleared.
3. When fault or warning message appears, backlight LED will blink until the fault or the warning is cleared.
10-22
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
2. Go to File (F) Click on New. The Window below will pop up. At the device type, click on the drop down
menu and choose DELTA VFD-C Inverter. At the TP type, click on the drop down menu and choose VFD-C
Keypad. As for File Name, enter TPE0. Now click on OK.
3. You are now at the designing page. Go to Edit (E) Click on Add a New Page (A) or go to the TP page on
the upper right side, right click once on TP page and choose Add to increase one more page for editing.
10-23
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
5. Static Text . Open a blank page, click once on this button , and then double click on that blank
page. The following window will pop up.
6. Static Bitmap Open a blank page, then click once on this button and then double click on that
blank page. The following window will pop up.
Please note that Static Bitmap setting supports only images in BMP format. Now choose an image that
you need and click open, then that image will appear in the Static Bitmap window.
8. Finish editing the keypad starting screen and select Communication>Input User Defined Keypad
Starting Screen.
10-24
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
9. Downloading setting: Go to Tool > Communication. Set up communication port and speed of IFD6530.
10. Only three speed selections are available: 9600 bps, 19200 bps and 38400 bps.
11. When a dialogue box displayed on the screen asking to confirm writing or not, press buttons on the keypad
to go to MENU, select PC LINK and then press ENTER and wait for few seconds. Then select YES on the
screen to start downloading.
10-25
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
2. On the bottom right-hand corner of the HMI, click on a page number to edit or go to VIEW > HMI page to
start editing main page. As shown in the image, the following objects are available. From left to right:
Static Text, ASCII Display, Static Bitmap, Scale, Bar Graph, Button, Clock Display, Multi-state bit map,
Units, Numeric Input and 11 geometric bitmaps and lines of different width. The application of Static Text,
Static Bitmap, and geometric bitmap is the same as the editing startup page.
3. Numeric / ASCII Display: To add a Numeric / ASCII Display object to a screen, double click on the object
to set up Related Devices, Frame Setting, Fonts and Alignment.
Related Device: Choose the VFD Communication Port that you need, if you want to read output
frequency (H), set the VFD Communication Port to $2202. For other values, please refer to ACMD
Modbus Comm Address List.
10-26
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
4. Scale Setting : On the Tool Bar, click on for Scale Setting. You can also edit Scale Setting in the
Property Window on the right hand side of your computer screen.
a. Scale Position: Click on the drop down list to choose which position that you need to place a scale.
b. Scale Side: Click on the drop down list to choose if you want to number your scale from smaller
number to bigger number or from big to small. Click OK to accept this setting or click Cancel to
abort.
c. Font Setting: Click on the drop down list to choose the Font setting that you need then click OK to
accept the setting or click Cancel to abort.
d. Value Length: Click on the drop down to choose 16 bits or 32 bits. Then click OK to accept the
setting or click Cancel to abort.
e. Main Scale & Sub Scale: In order to divide the whole scale into equal parts, key in the numbers of
your choices for main scale and sub scale.
f. Maximum value & Minimum Value are the numbers on the two ends of a scale. They can be
negative numbers. But the values allowed to be input are limited by the length of value. For
example, when the length of value is set to be hexadecimal, the maximum and the minimum value
cannot be input as -4000.
Follow the Scale setting mentioned above; you will have a scale as shown below.
a. Related Device: Choose the VFD Communication Port that you need.
b. Direction Setting: Click on the drop down menu to choose one of the following directions: From
Bottom to Top, From Top to Bottom, From Left to Right or From Right to Left.
c. Maximum Value & Minimum Value: They define the range covered by the maximum value and
minimum value. If a value is smaller than or equal to the minimum value, then the bar graph will be
blank. If a value is bigger or equal to the maximum value, then the bar graph will be full. If a value is
between minimum and maximum value, then the bar graph will be filled proportionally.
10-27
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
6. Button : Currently this function only allows the Keypad to switch pages, other functions are not yet
available. Text input function and Image inserted functions are not yet supported.
Double click on to open set up window.
<Button Type> allows users set up buttons’ functions. <Page Jump> and <Constant Setting> are the only
two currently supported functions.
A. [Page Jump] function setting
Page Jump setting: After you choose the Page Jump function in the drop down list, you will see this
Page Jump Setting Menu
<Function Key> allows you to assign functions to the following keys on the KPC-CC01 keypad: F1,
F2, F3, F4, Up, Down, Left and Right. Please note that the Up and Down keys are locked by
TPEditor. These two keys cannot be programmed. If you want to program Up and Down keys, go to
ToolFunction Key Settings (F) Re-Define Up / Down Key (R).
Button Text: This function allows user to name buttons. For example, key in <Next Page> in the
empty space, a button will have the wording <Next Page> displayed on it.
B. [Constant setting] function
This function is to set up the memory address’ value of the VFD or PLC. When pressing the <function
button> set up in before, a value will be written to the memory address of the <Constant Setting>. This
function can be used as initializing a variable.
10-28
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
7. Clock Display Setting : The setup window of the Clock Display is shown as the image below. Time,
Day or Date can be displayed on the keypad.
Open a new file and click once in that window, you will see the following
In the clock display setting, you can choose to display Time, Day or Date on the Keypad. To adjust time,
go to #9 on the Keypad’s menu. You can also adjust Frame Setting, Font Setting and Alignment.
8. Multi-state bitmap : The setup window of the multi-state is shown as the image below. This object
reads the bit’s property value of the PLC. It defines what image or wording is when this bit is 0 or when
this bit is 1. Set the initial status to be 0 or 1 to define the displayed image or wording.
Choose from the drop down list the Metrology and the Unity Name that you need.
As for Metrology, you have the following choices: Length, Square Measure, Volume/Solid Measure,
Weight, Speed, Time and Temperature. The unit name changes automatically when you change
metrology type.
10-29
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
This menu allows you to provide parameters or communication ports and to input numbers.
Click once on this button .
Open a new file and double click on that window, you will see the following:
a. Related Device: There are two blank spaces to fill in, one is <Write> and another one is <Read>.
Input the numbers that you want to display and the corresponding numbers of a parameter and that
of a communication port. For example, input 012C to Read and Write Parameter Pr.01-44.
b. Outline Setting: The Frame setting, Font setting, Vertical Alignment and Horizontal Alignment are
the same as mentioned before. Click on the drop down menu and choose the setting that you need.
c. Function key: The setting here allows you to program keys on the keypad. Press the key on the
menu then the corresponding key on the keypad will start to blink, then press Enter to confirm the
setting.
d. Value Type & Value Length: These two factors influence the range of the Minimum and Maximum
Value of the Limit Setting. Please note that the corresponding supporting values for CP2000 have
to be 16bits. The 32bits values are not supported.
e. Value Setting: This part is set automatically by the keypad itself.
f. Limit Setting: Input the range the security setting here.
For example, if you set Function Key as F1, Minimum Value as 0 and Maximum Value as 4, then
press F1 on Keypad. Then you can press Up and Down key on the keypad to increase or decrease
the value. Press Enter Key on the keypad to confirm your setting. You can also go to parameter
table 01-44 to verify if your input value is correct.
11. Download TP Page: Press Up or Down key on the keypad until you reach #13 PC Link.
Then press Enter on the keypad and you will see the word “Waiting” on keypad’s screen. Now choose a
page that you have created then go to Communication (M) Write to TP (W) to start downloading the
page to the keypad.
When you see the word Completed on the keypad’s screen, that means the download is done.
Then you can press ESC on the keypad to go back to the menu of the keypad.
10-30
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Fault Codes
10-31
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
Warning Codes
10-32
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
These faults will happen when KPC-CC01 cannot perform the command after clicking the Enter button in
copy function.
10-33
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
10-34
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
1. Local Page Setting and Global Setting functions are not supported.
10-35
Chapter 10 Digital KeypadCP2000
10-36
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
This chapter provides a summary of parameter (Pr.) setting ranges and defaults. You can set,
changed and reset parameters through the digital keypad.
NOTE
1) : You can set this parameter during operation
2) For more detail on parameters, please refer to Ch12 Description of Parameter Settings.
00 Drive Parameters
NOTE IM: Induction Motor; PM: Permanent Magnet Motor
Pr. Parameter Name Settings Range Default
4: 230V, 0.75 kW
5: 460V, 0.75 kW
6: 230V, 1.50 kW
7: 460V, 1.50 kW
8: 230V, 2.20 kW
9: 460V, 2.20 kW
10: 230V, 3.70 kW
11: 460V, 3.70 kW
12: 230V, 5.50 kW
13: 460V, 5.50 kW
14: 230V, 7.50 kW
15: 460V, 7.50 kW
16: 230V, 11.0 kW
17: 460V, 11.0 kW
18: 230V, 15.0 kW
19: 460V, 15.0 kW
20: 230V, 18.5 kW Read
00-00 Identity code of the AC motor drive
21: 460V, 18.5 kW only
22: 230V, 22.0 kW
23: 460V, 22.0 kW
24: 230V, 30.0 kW
25: 460V, 30.0 kW
26: 230V, 37.0 kW
27: 460V, 37.0 kW
28: 230V, 45.0 kW
29: 460V, 45.0 kW
30: 230V, 55.0 kW
31: 460V, 55.0 kW
32: 230V, 75.0 kW
33: 460V, 75.0 kW
34: 230V, 90.0 kW
35: 460V, 90.0 kW
37: 460V, 110.0 kW
39: 460V, 132.0 kW
11-1
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-2
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-3
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-4
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-5
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-6
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-7
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
01 Basic Parameters
Pr. Parameter Name Settings Range Default
50.00–599.00 Hz
60.00 /
01-00 Maximum operation frequency Setting range for/including 45 kW (60 HP) and
50.00
above: 0.00–400 Hz
60.00 /
01-01 Output frequency of motor 1 0.00–599.00 Hz
50.00
230V: 0.0–255.0 V 200.0
460V: 0.0–510.0 V 400.0
01-02 Output voltage of motor 1
575V: 0.0–637.0 V 575.0
690V: 0.0–765.0 V 660.0
3.00 /
01-03 Mid-point frequency 1 of motor 1 0.00–599.00 Hz
0.00
230V: 0.0–240.0 V 11.0
460V: 0.0–480.0 V 22.0
01-04 Mid-point voltage 1 of motor 1 575V: 0.0–637.0 V 0.0
690V: 0.0–720.0 V 0.0
*690V, with 185 kW and above: 10.0
01-05 Mid-point frequency 2 of motor 1 0.00–599.00 Hz 1.50
230V: 0.0–240.0 V 5.0
460V: 0.0–480.0 V 10.0
01-06 Mid-point voltage 2 of motor 1 575V: 0.0–637.0 V 0.0
690V: 0.0–720.0 V 0.0
*690V, with 185 kW and above: 2.0
01-07 Min. output frequency of motor 1 0.00–599.00 Hz 1.50
230V: 0.0–240.0 V 1.0
460V: 0.0–480.0 V 2.0
01-08 Min. output voltage of motor 1
575V: 0.0–637.0 V 0.0
690V: 0.0–720.0 V 0.0
01-09 Start-up frequency 0.00–599.00 Hz 0.50
01-10 Output frequency upper limit 0.00–599.00 Hz 599.00
01-11 Output frequency lower limit 0.00–599.00 Hz 0.00
Pr.01-45=0: 0.00–600.00 sec.
Pr.01-45=1: 0.0–6000.0 sec.
01-12 Acceleration time 1 Motor drive with 230V/460V/690V, 22 kW and above: 10.00
60.00 / 60.0
Motor drive with 690V, 160 kW and above: 80.00 / 80.0
Pr.01-45=0: 0.00–600.00 sec.
Pr.01-45=1: 0.0–6000.0 sec.
01-13 Deceleration time 1 Motor drive with 230V/460V/690V, 22 kW and above: 10.00
60.00 / 60.0
Motor drive with 690V, 160 kW and above: 80.00 / 80.0
Pr.01-45=0: 0.00–600.00 sec.
Pr.01-45=1: 0.0–6000.0 sec.
01-14 Acceleration time 2 Motor drive with 230V/460V/690V, 22 kW and above: 10.00
60.00 / 60.0
Motor drive with 690V, 160 kW and above: 80.00 / 80.0
11-8
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-9
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-10
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-11
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-12
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-13
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-14
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-15
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-16
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-17
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-18
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-19
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-20
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
05 Motor Parameters
Pr. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
0: No function
1: Simple rolling auto-tuning test for induction motor
(IM)
05-00 Motor parameter auto tuning 0
2: Static auto-tuning for induction motor (IM)
5: Rolling auto-tuning for PM (IPM / SPM)
13: Static auto-tuning for PM (IPM / SPM)
Depending
Full-load current for induction on the
05-01 Depending on the model power model
motor 1 (A)
power
Depending
Rated power for induction motor on the
05-02 0.00–655.35 kW model
1 (kW)
power
Depending
on the
Rated speed for induction motor 0–xxxx (Depending on the number of motor poles)
05-03 number of
1 (rpm) 1710 (60Hz 4 poles); 1410 (50Hz 4 poles) motor
poles
Number of poles for induction
05-04 2–64 4
motor 1
Depending
No-load current for induction on the
05-05 0.00–Pr.05-01 default model
motor 1 (A)
power
Depending
Stator resistance (Rs) for on the
05-06 0.000–65.535 model
induction motor 1
power
Rotor resistance (Rr) for
05-07 0.000–65.535 0.000
induction motor 1
Magnetizing inductance (Lm) for
05-08 0.0–6553.5 mH 0.0
induction motor 1
Stator inductance (Lx) for
05-09 0.0–6553.5 mH 0.0
induction motor 1
Depending
Full-load current for induction on the
05-13 Depending on the model power model
motor 2 (A)
power
Depending
Rated power for induction motor on the
05-14 0.00–655.35 kW model
2 (kW)
power
Depending
on the
Rated speed for induction motor 0–xxxx (Depending on the number of motor poles)
05-15 number of
2 (rpm) 1710 (60Hz 4 poles) ; 1410 (50Hz 4 poles) motor
poles
Number of poles for induction
05-16 2–64 4
motor 2
Depending
No-load current for induction on the
05-17 0.00–Pr.05-13 default model
motor 2 (A)
power
Depending
Stator resistance (Rs) for on the
05-18 0.000–65.535 model
induction motor 2
power
Rotor resistance (Rr) for
05-19 0.000–65.535 0.000
induction motor 2
11-21
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-22
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
06 Protection Parameters
Pr. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
230V: Frame A–D: 150.0–220.0 VDC 180.0
Frame E and above : 190.0–220.0 VDC 200.0
460V: Frame A–D: 300.0–440.0 VDC 360.0
06-00 Low voltage level
Frame E and above : 380.0–440.0 VDC 400.0
575V: 420.0–520.0 VDC 470.0
690V: 450.0–660.0 VDC 480.0
0: Disabled
230V: 0.0–450.0 VDC 380.0
06-01 Over-voltage stall prevention 460V: 0.0–900.0 VDC 760.0
575V: 0.0–1116.0 VDC 920.0
690V: 0.0–1318.0 VDC 1087.0
0: Traditional over-voltage and traditional over-current
stall prevention
1: Smart over-voltage and traditional over-current stall
Selection for over-voltage stall prevention
06-02 0
prevention 2: Traditional over-voltage and smart over-current stall
prevention
3: Smart over-voltage and smart over-current stall
prevention
230V / 460V models
Light load: 0–130% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
current of the drive )
Normal load: 0–160% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
Over-current stall prevention current of the drive)
06-03
during acceleration 575V / 690V models
Light load: 0–125% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
current of the drive)
Normal load: 0–150% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
current of the drive)
230V / 460V models
Light load: 0–130% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
current of the drive )
Normal load: 0–160% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
Over-current stall prevention current of the drive)
06-04
during operation 575V / 690V models
Light load: 0–125% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
current of the drive)
Normal load: 0–150% (100% corresponds to the rated 120
current of the drive)
0: By current acceleration / deceleration time
1: By the 1st acceleration / deceleration time
Acceleration / deceleration time
2: By the 2nd acceleration / deceleration time
06-05 selection for stall prevention at 0
3: By the 3rd acceleration / deceleration time
constant speed
4: By the 4th acceleration / deceleration time
5: By auto acceleration / deceleration
11-23
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-24
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-25
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-26
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-27
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-28
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
07 Special Parameters
Pr. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
230V: 350.0–450.0 VDC 370.0
460V: 700.0–900.0 VDC 740.0
07-00 Built-in Software brake level
575V: 850.0–1116.0 VDC 895.0
690V: 939.0–1318.0 VDC 1057.0
07-01 DC brake current level 0–100% 0
07-02 DC brake time at run 0.0–60.0 sec. 0.0
07-03 DC brake time at stop 0.0–60.0 sec. 0.0
07-04 DC brake frequency at stop 0.00–599.00 Hz 0.00
07-05 Voltage increasing gain 1–200% 100
0: Stop operation
Restart after momentary power
07-06 1: Speed tracking by speed before the power loss 0
loss
2: Speed tracking by minimum output frequency
07-07 Allowed power loss duration 0.0–20.0 sec. 2.0
Depending
on the
07-08 Base block time 0.0–5.0 sec. (Depending on the model power) model
power
20–200% (100% corresponds to the light-load rated
07-09 Current limit of speed tracking 100
current of the drive)
0: Stop operation
07-10 Restart after fault action 1: Speed tracking by current speed 0
2: Speed tracking by minimum output frequency
Number of times of restart after
07-11 0–10 0
fault
0: Disable
1: Speed tracking by maximum output frequency
07-12 Speed tracking during start-up 0
2: Speed tracking by motor frequency at start
3: Speed tracking by minimum output frequency
0: Disable
1: dEb with auto acceleration / deceleration, the drive
does not output the frequency after the power is
07-13 dEb function selection restored. 0
2: dEb with auto-acceleration / auto-deceleration, the
drive outputs the frequency after the power is
restored.
07-15 Dwell time at acceleration 0.00–600.00 sec. 0.00
07-16 Dwell frequency at acceleration 0.00–599.00 Hz 0.00
07-17 Dwell time at deceleration 0.00–600.00 sec. 0.00
07-18 Dwell frequency at deceleration 0.00–599.00 Hz 0.00
0: Fan always ON
1: Fan is OFF after the AC motor drive stops for one
minute
07-19 Fan cooling control 0
2: Fan is ON when AC motor drive runs; fan is OFF
when AC motor drive stops
11-29
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-30
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-31
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
09 Communication Parameters
Pr. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
09-00 COM1 communication address 1–254 1
09-01 COM1 transmission speed 4.8–115.2 Kbps 9.6
0: Warn and continue operation
1: Fault and ramp to stop
09-02 COM1 transmission fault treatment 3
2: Fault and coast to stop
3: No warning and continue operation
09-03 COM1 time-out detection 0.0–100.0 sec. 0.0
1: 7, N, 2 (ASCII)
2: 7, E, 1 (ASCII)
3: 7, O, 1 (ASCII)
4: 7, E, 2 (ASCII)
5: 7, O, 2 (ASCII)
6: 8, N, 1 (ASCII)
7: 8, N, 2 (ASCII)
8: 8, E, 1 (ASCII)
09-04 COM1 communication protocol 9: 8, O, 1 (ASCII) 1
10: 8, E, 2 (ASCII)
11: 8, O, 2 (ASCII)
12: 8, N, 1 (RTU)
13: 8, N, 2 (RTU)
14: 8, E, 1 (RTU)
15: 8, O, 1 (RTU)
16: 8, E, 2 (RTU)
17: 8, O, 2 (RTU)
09-09 Communication response delay time 0.0–200.0 ms 2.0
09-10 Communication main frequency 0.00–599.00 Hz 60.00
09-11 Block transfer 1 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-12 Block transfer 2 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-13 Block transfer 3 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-14 Block transfer 4 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-15 Block transfer 5 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-16 Block transfer 6 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-17 Block transfer 7 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-18 Block transfer 8 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-19 Block transfer 9 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-20 Block transfer 10 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-21 Block transfer 11 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-22 Block transfer 12 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-23 Block transfer 13 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-24 Block transfer 14 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-25 Block transfer 15 0000–FFFFh 0000h
09-26 Block transfer 16 0000–FFFFh 0000h
0: Decoding method 1 (20xx)
09-30 Communication decoding method 1
1: Decoding method 2 (60xx)
11-32
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-33
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-34
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-35
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-36
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-37
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11 Advanced Parameters
11-38
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12 PUMP Parameters
Pr. Parameter Name Setting Range Default
0: No operation
1: Fixed time circulation (by time)
2: Fixed quantity circulation
12-00 Circulation Control 0
3: Fixed quantity control
4: Fixed time circulation + fixed quantity circulation
5: Fixed time circulation + fixed quantity control
Number of Motors to be
12-01 1–8 1
connected
Operating time for each motor
12-02 0–65500 min. 0
(minutes)
Delay time due to the
12-03 acceleration (or the increment ) 0.0–3600.0 sec. 1.0
at motor switching (seconds)
Delay time due to the
12-04 deceleration ( or the decrement) 0.0–3600.0 sec. 1.0
at motor switching (seconds)
Delay time due to fixed quantity
12-05 circulation at motor switching 0.0–3600.0 sec. 10.0
(seconds)
Frequency when switching
12-06 motors at fixed quantity 0.00–599.00 Hz 60.0
circulation (Hz)
0: Turn off all output
Action when fixed 1uantity
12-07 1: Motors powered by mains electricity continues to 0
circulation breaks down
operate
Frequency for stopping auxiliary
12-08 0.00–599.00 Hz 0.00
motor (Hz)
Fixed quantity circulation output
12-09 1.0–3600.0 sec. 1.0
delay
Motor 1 operation record Read
12-10 Read only
(min./sec.) Only
Read
12-11 Motor 1 operation record (hour) Read only
Only
Motor 2 operation record Read
12-12 Read only
(min./sec.) Only
Read
12-13 Motor 2 operation record (hour) Read only
Only
Motor 3 operation record Read
12-14 Read only
(min./sec.) Only
Read
12-15 Motor 3 operation record (hour) Read only
Only
Motor 4 operation record Read
12-16 Read only
(min./sec.) Only
Read
12-17 Motor 4 operation record (hour) Read only
Only
11-39
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-40
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-41
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-42
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
14-36 0: 0–10 V 0
AO10 output selection
1: 0–20 mA
14-37 AO11 output selection 2: 4–20 mA 0
11-43
Chapter 11 Summary of Parameter SettingsCP2000
11-44
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
460V Series
Frame A B C
kW 0.75 1.5 2.2 3.7 4.0 5.5 7.5 11 15 18.5 22 30 37
HP 1 2 3 5 5 7.5 10 15 20 25 30 40 50
Identity code 5 7 9 11 93 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27
Rated current for
3 4.2 5.5 8.5 10.5 13 18 24 32 38 45 60 73
light load [A]
Rated current for
2.8 3.0 4.0 6.0 9.0 10.5 12 18 24 32 38 45 60
normal load [A]
12.1-00-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
460V Series
Frame D0 D E F G H
kW 45 55 75 90 110 132 160 185 220 280 315 355 400 500
HP 60 75 100 125 150 175 215 250 300 375 425 475 536 675
Identity code 29 31 33 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 51 53 55
Rated current for
91 110 150 180 220 260 310 370 460 530 616 683 770 930
light load [A]
Rated current for
73 91 110 150 180 220 260 310 370 460 550 616 683 866
normal load [A]
575V Series
Frame A B
kW 1.5 2.2 3.7 5.5 7.5 11 15
HP 2 3 5 7.5 10 15 20
Identity code 505 506 507 508 509 510 511
Rated current for
3 4.3 6.7 9.9 12.1 18.7 24.2
light load [A]
Rated current for
2.5 3.6 5.5 8.2 10 15.5 20
normal load [A]
690V Series
Frame C D E
kW 18.5 22 30 37 45 55 75 90 110 132
HP 25 30 40 50 60 75 100 125 150 175
Identity code 612 613 614 615 616 617 618 619 620 621
Rated current for
24 30 36 45 54 67 86 104 125 150
light load [A]
Rated current for
20 24 30 36 45 54 67 86 104 125
normal load [A]
Frame F G H
kW 160 200 250 315 400 450 560 630
HP 215 270 335 425 530 600 745 840
Identity code 622 686 687 626 628 629 631 632
Rated current for
180 220 290 350 430 465 590 675
light load [A]
Rated current for
150 180 220 290 350 385 465 675
normal load [A]
Parameter Reset
Default: 0
Settings 0: No Function
1: Write protection for parameters
5: Reset kWh display to 0
6: Reset PLC (including CANopen Master Index)
7: Reset CANopen Index (Slave)
9: Reset all parameters to defaults with base frequency at 50 Hz
10: Reset all parameters to defaults with base frequency at 60 Hz
12.1-00-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When set to 1, all parameters are read only except Pr.00-02, Pr.00-07 and Pr.00-08. Set Pr.00-02
to 0 before changing other parameter settings.
When set to 5, kWh displayed value can be reset to 0 even when the drive is operating. Pr.05-26,
Pr.05-27, Pr.05-28, Pr.05-29 and Pr.05-30 are reset to 0.
When set to 6, clear internal PLC program (includes the related settings of PLC internal CANopen
master)
When set to 7, reset the related settings of CANopen slave.
When set to 9 or 10, reset all parameters to defaults. If there is a password set in Pr.00-08, enter
the password set in Pr.00-07 to reset to default.
When it is set to 6, 7, 9 and 10, reboot the motor drive after setting.
12.1-00-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Status 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
12.1-00-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
If Pr.00-04 is set to 17 or 20, it displays in hexadecimal “0001h” with LED u page is ON in the
keypad.
The setting value 17 is ON / OFF status of digital output according to Pr.02-18 setting, and the
setting value 20 is the corresponding CPU pin ON / OFF status of the digital output.
You can set 17 to monitor the digital output status, and then set 20 to check if the circuit is
normal.
Explanation 4
Setting value 25: when displayed value reaches 100.00%, the drive shows “oL” as an overload
warning.
Explanation 5
Setting value 38:
bit 0: The drive is running forward.
bit 1: The drive is running backward.
bit 2: The drive is ready.
bit 3: Errors occurred on the drive.
bit 4: The drive is running.
bit 5: Warnings occurred on the drive.
Software Version
Default: Read only
Settings Read only
Parameter Protection Password Input
Default: 0
Settings 0–65535
Display 0–4 (the number of password attempts)
This parameter allows you to enter your password (which is set in Pr.00-08) to unlock the
parameter protection and to make changes to the parameter.
To avoid problems in the future, be sure to write down the password after you set this parameter.
Pr.00-07 and Pr.00-08 are used to prevent personnel from setting other parameters by accident.
If you forget the password, clear the password setting by entering 9999 and press the ENTER
key, then enter 9999 again and press ENTER within 10 seconds. After decoding, all the settings
return to default.
When setting is under password protection, all the parameters read 0, except Pr.00-08.
12.1-00-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-00-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When Pr.00-10=0, and you set Pr.00-11 to 0, the V/F control diagram is as follows:
When Pr.00-10=0, and you set Pr.00-11 to 2, the space vector control diagram is as follows.
Induction Motor Space Vector Control (IMSVC)
12.1-00-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Load Selection
Default: 0
Settings 0: Light load
1: Normal load
Light load (230V & 460V series): over-load rated output current 120% in 60 seconds. Refer to
Pr.00-17 for the setting for the carrier wave. Refer to Pr.00-01 or the specification table in Section
09 for the rated current.
Normal load of 230V & 460V: over-load rated output current 120% in 60 seconds (160%, 3
seconds). Refer to Pr.00-17 for the setting for the carrier wave. Refer to Pr.00-01 or the
specification table in Section 9 for the rated current.
Pr.00-01 varies with the setting value for Pr.00-16. The default value and maximum setting value
for Pr.06-03 and Pr.06-04 also vary with the setting value for Pr.00-16.
Carrier Frequency
Default: Table below
Settings 2–15 kHz
This parameter determinates the PWM carrier frequency for the AC motor drive.
230V
Settings 2–15 kHz 2–10 kHz 2–9 kHz
Models 1–20 HP [0.75–15 kW] 25–60 HP [18.5–45 kW] 75–125 HP [55–90 kW]
Light Load
Default 8 kHz 6 kHz 4 kHz
Normal Models 0.5–15 HP [0.4–11 kW] 20–50 HP [15–37 kW] 60–100 HP [45–75 kW]
Load Default 8 kHz 6 kHz 4k Hz
460V
Settings 2–15 kHz 2–10 kHz 2–9 kHz
Models 1–25 HP [0.75–18.5 kW] 30–100 HP [22–75 kW] 125–536 HP [90–400 kW]
Light Load
Default 8 kHz 6 kHz 4 kHz
Normal Models 0.5–20 HP [0.4–15 kW] 25–75 HP [18.5–55 kW] 100–475 HP [75–355 kW]
Load Default 8 kHz 6 kHz 4 kHz
12.1-00-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
575V 690V
Settings 2–9 kHz 2–9 kHz
Models 2–20 HP [1.5–15 kW] 25–745 HP [18.5–560 kW]
Light Load
Default 4 kHz 4 kHz*1
Normal Models 2–20 HP [1.5–15 kW] 25–745 HP [18.5–560 kW]
Load Default 4 kHz 4 kHz*1
*1. Light load / Normal load: the default for 690V, 630 kW [850 HP] model is 3 kHz.
From the table, you see that the PWM carrier frequency has significant influences on the
electromagnetic noise, the AC motor drive heat dissipation, and the motor acoustic noise.
Therefore, if the surrounding noise is greater than the motor noise, lower the carrier frequency to
reduce the temperature rise. Although the motor has quiet operation in the higher carrier
frequency, consider the entire wiring and interference.
When the carrier frequency is higher than the default, decrease the carrier frequency to protect
the drive. Refer to Pr.06-55 for the related setting and details.
Master Frequency Command (AUTO) Source / Source Selection of the PID Target
Default: 0
Settings 0: Digital keypad
1: RS-485 communication
2: External analog input (Pr.03-00)
3: External UP/DOWN terminal (multi-function input terminal)
6: CANopen communication card
8: Communication card (does not include CANopen card)
Set the master frequency source in AUTO mode.
Pr.00-20 and Pr.00-21 are for settings the frequency source and operation source in AUTO mode.
Pr.00-30 and Pr.00-31 are for settings the frequency source and operation source in HAND mode.
You can switch the AUTO/HAND mode with the keypad KPC-CC01 or the multi-function input
terminal (MI).
The default for the frequency source or operation source is AUTO mode. It returns to AUTO mode
whenever you cycle the power. If you use a multi-function input terminal to switch between AUTO
and HAND mode, the highest priority is the multi-function input terminal. When the external
terminal is OFF, the drive does not accept any operation signal and cannot execute JOG.
12.1-00-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Stop Method
Default: 0
Settings 0: Ramp to stop
1: Coast to stop
Determines how the motor is stopped when the drive receives the Stop command.
Ramp to stop: the AC motor drive decelerates to 0 or the minimum output frequency according
to the set deceleration time, and then to stop (according to Pr.01-07).
Coast to stop: the AC motor drive stops output immediately, and the motor coasts to stop
according to the load inertia.
(1) Use “ramp to stop” for the safety of personnel, or to prevent material from being wasted in
applications where the motor must stop immediately after the drive stops. You must set the
deceleration time accordingly.
(2) If idling is allowed, or the load inertia is large, use “coast to stop”. For example, blowers,
punching machines and pumps
12.1-00-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
User-Defined Characteristics
Default: 0
Settings bit0–3: user-defined decimal place
0000b: no decimal place
0001b: one decimal place
0010b: two decimal place
0011b: three decimal place
bit4–15: user-defined unit
000xh: Hz
001xh: rpm
002xh: %
003xh: kg
004xh: m/s
005xh: kW
006xh: HP
007xh: ppm
008xh: 1/m
009xh: kg/s
00Axh: kg/m
00Bxh: kg/h
00Cxh: lb/s
00Dxh: lb/m
00Exh: lb/h
00Fxh: ft/s
010xh: ft/m
011xh: m
012xh: ft
013xh: degC
014xh: degF
015xh: mbar
016xh: bar
017xh: Pa
019xh: mWG
01Axh: inWG
01Bxh: ftWG
01Cxh: psi
12.1-00-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
01Cxh: psi
01Dxh: atm
01Exh: L/s
01Fxh: L/m
020xh: L/h
021xh: m3/s
022xh: m3/h
023xh: GPM
024xh: CFM
xxxxh: Hz
bit0–3: the control frequency F page, user-defined unit (Pr.00-04=d10, PID feedback value) and
the number of decimal places (Pr.00-26) which supports up to three decimal places.
bit4–15: the control frequency F page, user-defined unit (Pr.00-04=d10, PID feedback value) and
the displayed units for Pr.00-26.
12.1-00-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
User-Defined Value
Default: Read only
Settings Read only
Pr.00-27 displays the user-defined value when Pr.00-26 is not set to 0.
The user-defined value is valid when Pr.00-20 (frequency source) is set to the digital keypad or to
RS-485 communication.
12.1-00-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When you do not set Pr.00-29 to 0, the Local / Remote function is enabled, and the top right
corner of digital keypad KPC-CC01 (firmware version 1.021 and above) displays “LOC” or “REM”.
Set the REMOTE frequency and operation source with Pr.00-20 and Pr.00-21. Set the LOCAL
frequency and operation source with Pr.00-30 and Pr.00-31. Select or switch Local / Remote
mode with the digital keypad KPC-CC01 or set the multi-function input terminal MIx=56. The
AUTO key of the digital keypad is for the REMOTE function, and HAND key is for the LOCAL
function.
When you set the external terminal (MI) to 56 for LOC / REM mode selection, if you set Pr.00-29
to 0, then the external terminal function is disabled.
When you set the external terminal (MI) to 56 for LOC / REM mode selection, if Pr.00-29 is not
set to 0, then AUTO / HAND key is disabled, and the external terminal has the highest command
priority.
Following table is the corresponded setting value for the PLC address:
PLC address / HOA mode LOC / REM mode HOA mode
Mode HAND-ON AUTO-ON LOC-ON REM-ON OFF
M1090 = 0 0 0 0 1
M1091 = 1 0 0 0 0
M1092 = 0 1 0 0 0
M1100 = 0 0 1 0 0
M1101 = 0 0 0 1 0
12.1-00-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
The default for the frequency source or operation source is AUTO mode. It returns to AUTO
mode whenever you cycle the power. If you use a multi-function input terminal to switch AUTO /
HAND mode, the multi-function input terminal has the highest priority. When the external terminal
is OFF, the drive does not accept any operation signal and cannot execute JOG.
12.1-00-15
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
01 Basic Parameters
You can set this parameter during operation.
Maximum Operation Frequency
Default: 60.00 / 50.00
Settings 50.00–599.00 Hz
Setting range for / including 230V, 55 kW: 0.00–400.00 Hz
Setting range for / including 460V, 90 kW: 0.00–400.00 Hz
Setting Range for / including 575V / 690V: 599.00 Hz
Determines the AC motor drive’s maximum operation frequency range. This setting corresponds
to the maximum value for the analog input frequency setting signal (0 – +10 V, 4–20 mA, 0–20
mA, ±10 V).
Minimum Carrier Wave Requirement Maximum Operation Frequency (IM VF/ IM SVC)
2k 200 Hz
3k 300 Hz
4k 400 Hz
5k 500 Hz
6k 599 Hz
230V series 55 kW and above, maximum operation frequency is 400 Hz (carrier should be set at least 4k)
460V series 90 kW and above, maximum operation frequency is 400 Hz (carrier should be set at least 4k)
575V / 690V series, maximum operation frequency is 599 Hz
12.1-01-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-01-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-01-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-01-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Start-Up Frequency
Default: 0.50
Settings 0.00–599.00 Hz
When the starting frequency is higher than the minimum output frequency, the drives’ output is
from the starting frequency to the setting frequency. Refer to the following diagram for details.
Fcmd: frequency command
Fstart: start-up frequency (Pr.01-09)
fstart: actual start-up frequency of drive
Fmin: 4th output frequency setting (Pr.01-07 / Pr.01-41)
Flow: output frequency lower limit (Pr.01-11)
12.1-01-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
The lower output frequency limits the minimum output frequency of the drive. When the drive
frequency command or feedback control frequency is lower than this setting, the lower limit of the
frequency limits the drive output frequency.
When the drive starts, it operates from the minimum output frequency (Pr.01-07) and accelerates
to the setting frequency. It is not limited by the lower output frequency settings.
Use the output frequency upper and lower limit settings to prevent operator misuse, overheating
caused by operating at a too low frequency, or damage caused by excessive speed.
If the output frequency upper limit setting is 50 Hz and frequency setting is 60 Hz, the maximum
output frequency is 50 Hz.
If the output frequency lower limit setting is 10 Hz and the minimum operation frequency setting
(Pr.01-07) is 1.5 Hz, the drive operates at 10 Hz when the frequency command is higher than
Pr.01-07 and less than 10 Hz. If the frequency command is less than Pr.01-07, the drive stays in
ready status with no output.
12.1-01-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
If the frequency output upper limit is 60 Hz and frequency setting is also 60 Hz, only the
frequency command is limited in 60 Hz. The actual frequency output may exceed 60 Hz if the
drive starts the slip compensation function.
Acceleration Time 1
Deceleration Time 1
Acceleration Time 2
Deceleration Time 2
Acceleration Time 3
Deceleration Time 3
Acceleration Time 4
Deceleration Time 4
JOG Acceleration Time
JOG Deceleration Time
Default: 10.00
Default: 60.00 / 60.0 (22 kW and above models)
Default: 80.00 / 80.0 (160 kW and above models)
Settings Pr.01-45=0: 0.00–600.00 seconds
Pr.01-45=1: 0.0–6000.0 seconds
Use the acceleration time to determine the time required for the AC motor drive to accelerate
from 0.00 Hz to maximum output frequency (Pr.01-00). Use the deceleration time to determine
the time required for the AC motor drive to decelerate from maximum output frequency (Pr.01-00)
down to 0.00 Hz.
The acceleration and deceleration time are invalid when using Pr.01-44 Auto-acceleration and
Auto-deceleration Setting
Select the acceleration and deceleration time 1, 2, 3 and 4 with the multi-function input terminals
settings. The defaults are acceleration and deceleration time 1.
With the enabled torque limits and stall prevention functions, the actual acceleration and
deceleration time are longer than the above action time.
Note that setting the acceleration time too short may trigger the protection function (Pr.06-03
Over-current Stall Prevention during Acceleration or Pr.06-01 Over-voltage Stall Prevention).
Note that setting the deceleration time too short may cause motor damage or trigger drive
protection due to over-current during deceleration or over-voltage.
Use suitable brake resistor (refer to Section 07 Optional Accessories) to decelerate in a short
time and prevent over-voltage.
When you enable Pr.01-24–Pr.01-27, the actual acceleration and deceleration time are longer
than the setting.
12.1-01-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
JOG Frequency
Default: 6.00
Settings 0.00–599.00 Hz
You can use both the external terminal JOG and F1 key on the optional keypad KPC-CC01 to set
the JOG function. When the JOG command is ON, the AC motor drive accelerates from 0Hz to
the JOG frequency (Pr.01-22). When the JOG command is OFF, the AC motor drive decelerates
from the JOG Frequency to stop. The JOG acceleration and deceleration time (Pr.01-20,
Pr.01-21) are the time to accelerate from 0.0 Hz to JOG frequency (Pr.01-22).
You cannot execute the JOG command when the AC motor drive is running. When the JOG
command is executing, other operation commands are invalid.
12.1-01-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Frequency
01-25 01-26
Time
01-24 01-27
12.1-01-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Set the AC motor drive’s skip frequency. The drive’s frequency setting skips these frequency
ranges. However, the frequency output is continuous. There are no limits for these six parameters
and you can combine them. Pr.01-28 does not need to be greater than Pr.01-29; Pr.01-30 does
not need to be greater than Pr.01-31; Pr.01-32 does not need to be greater than Pr.01-33.
These parameters set the skip frequency ranges for the AC motor drive. You can use this function
to avoid frequencies that cause mechanical resonance. The skip frequencies are useful when a
motor has resonance vibration at a specific frequency bandwidth. Skipping this frequency avoids
the vibration. There are three frequency skip zones available.
You can set the frequency command (F) within the range of skip frequencies. Then the output
frequency (H) is limited to the lower limit of skip frequency ranges.
When accelerating and decelerating, the output frequency still passes the skip frequency ranges.
Zero-speed Mode
Default: 0
Settings 0: Waiting for output
1: Zero-speed operation
2: Minimum frequency (Refer to Pr.01-07, Pr.01-41)
When the frequency command of drive is less than Fmin (Pr.01-07 or Pr.01-41), the drive
operates according to the setting value.
0: the AC motor drive is in waiting mode without voltage output from terminals U, V, W.
1: the drive executes the DC brake by Vmin (Pr.01-08 and Pr.01-42) in V/F and SVC modes.
2: the AC motor drive runs using Fmin (Pr.01-07, Pr.01-41) and Vmin (Pr.01-08, Pr.01-42) in V/F
and SVC modes.
In V/F and SVC modes
12.1-01-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-01-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-01-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Use this to set the time to decelerate from the maximum operation frequency (Pr.01-00) to 0.00
Hz by CANopen control.
12.1-01-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Settings: 0
2-wire mode 1
FWD/STOP
REV/STOP
Settings: 1
2-wire mode 2
RUN/STOP
REV/FWD
Settings: 2
3-wire operation control
12.1-02-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
0 No Function
Multi-step speed
1
command 1
Multi-step speed You can set 15 steps of speed or 15 positions with the digital status
2
command 2 of these 4 terminals. You can use 16-steps of speed if you include
Multi-step speed the master speed when setting as 15 steps of speed. (Refer to
3
command 3 Parameter Group 04 Multi-step Speed Parameters.)
Multi-step speed
4
command 4
12.1-02-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
6 JOG Command
When you enable this function, the drive stops acceleration and
deceleration immediately. After you disable this function, the AC
motor drive starts to accelerate or decelerate from the inhibit point.
Acceleration /
7 deceleration speed
inhibit
The 1st, 2nd acceleration You can select the acceleration and deceleration time of the drive
8 or deceleration time with this function, or from the digital status of the terminals; there
selection are four acceleration and deceleration selection.
MIx=9 MIx=8 Accel./Decel.
The 3rd, 4th acceleration OFF OFF 1st Accel./Decel.
9 or deceleration time OFF ON 2nd Accel./Decel.
selection ON OFF 3rd Accel./Decel.
ON ON 4th Accel./Decel.
For external fault input. The drive decelerates according to the
EF Input Pr.07-20 setting, and the keypad shows EF. (It shows the fault
10
(EF: External fault) record when an external fault occurs). The drive keeps running until
the fault is cleared (terminal status restored) after RESET.
12.1-02-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Output Stop
12
(Output pause)
Cancel the setting for Set Pr.01-44 to one of the Pr.01-04 setting modes before using this
13 auto-acceleration / function. When this function is enabled, OFF is for auto mode and
auto-deceleration time ON is for linear acceleration / deceleration.
Switch between motor 1 ON: use parameters for motor 2 .
14
and motor 2 OFF: use parameters for motor 1.
ON: force the source of the frequency to be AVI1. (If the rotating
Rotating speed
15 speed commands are set to AVI1, ACI and AVI2 at the same time,
command from AVI1
the priority is AVI1>ACI>AVI2)
ON: force the source of the frequency to be ACI. (If the rotating
Rotating speed
16 speed commands are set to AVI1, ACI and AVI2 at the same time.
command form ACI
The priority is AVI1>ACI>AVI2)
ON: force the source of the frequency to be AVI2. (If the rotating
Rotating speed
17 speed commands are set to AVI1, ACI and AVI2 at the same time.
command form AVI2
The priority is AVI1>ACI>AVI2)
18 Forced to stop (Pr.07-20) ON: the drive ramps to stop according to Pr.07-20 setting.
ON: the frequency of the drive increases or decreases by one unit.
19 Digital Up command
If this function remains ON continuously, the frequency increases
or decreases according to Pr.02-09 / Pr.02-10.
The Frequency command returns to zero when the drive stops, and
20 Digital Down command
the displayed frequency is 0.0 Hz. If you select Pr.11-00, bit7 = 1,
the frequency is not saved.
21 PID function disabled ON: the PID function is disabled.
ON: the current counter value is cleared and displays “0”. The drive
22 Clear the counter
counts up when this function is disabled.
12.1-02-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Signal confirmation for When the control mode is V/F, ON: the drive operates by the first
29
Y-connection V/F.
Signal confirmation for When the control mode is V/F, ON: the drive operates by the
30
-connection second V/F.
Disable EEPROM write
ON: writing to EEPROM is disabled. Changed parameters are not
38 function (parameters
saved after power off
memory disable)
40 Force coasting to stop ON: during operation, the drive free runs to stop.
12.1-02-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
LOCAL / REMOTE KPC-CC01 displays the LOC / REM status. (KPC-CC01 firmware
56 version 1.021 and above).
Selection
bit 0
REM 0
LOC 1
Enable fire mode with Enable this function under fire mode to force the drive to run (while
58
RUN Command there is RUN command).
Enable fire mode Enable this function under fire mode to force the drive to run (while
59
without RUN Command there is not a RUN command).
ON: when the multi-motor circulative control is enable, all motors
60 Disable all the motors
coast to stop.
61 Disable Motor 1
62 Disable Motor 2
These functions work with multi-motor circulative control, motor 1 to
63 Disable Motor 3
8 can be set to coast to stop. If any of Auxiliary Motor 1 to Motor 8 is
64 Disable Motor 4
out of order or under maintenance, enable this terminal to bypass
65 Disable Motor 5
that motor.
66 Disable Motor 6
67 Disable Motor 7
12.1-02-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When Pr.02-09 is set to 1: the increasing / decreasing frequency command (F) operates
according to the setting for Pr.02-10 (0.01–1.00 Hz/ms).
12.1-02-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
time for confirmation. The confirmation prevents interference that could cause error in the input to
the digital terminals. In the meanwhile, it delays the response time, though confirmation improves
accuracy.
12.1-02-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Mechanical Brake Active when the drive runs after the set delayed time for Pr.02-32.
12
Release (Pr.02-32) This function must use with DC brake function.
Active when IGBT or heat sink overheats, to prevent the drive from
13 Over-heat warning
shutting down due to over-heating (refer to Pr.06-15).
Software brake signal
14 Active when the soft brake function is ON (refer to Pr.07-00).
indication
15 PID feedback error Active when the PID feedback signal error is detected.
16 Slip Error (oSL) Active when the slip error is detected.
Count value reached, When the drive executes external counter, this contact is active if the
17 does not return to 0 count value is equal to the setting value for Pr.02-20. This contact is
(Pr.02-20) not active when the setting value for Pr.02-20 > Pr.02-19.
Counter value reached, When the drive executes the external counter, this contact is active if
18
returns to 0 (Pr. 02-19) the count value is equal to the setting value for Pr. 02-19.
External interrupt B.B.
19 Active when external interrupt (B.B.) stop output occurs in the drive.
input (Base Block)
20 Warning Output Active when a warning is detected.
21 Over-voltage Active when the over-voltage is detected.
Over-current stall
22 Active when the over-current stall prevention is detected.
prevention
Over-voltage stall
23 Active when the over-voltage stall prevention is detected.
prevention
Operation mode Active when the operation command is controlled by external terminal.
24
indication (Pr.00-21≠0)
25 Forward command Active when the operation direction is forward.
26 Reverse command Active when the operation direction is reverse.
Output when Current ≥
27 Active when the current is ≥ Pr.02-33.
Pr.02-33
Output when Current <
28 Active when the current is < Pr.02-33
Pr.02-33
Output when frequency
29 Active when the frequency is ≥ Pr.02-34.
≥ Pr.02-34
Output when Frequency
30 Active when the frequency is < Pr.02-34.
< Pr.02-34
Y-connection for the Active when Pr.05-24=1, the frequency output is lower than Pr.05-23
31
motor coil minus 2Hz, and the time is longer than Pr.05-25.
∆-connection for the Active when Pr.05-24=1, the frequency output is higher than Pr.05-23
32
motor coil plus 2Hz, and the time is longer than Pr.05-25.
Zero Speed (actual Active when the actual output frequency is 0. (the drive is in RUN
33
output frequency) mode)
Zero Speed includes
34 stop (actual output Active when the actual output frequency is 0 or Stopped.
frequency)
Error output selection 1
35 Active when Pr.06-23 is ON.
(Pr.06-23)
Error output selection 2
36 Active when Pr.06-24 is ON.
(Pr.06-24)
12.1-02-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
UVW output
45 electromagnetic valve
switch
12.1-02-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
In addition, the AI and DI values can be read directly, and DO and AO have to be controlled by
Modbus for corresponding parameter functions. The tables below shown the related parameter
definition.
DO
Terminal Pr. Setting Direct control the index corresponded to Modbus
RY1 Pr.02-13 = 51 bit0 of 2640h
RY2 Pr.02-14 = 51 bit1 of 2640h
RY3 Pr.02-15 = 51 bit2 of 2640h
MO10 / RY10 Pr.02-36 = 51 bit5 of 2640h
MO11 / RY11 Pr.02-37 = 51 bit6 of 2640h
MO12 Pr.02-38 = 51 bit7 of 2640h
MO13 Pr.02-39 = 51 bit8 of 2640h
MO14 Pr.02-40 = 51 bit9 of 2640h
MO15 Pr.02-41 = 51 bit10 of 2640h
AO
Terminal Pr. Setting Direct control the index corresponded to Modbus
AFM1 Pr.03-20 = 21 The value of 26A0h
AFM2 Pr.03-23 = 21 The value of 26A1h
AFM10 Pr.14-12 = 21 The value of 26AAh
AFM11 Pr.14-13 = 21 The value of 26ABh
12.1-02-15
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-16
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
H
Fcmd=60Hz
42Hz
02-24=40Hz 40Hz
02-25=2Hz 38Hz
12Hz
02-22=10Hz 10Hz
02-23=2Hz 8Hz
T
02-13,02-14,
=3
02-36,02-37,
02-13,02-14,
02-36,02-37, =4
This parameter is invalid if it is used without DC brake. Refer to the following operation timing.
12.1-02-17
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-18
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
For Example:
When Pr.02-50 displays 0034h (hex), (that is, the value is 52 (decimal), and 110100 (binary)). It
means MI1, MI3 and MI4 are ON.
Example:
When Pr.02-51 displays 000Bh (hex) (that is, the value is 11 (decimal), and 100011
(binary)). It means that RY1, RY2 and MO10 are ON.
0=OFF
1=ON
Setting
Reserved
Note
Reserved
12.1-02-19
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Example:
When Pr.02-52 displays 0034h (hex) (that is, the value is 110100 (binary)), it means MI1, MI3 and
MI4 are used by PLC.
12.1-02-20
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Example:
When Pr.02-53 displays 0003h (hex), it means that RY1 and RY2 are used by PLC.
IO Card Types
Default: Read only
Settings 1: EMC-BPS01
4: EMC-D611A
5: EMC-D42A
6: EMC-R6AA
11: EMC-A22A
Preheating Output Current Level
Default: 0
Settings 0–100%
When a motor drive is not in operation (STOP) and is placed in a cold and humid environment,
enabling the preheating function to output DC current to heat up the motor drive can prevent the
invasion of humidity into the motor drive, which creates condensation affects the normal function
of the motor drive.
Sets the output current level from the motor drive to the motor after enabling the preheating. The
percentage of the preheating DC current is 100% of the rated current of the motor drive (Pr.05-01,
Pr.05-13 and Pr.05-34). When setting this parameter, slowly increase the percentage to reach
the sufficient preheating temperature.
12.1-02-21
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Drive STOP
A
02-72≠0
Pre-Heat
02-73≠0
Running
Enable preheating: When Pr.02-72 and Pr.02-73 are NOT set to zero.
Preheating function A: If Pr.07-72 and Pr.07-23 are set before the motor drive stops operation
(STOP), preheating is enabled right after the motor drive stops. However, if Pr.07-72 and
Pr.07-73 are set after the motor drives stops operation, preheating is not enabled. Preheating is
enabled only when the motor drive stops again or restarts.
Preheating function B: When the motor drive is in operation (RUN) or stops operating (STOP),
set Pr.02-72 and Pr.02-73 between 1–100% and set MFI= 69 and MFI = ON. Preheating is
enabled whenever the motor drive stops; no matter the motor drive is in operation (RUN) or stops
operating (STOP).
Preheating priority: if preheating function A and B are both enabled, function B takes priority.
12.1-02-22
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-23
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-02-24
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
In the diagram below: Black line: Curve with no bias. Gray line: curve with bias
1.
2.
12.1-03-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
3.
4.
5.
12.1-03-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
6.
7.
8.
12.1-03-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
9.
10.
11.
12.1-03-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.
13.
14.
12.1-03-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
15.
16.
17.
12.1-03-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
18.
19.
20.
12.1-03-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
21.
22.
23.
12.1-03-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
24.
25.
26.
12.1-03-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
27.
28.
29.
12.1-03-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
30.
31.
32.
12.1-03-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
33.
34.
35.
12.1-03-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
36.
37.
38.
12.1-03-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
39.
40.
12.1-03-15
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-16
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-17
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-18
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Example 1, AFM2 0–10 V is set to the output frequency, the output equation is:
10 V * (output frequency / Pr.01-00) * Pr.03-24 + 10 V * Pr.03-27
Example 2, AFM2 0–20 mA is set to the output frequency, the output equation is:
20 mA*(output frequency / Pr.01-00) * Pr.03-24 + 20 mA * Pr.03-27
Example 3, AFM2 4–20 mA is set to the output frequency, the output equation is:
4 mA+16 mA * (output frequency / Pr.01-00) * Pr.03-24 + 16 mA * Pr.03-27
This parameter sets the corresponding voltage for the analog output 0.
For Example:
When Pr.03-30 displays 0002h (hex), it means that AFM2 is used by PLC.
12.1-03-19
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
AFM1 Filter Output Time
AFM2 Filter Output Time
Default: 0.01
Settings 0.00–20.00 sec.
12.1-03-20
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-21
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-22
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
ACI Mid-Point
Default:
12.00 / 5.00 / 10.00
Settings Pr.03-29=0, 0.00–20.00 mA
Pr.03-29=1, 0.00–10.00 V
Pr.03-29=2, 0.00–20.00 mA
ACI Proportional Mid-Point
Default: 50.00
Settings -100.00–100.00%
ACI Highest Point
Default:
20.00 / 10.00 / 20.00
Settings Pr.03-29=0, 0.00–20.00 mA
Pr.03-29=1, 0.00–10.00 V
Pr.03-29=2, 0.00–20.00 mA
ACI Proportional Highest Point
Default: 100.00
Settings -100.00–100.00%
When Pr.03-29=1, ACI setting is 0–10 V and the unit is in voltage (V). When Pr.03-29≠1, ACI
12.1-03-23
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-03-24
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When ACI Selection (Pr.03-29) is 0–10 V, the setting ranges for Pr.03-57, Pr.03-59 and Pr.03-61
must be 0.00–10.00 or 0.00–20.00.
Set the analog input values at Pr.03-51–Pr.03-68 and the maximum operating frequency at
Pr.01-00. The corresponding functions of open-loop control are shown as image below.
12.1-03-25
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-04-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
PLC Buffer 0
PLC Buffer 1
PLC Buffer 2
PLC Buffer 3
PLC Buffer 4
PLC Buffer 5
PLC Buffer 6
PLC Buffer 7
PLC Buffer 8
PLC Buffer 9
PLC Buffer 10
PLC Buffer 11
PLC Buffer 12
PLC Buffer 13
PLC Buffer 14
PLC Buffer 15
PLC Buffer 16
PLC Buffer 17
PLC Buffer 18
PLC Buffer 19
Default: 0
Settings 0–65535
You can combine the PLC buffer with the built-in PLC function for a variety of applications.
12.1-04-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-04-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
05 Motor Parameters
This parameter can be set during operation.
Motor Parameter Auto-Tuning
Default: 0
Settings 0: No function
1: Rolling auto-tuning for induction motor(IM)
2: Static auto-tuning for induction motor
5: Rolling auto-tuning for PM (SPM)
13: Static auto-tuning for PM
Refer to Section 12-2 “Adjustment and Application” for more details of motor adjustment process.
12.1-05-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Set up Pr.01-01 and Pr.05-03 before setting up Pr.05-04 to make sure motor operates normally.
Pr.01-01 and Pr.05-03 determine the maximum set up number poles for the IM.
For example: Pr.01-01=20 Hz and Pr.05-03=39 rpm, according to the equation 120 x 20 Hz /
39rpm=61.5 and take even number, the number of poles is 60. Therefore, Pr.05-04 can be set to
the maximum of 60 poles.
12.1-05-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-05-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-05-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-05-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Example: When Pr. 05-30 = 76 MWh and Pr. 05-29 = 150 kWh, Pr. 05-28 = 400 Wh (or 0.4 kWh),
the accumulated total kilowatts of the motor per hour = 76 x 1000000 + 150 x 1000 + 40 =
76150400Wh = 76150.4 kWh
12.1-05-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Above
Rated Power [kW] 14.1 18.2 27 33 40 46 54
54
Rotor Inertia [kg-cm2] 211.0 265.0 308.0 527.0 866.0 1082.0 1267.6 1515.0
12.1-05-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
06 Protection Parameters
This parameter can be set during operation.
Low Voltage Level
Default:
Settings 230V series: Frame A–D: 150.0–220.0 VDC 180.0
Frame E and above: 190.0–220.0 VDC 200.0
460V series: Frame A–D: 300.0–440.0 VDC 360.0
Frame E and above: 380.0–440.0 VDC 400.0
575V series: 420.0–520.0 VDC 470.0
690V series: 450.0–660.0 VDC 480.0
Sets the Low Voltage (Lv) level. When the DC bus voltage is lower than Pr.06-00, the drive stops
output and the motor free runs to stop.
If the Lv fault is triggered during operation, the drive stops output and the motor free runs to stop.
There are three Lv faults: LvA (Lv during acceleration), Lvd (Lv during deceleration), and Lvn (Lv
in constant speed) that are triggered according to the status of acceleration or deceleration. You
must press RESET to clear the Lv fault. The drive automatically restarts if you set to restart after
momentary power loss (refer to Pr.07-06 Restart after Momentary Power Loss and Pr.07-07
Allowed Power Loss Duration for details).
If the Lv fault is triggered when the drive is in STOP status, the drive displays LvS (Lv during
stop), which is not recorded, and the drive restarts automatically when the input voltage is higher
than Pr.06-00 + Lv return level (as listed below).
Lv Return Level 230V 460V 575V 690V
Frame A–D 30 VDC 60 VDC 100 VDC 100 VDC
Frame E–H 40 VDC 80 VDC N/A 120 VDC
V
DC Bus Voltage
Lv Return Level
06-00
Lv Error
time
12.1-06-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
braking unit or braking resistor). Use this setting when braking units or resistors are connected to
the drive.
Setting Pr.06-01 to a value > 0 enables the over-voltage stall prevention. This setting refers to
the power supply system and loading. If the setting is too low, then over-voltage stall prevention
is easily activated, which may increase the deceleration time.
Related parameters: Pr.01-13, Pr.01-15, Pr.01-17, Pr.01-19 Deceleration Time 1–4,
Pr.02-13–Pr.02-15 Multiple-function Output (Relay1–3) and Pr.06-02 Selection for Over-voltage
Stall Prevention.
12.1-06-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When you set Pr.06-06 or Pr.06-09 to 2 or 4, an ot1 / ot2 warning displays and the drive stops
running after over-torque detection. The drive keeps running after you manually reset it.
12.1-06-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
The action of electronic thermal relay depends on the setting for Pr.06-13 and Pr.06-27.
1. Pr.06-13 or Pr.06-27 set to 0 (using inverter motor):
When the output current of motor drive is higher than 150% of motor rated current (refer to the
motor cooling curve with independent fan), motor drive starts to count the time. The electronic
thermal relay acts when the accumulated time exceeds Pr.06-14 or 06-28.
2. Pr.06-13 or Pr.06-27 set to 1 (using standard motor):
When the output current of the drive is higher than 150% of the motor rated current (refer to
the motor cooling curve with shaft-fixed fan), the drive starts to count the time. The electronic
thermal relay acts when the accumulated time exceeds Pr.06-14 or 06-28
3. If the Pr.05-01 is not set, the default is 90% of Pr.00-01 rated current of the drive.
The actual electronic thermal relay action time adjusts according to the drive output current
(shown as the motor loading rate %). The action time is short when the current is high, and the
action time is long when the current is low. Refer to following chart: (The motor cooling curve with
shaft-fixed fan and motor cooling curve with independent fan F = 50 Hz are the same one.)
12.1-06-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Stall Prevention Limit Level (Weak Magnetic Area Current Stall Prevention Level)
Default: 50
Settings 0–100% (Refer to Pr.06-03, Pr.06-04)
Sets the over-current stall prevention level when operation frequency is larger than Pr.01-01. This
parameter only works during acceleration.
Example: Pr.06-03 = 150%, Pr.06-04 = 100% and Pr.06-16 = 80%, when the operation frequency
is larger than Pr.01-01, the over-current stall prevention level is as below:
Over-current stall prevention level during acceleration = Pr. 06-03 × Pr. 06-16 = 150 × 80% =
120%.
Over-current stall prevention level during operation = Pr.06-04 × Pr.06-16 = 100 × 80% = 80%
Pr. 06-16 is invalid when the over-current stall prevention activates according to Pr. 06-04 at
constant speed.
Fault Record 1
Fault Record 2
Fault Record 3
Fault Record 4
Fault Record 5
Fault Record 6
Settings
0: No fault record
1: Over-current during acceleration (ocA)
2: Over-current during deceleration (ocd)
3: Over-current during constant speed (ocn)
4: Ground fault (GFF)
5: IGBT short-circuit (occ)
6: Over-current at stop (ocS)
7: Over-voltage during acceleration (ovA)
8: Over-voltage during deceleration (ovd)
9: Over-voltage during constant speed (ovn)
10: Over-voltage at stop (ovS)
11: Low-voltage during acceleration (LvA)
12.1-06-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
71: Watchdog
72: Channel 1 (STO1–SCM1) safety loop error (STL1)
73: External safety gate S1
74: FIRE mode output
76: Safety Torque Off (STO)
77: Channel 2 (STO2–SCM2) safety loop error (STL2)
78: Internal loop error (STL3)
79: U-phase output short-circuit (Uoc)
80: V-phase output short-circuit (Voc)
81: W-phase output short-circuit (Woc)
82: U-phase output phase loss (OPHL)
83: V-phase output phase loss (OPHL)
84: W-phase output phase loss (OPHL)
89: RoPd initial rotor position detection error
90: Inner PLC function is forced to stop
93: CPU error
99: TRAP CPU command error
101: CANopen software disconnect1 (CGdE)
102: CANopen software disconnect2 (CHbE)
103: CANopen synchronous error (CsyE)
104: CANopen hardware disconnect (CbFE)
105: CANopen index setting error (CidE)
106: CANopen slave station number setting error (CAdE)
107: CANopen index setting exceed limit (CFrE)
111: Internal communication overtime error (ictE)
142: Auto-tuning error 1 (no feedback current error) (AUE1)
143: Auto-tuning error 2 (motor phase loss error) (AUE2)
144: Auto-tuning error 3 (no-load current I0 measuring error) (AUE3)
148: Auto-tuning error (leakage inductance Lsigma measuring error) (AUE4)
When the fault occurs and forces stopping, the fault is recorded in this parameter.
During stop with low voltage Lv (LvS warning), there is no error record. During operation with
mid-low voltage Lv (LvA, Lvd, Lvn error), there is a record.
When dEb function is valid and enabled, the drive executes dEb and records fault code 62 to
Pr.06-17–Pr.06-22 simultaneously.
12.1-06-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
requirement. When the fault occurs, the corresponding terminals activate. Convert the binary
value to decimal value before you enter the value for Pr.06-23–Pr.06-26).
12.1-06-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
PTC Level
Default: 50.0
Settings 0.0–100.0%
Sets AVI1/ACI/AVI2 analog input function Pr.03-00–03-02 to 6 [Positive Temperature Coefficient
(P.T.C.) thermistor input value].
Use this to set the PTC level, the corresponding value for 100% is the analog input maximum
value.
DC Voltage at Malfunction
Default: Read only
Settings 0.0–6553.5 V
When a malfunction occurs, check the current DC voltage. If it happens again, it overwrites the
previous record.
12.1-06-15
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-16
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-17
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Status 3-1: Pr. 06-48 ≠ 0, Pr. 07-02 ≠ 0 (No OPHL detected before operation)
Status 3-2: Pr. 06-48≠0, Pr. 07-20≠0 (OPHL detected before operation)
12.1-06-18
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
LvX Auto-Reset
Default: 0
Settings 0: Disable
1: Enable
Time for Input Phase Loss Detection
Default: 0.20
Settings 0.00–600.00 sec.
Sets the time for input phase loss detection; setting 0.20 seconds means to check every 0.20 sec.
12.1-06-19
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Derating Protection
Default: 0
Settings 0: Constant rated current and limit carrier wave by load current and
temperature
1: Constant carrier frequency and limit load current by setting carrier wave
2: Constant rated current (same as setting 0), but close current limit
The maximum output frequency and its corresponded carrier frequency lower limit under each
control mode:
VF, SVC: 599 Hz, 6K
FOC sensorless (IM): 300 Hz, 6K
FOC sensorless (PM): 500 Hz, 10K
Setting 0:
When the operating point is greater than the derating curve, the rated current is constant, and
carrier frequency (Fc) output by the drive decreases automatically according to the ambient
12.1-06-20
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
temperature, overload output current and time. If overloads are not frequent, and the concern is
only about the carrier frequency operating with the rated current for a long time, and changes to
the carrier wave due to short overload are acceptable, set to 0.
Refer to the Section 9-7 “Derating Curve of Ambient Temperature” for the level of carrier
frequency. Take VFD007CP43A in normal duty for example, ambient temperature 50°C, UL
open-type, and independent installation. When the carrier frequency is set to 15 kHz, it
corresponds to 72% of the rated output current. When the output current is higher than the value,
it automatically decreases the carrier wave according to the ambient temperature, output current
and overload time. At this time, the overload capacity of the drive is still 120% of the rated
current.
Setting 1:
When the operating point exceeds derating curve 1, the carrier frequency is fixed to the set
value. Select this mode if the change of carrier wave and motor noise caused by ambient
temperature and frequent overload are not acceptable. Refer to Pr.00-17.
Refer to Section 9-7 “Derating Curve of Ambient Temperature” for the derating level of the rated
current. Take VFD007CP43A in normal duty for example, when the carrier frequency maintains
at 15 kHz, the rated current decreases to 72%. The oL protection executes when the current is
120%*72%=86% for one minute; therefore, it must operate by the curve to keep the carrier
frequency.
Setting 2:
The protection method and action are the same as setting it to 0, but this disables the current
limit when output current is the derating ratio x 160% of output current in normal load, and
derating ratio x 130% of output current in light load. The advantage is that this can provide a
higher starting output current when the carrier frequency setting is higher than the default. The
disadvantage is that the carrier wave derates easily when it overloads.
Use with settings for Pr.00-16 and Pr.00-17.
12.1-06-21
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Figure 1
12.1-06-22
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Set up process:
1. Switch AFM2 to 0–20 mA on the I/O control terminal block. (Refer to Figure 1, PT100 wiring
diagram)
2. Wiring (Refer to Figure 1, PT100 wiring diagram):
Connect external terminal AFM2 to (+)
Connect external terminal ACM to (-)
Connect external terminals AFM2 and AVI1 to “short-circuit”
3. Set Pr.03-00=11 or Pr.03-23=23 or Pr.03-33=45% (9 mA).
4. Refer to the RTD temperature and resistance comparison table
Temperature=135°C, resistance=151.71 ; input current: 9 mA, voltage: about 1.37 VDC
Temperature=150°C, resistance=157.33 ; input current: 9 mA, voltage: about 1.42 VDC
5. When the RTD temperature is > 135°C, the drive decelerates to the specified operation
frequency automatically. Then, Pr.06-56=1.37 and Pr.06-58=10 Hz. When Pr.06-58=0, it
disables the specified operation frequency.
6. When the RTD temperature is > 150°C, the drive outputs a fault, decelerates to STOP, and
displays the warning ‘oH3’. Then, Pr.06-57=1.42 and Pr.06-29=1 (warn and ramp to stop).
12.1-06-23
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-24
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Fire Mode
Default: 0.00
Settings 0: Disable
1: Operates in counter clockwise direction
2: Operates in clockwise direction
This parameter works with multi-input function terminal 58 or 59 and multi-output function
terminal 53 and 54.
0: Fire mode is disabled.
1: When there is a fire, the motor operates in counter clockwise direction (U, V, W).
2: When there is a fire, the motor operates in clockwise direction (U, W, V).
12.1-06-25
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-26
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Below diagram shows the sequence of fire mode operation. The operation mode will accord to the
Pr.06-86 bit0 setting (bit0: 0=Open Loop; 1=Close Loop (PID control)).
Pr.06-86 bit0=1: When setting the Pr.06-80=1 or 2, and the multi-functional input terminals MIx=58 is
ON, the drive enables the fire mode operation. The drive runs PID control with Pr.06-87 as PID set
point, and the keypad KPC-CC01 displays a “Fire” warning. The drive outputs a RUN command for
the fire mode when the multi-function output terminal MOx is set to 53. If you set Pr.06-82=1 to
enable the Bypass function and the condition is established, the MOx=54 Bypass fire mode indicates
action and switches the motor power to the mains power, then the drive stops.
If an error occurs to the PID feedback signal, the drive switches to the open-loop control and runs
according to the setting frequency for Pr.06-81.
12.1-06-27
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
(2) When operating in fire mode, if there is an error on auto-reset and the number of times to
auto-reset remains zero or the fire alarm rings according to the time setting for Pr.06-83, then the
bypass function is enabled. MFO bypass indication is ON. If the auto-reset is successful before
the bypass function is enabled, the bypass delay counter returns to zero to wait for next trigger.
Table 1: Error detection under Normal mode, Fire mode and Bypass function in Fire mode.
(V means detectable)
Normal Enable bypass
Code Error name Fire Mode
mode function
1 Over-current during acceleration (ocA) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
2 Over-current during deceleration (ocd) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
3 Over-current during constant speed (ocn) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
4 Ground Fault (GFF) V V(able to auto-reset) V
5 IGBT short circuit (occ) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
6 Over-current during stop (ocS) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
7 Over-voltage during acceleration (ovA) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
8 Over-voltage during deceleration (ovd) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
9 Over-voltage during constant speed (ovn) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
10 Over-voltage during stop (ovS) V(RS) V(able to auto-reset) V
11 Low-voltage during acceleration (LvA) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
12 Low-voltage during deceleration (Lvd) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
13 Low-voltage during constant speed (Lvn) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
14 Low-voltage during Stop (LvS) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
15 Input phase loss (OrP) V V(able to auto-reset) V
16 Over-heat 1 (oH1) V V(able to auto-reset) V
17 Over-heat 2 (oH2) V V(able to auto-reset) V
18 Thermistor 1 open (tH1o) V V(able to auto-reset) V
19 Thermistor 2 open (tH2o) V V(able to auto-reset) V
21 Over-load (oL) (150% 1Min, Inverter) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
22 Motor 1 over load (EoL1) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
23 Motor 2 over load (EoL2) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
24 Over heat 3 (oH3) V V(able to auto-reset) V
26 Over torque 1 (ot1) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
27 Over torque 2 (ot2) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
28 Low current (uC) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
30 EEPROM write error (cF1) V Not-detectable Not-detectable
31 EEPROM read error (cF2) V V Not-detectable
U phase current sensor detection error
33 V V Not-detectable
(cd1)
V phase current sensor detection error
34 V V Not-detectable
(cd2)
W phase current sensor detection error
35 V V Not-detectable
(cd3)
36 Clamp current detection error (Hd0) V V Not-detectable
12.1-06-28
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-29
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Wiring Diagram:
1. When AC power is ON, RB1 and RC1 are ON, and RA1 and RC1 are OFF.
2. When operating in fire mode and bypass indication function is disabled, RB1 and RC1 are ON, and
the motor is driven by the drive.
3. When operating in fire mode and bypass indication function is enabled, RA1 and RC1 are ON, and
the motor runs under mains electricity.
12.1-06-30
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When in fire mode, the running direction of the drive is based on Pr.06-08=1 (FWD) or
Pr.06-80=2 (REV). Other running direction commands are invalid and Pr.00-23 Motor Operating
Direction is not available when in fire mode.
When in fire mode, all keypad command are ignored, including RUN, STOP, JOG and direction
commands.
When in fire mode, all RS-485 communication commands are ignored, including RUN, STOP,
JOG and direction commands.
When in fire mode, B.B. and EF are not activated, including external terminal B.B,
communication B.B, external terminal EF, communication EF and external terminal EF1). Any
activated B.B. is automatically invalid, including external terminal B.B. and communication B.B.,
and the drive executes speed tracking.
When in fire mode, activated EF and EF1 are automatically invalid, including external terminals
EF & EF1 and communication EF).
When in fire mode, the JOG command is not available (JOG command source: keypad, external
terminals and communications). Any operating JOG command is automatically invalid.
When in fire mode, the Acceleration / Deceleration Speed Inhibit function is not available. Any
activated acceleration / deceleration speed inhibition is automatically invalid.
When in fire mode, If you set Pr.06-86 to bit0=0 (open-loop control), the drive does not execute
parameter group 08 PID function. Any operating PID function is automatically invalid.
When in fire mode, the Hand-Off-Auto function is not available, including multi-function output
terminals.
When in fire mode, the drive does not execute the circulative control function, and all circulating
control function parameters are cleared. The circulative control function is automatically invalid
when in fire mode.
When in fire mode, the drive does not execute the sleep function.
When in fire mode, the drive does not execute the DC brake function. Any operating DC brake is
automatically invalid when in fire mode.
When in fire mode, the drive does not execute over-current stall prevention function. Any
operating over-current stall prevention is automatically invalid when in fire mode.
When in fire mode, over-torque detection function is not available.
When in fire mode, OL1/OL2 detection function is not available.
When in fire mode, abnormal communication (CE10, CE1, CE2, CE3 and CE4) detection is not
available.
The cd1, cd2, cd3 and Hd0, Hd1, Hd2, Hd3 are boot check and cannot be cleared. The above
errors cannot be cleared when in fire mode. The drive does not operate when in fire mode.
Lv protection is not activated when in fire mode, so the drive keeps running or runs until the
power is lost. If the Lv error occurs before the fire mode warning, clear the Lv error to operate the
drive.
If bypass fire mode indication (MOx=54) is activated, reboot the drive and deactivate the fire
mode to turn off this terminal output.
When in fire mode, the output stop function is not available.
12.1-06-31
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-06-32
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
07 Special Parameters
This parameter can be set during operation.
Software Brake Level
Default:
380.0/740.0/895.0/1057.0
Settings 230V series: 350.0–450.0 VDC
460V series: 700.0–900.0 VDC
575V series: 850.0–1116.0 VDC
690V series: 939.0–1318.0 VDC
Sets the brake transistor level for the DC bus voltage. Choose a suitable brake resistor to
achieve the best deceleration. Refer to Section 7 Optional Accessories for information about
brake resistors.
This parameter is only valid for the models below 22 kW of 230V series and 30 kW of 460V
series.
12.1-07-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
The motor may continue rotating after the drive stops output due to external forces or the inertia
of the motor itself. This parameter outputs DC current, generating torque to force the drive stop
after the drive stops output to make sure that the motor stops.
This parameter determines the duration of the DC brake current output to the motor when
braking. To enable DC brake at STOP, set Pr.00-22 (Stop Method) to 0 (ramp to stop). The DC
brake is invalid when Pr.07-03 is set to 0.0.
Related parameters: Pr.00-22 Stop Method, Pr.07-04 DC Brake Frequency at STOP.
Use the DC brake before running the motor when the load is movable at stop, such as with fans
and pumps. The motor is in free operating status and in unknown rotation direction before the
drive start up. Execute the DC brake before you start the motor.
Use DC brake at STOP when you need to brake the motor quickly or to control the positioning,
such as with cranes or cutting machines.
12.1-07-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Setting 1: Frequency tracking begins before momentary power loss and accelerates to the
master Frequency command after the drive output frequency and motor rotator speed are
synchronous. Use this setting when there is a lot of inertia with little resistance on the motor load.
For example, in equipment with a large inertia flywheel, there is NO need to wait until the
flywheel stops completely after a restart to execute the operation command; therefore, it saves
time.
Setting 2: Frequency tracking starts from the minimum output frequency and accelerates to the
master Frequency command after the drive output frequency and motor rotator speed are
synchronous. Use this setting when there is little inertia and large resistance.
This function is only valid when the RUN command is enabled.
12.1-07-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-07-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
The maximum current for speed tracking affects the synchronous time. The larger the parameter
setting is, the faster the synchronization occurs. However, if the parameter setting is too large,
the overload protection function may be activated.
12.1-07-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
to zero speed. If the power recovers at this time, the drive restarts the motor after the dEb return
time.
Lv return level: Default value depends on the drive power model
Frame A, B, C, D = Pr.06-00 + 60V/30V (230V models)
Frame E and above = Pr.06-00 + 80V/40V (230V models)
Lv level: Default = Pr.06-00
During dEb operation, other protection such as ryF, ov, oc, occ and EF may interrupt it, and
these error codes are recorded.
The STOP (RESET) command does not work during the dEb auto-deceleration, and the drive
continues decelerating to stop. To make the drive coast to stop immediately, use another
function (EF) instead.
The B.B. function does not work when executing dEb. The B.B. function is enabled after the dEb
function finishes.
Even though the Lv warning does not display during dEb operation, if the DC bus voltage is
lower than the Lv level, MOx = 10 (Low voltage warning) still operates.
The following explains the dEb action:
When the DC voltage drops below the dEb setting level, the dEb function start to work (soft start
relay remains closed) and the drive executes auto-deceleration.
Situation 1: Momentary power-loss, or power current too low and unstable, or power supply
sliding down because of sudden heavy load.
Pr.07-13=1, “dEb active, DC bus voltage returns, output frequency does not return” and
power recovers. When the power recovers and DC bus voltage exceeds the dEb return level,
the drive linearly decelerates to 0 Hz and stops. The keypad displays the ”dEb” warning until
you manually reset it, so that you can see the reason for the stop.
12.1-07-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Situation 2: Momentary power loss or power current too low and unstable, or power supply
sliding down because of sudden heavy load.
Pr.07-13=2 “dEb active, DC bus voltage returns, output frequency returns” and power
recovers. During the dEb deceleration time (includes 0 Hz run), if the power recovers higher
than dEb return level, the drive maintains the frequency for the set time of Pr.07-14 (default = 3
sec.) and then accelerates again. The dEb warning on the keypad clears automatically.
12.1-07-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Situation 4:
Pr.07-13=2 “dEb active, DC bus voltage returns, the output frequency returns” and power
does not recover. The drive decelerates to 0 Hz. The DC bus voltage continues to decrease until
the voltage is lower than the Lv level and the drive disconnects the soft-start relay. The keypad
displays “dEb” warning until the drive completely runs out of power.
Situation 5:
Pr.07-13=2 “dEb low voltage control, when the speed is lower than 1/4 rated motor speed,
DC bus voltage rises to 350 VDC / 700 VDC, the drive ramps to stop . The drive decelerates to 0
Hz. The DC bus voltage continues to decrease until the voltage is lower than the Lv level, and
then the drive disconnects the soft-start relay. The soft start relay closes again after the power
recovers and the DC bus voltage is higher than the Lv return level. When the DC bus voltage is
higher than the dEb return level, the drive maintains the frequency for the set time of Pr.07-14
(default = 3 sec.) and starts to do accelerate linearly, and the dEb warning on the keypad
cleared automatically.
12.1-07-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-07-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-07-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Energy-saving Gain
Default: 100
Settings 10–1000%
When Pr.07-21 is set to 1, use this parameter to adjust the energy-saving gain. The default is
100%. If the result is not satisfactory, adjust it by decreasing the setting value. If the motor
oscillates, then increase the setting value.
In certain applications such as high-speed spindles, the temperature rise in the motor is a major
concern. When the motor is not in working state, reduce the motor current to a lower level.
Reduce this parameter setting to meet this requirement.
12.1-07-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When the setting is too long, the control is stable but the control response is delayed. When the
setting is too short, the response is quick but the control may be unstable. Adjust the setting
according to the stability of the control and response times.
12.1-07-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Motor 1 (A)), the drive compensates the frequency with this parameter.
This parameter is set to 1.00 automatically when Pr.00-11 (Speed Control Method) is changed
from V/F mode to vector mode. Apply the slip compensation after load and acceleration.
Increase the compensation value from small to large gradually; add the output frequency with
motor rated slip x Pr.07-27 (Slip Compensation Gain) when the motor is at the rated load. If the
actual speed ratio is slower than expected, increase the parameter setting value; otherwise,
decrease the setting value.
12.1-07-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-07-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Master Frequency Command (AUTO) Source / Source Selection of the PID Target
Default: 0
Settings 0: Digital keypad
1: RS-485 serial communication
2: External analog input (Refer to Pr.03-00)
3: External UP/DOWN terminal
6: CANopen communication card
8: Communication card (does not include CANopen card)
12.1-08-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Adjustment: Turn off the Ti and Td, or remain Ti and Td in constant value, then adjust the
proportional gain (P).
Increase: Faster status feedback, but excessive adjustment will increase the overshoot.
Decrease: Smaller overshoot, but excessive adjustment will slow down the transient
response.
Integral time(I):
The controller output is proportional to the integral of the controller input. To eliminate the
steady-state error, add an “integral part” to the controller. The integral time controls the
relation between integral part and the error. The integral part increases over time even if
12.1-08-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
the error is small. It gradually increases the controller output to eliminate the error until it is
zero. This stabilizes the system without a steady-state error by using proportional gain
control and integral time control.
Adjustment: The integral time (I) accumulates from the time difference, if the vibration
cycle is longer than the setting for integral time, the integration enhances.
Increase the integral time (I) to reduce the vibration.
Increase: Reduce the overshoot, excessive adjustment causes worse transient response.
Decrease: Faster transient response, but the transient time will be longer, and takes more
time to achieve the steady state. Excessive adjustment causes larger overshoot.
Adjustment: When the vibration cycle is shorter and continuous, it means that the
differential time setting is too large, and causes excessive output. Decrease
the setting of D gain to reduce the vibration. If the D gain is set to 0, adjust the
PID control again.
12.1-08-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-08-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
system state. Using a suitable differential time can reduce overshoot and shorten adjustment
time; however, the differential operation increases noise interference. Note that a too large
differential causes more noise interference. In addition, the differential shows the change and
the output is 0 when there is no change. Note that you cannot use the differential control
independently. You must use it with the other two controllers for the PD controller or PID
controller.
Sets the D controller gain to determine the error change response. Using a suitable differential
time reduces the P and I controllers overshoot to decrease the oscillation for a stable system. A
differential time that is too long may cause system oscillation.
The differential controller acts on the change in the error and cannot reduce the interference. Do
not use this function when there is significant interference.
12.1-08-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
PID control output frequency is filtered with a primary low pass function. This function can filter a
mix frequency. A long primary low pass time means the filter degree is high and a short primary
low pass time means the filter degree is low.
Inappropriate delay time setting may cause system error.
PI Control:
Controlled only by the P action, so the deviation cannot be entirely eliminated. In general, to
eliminate residual deviations, use the P + I control. When you use the PI control, it eliminates the
deviation caused by the targeted value changes and the constant external interferences.
However, if the I action is too powerful, it delays the response when there is rapid variation. You
can use the P action by itself to control the loading system with the integral components.
PD Control:
When deviation occurs, the system immediately generates an operation load that is greater than
the load generated only by the D action to restrain the deviation increment. If the deviation is
small, the effectiveness of the P action decreases as well. The control objects include
applications with integral component loads, which are controlled by the P action only.
Sometimes, if the integral component is functioning, the whole system may vibrate. In this case,
use the PD control to reduce the P action’s vibration and stabilize the system. In other words,
this control is useful with no brake function’s loading over the processes.
PID Control:
Use the I action to eliminate the deviation and the D action to reduce vibration; then combine
this with the P action for the PID control. Use the PID method for a control process with no
deviations, high accuracies and a stable system.
Serial connection
Parallel connection
12.1-08-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Sleep Reference
Default: 0.00
Settings 0.00–599.00 Hz or 0–200.00%
Determines the sleep frequency, and if the sleep time and the wake-up frequency are enabled or
disabled. When Pr.08-10 = 0: disabled; when 08-10 ≠ 0: enable.
Wake-up Frequency
Default: 0.00
Settings 0.00–599.00 Hz or 0–200.00%
When Pr.08-18 = 0, the unit for Pr.08-10 and that for Pr.08-11 switch to frequency. The settings
become 0.00–599.00 Hz.
When Pr.08-18=1, the unit for Pr.08-10 and that for Pr.08-11 switch to percentage. The settings
then switch to 0–200.00%.
The percentage is based on the current command value, not the maximum value. For example, if
the maximum value is 100 kg, and the current value is 30 kg, then if Pr.08-11=40%, the value is
12 kg.
Pr. 08-10 uses the same logic for calculation.
Sleep Time
Default: 0.0
Settings 0.0–6000.0 sec.
When the frequency command is smaller than the sleep frequency and less than the sleep time,
the frequency command is equal to the sleep frequency. However, the frequency command
remains at 0.00 Hz until the frequency command becomes equal to or larger than the wake-up
frequency.
12.1-08-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
PID Compensation
Default: 0.0
Settings -100.0–100.0%
The PID compensation value = maximum PID target value × Pr.08-17. For example, if the
maximum operation frequency Pr.01-00=60.00 Hz, Pr.08-17=10.0%, the PID compensation
value increases the output frequency 6.00 Hz. 60.00 Hz × 100.00% × 10.0% = 6.00 Hz
12.1-08-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-08-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-08-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-08-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-08-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
09 Communication Parameters
The parameter can be set during the operation.
8 1
Modbus RS- 485
When us ing communication devi ces, Pin 1~2,7,8: Reserv ed
connects AC dr ive with P C by us ing Pin 3, 6: GND
Delta IFD6530 or IFD6500. Pin 4: SG-
RS-485 Pin 5: SG+
12.1-09-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
7: 8, N, 2 (ASCII)
8: 8, E, 1 (ASCII)
9: 8, O, 1 (ASCII)
10: 8, E, 2 (ASCII)
11: 8, O, 2 (ASCII)
12: 8, N, 1 (RTU)
13: 8, N, 2 (RTU)
14: 8, E, 1 (RTU)
15: 8, O, 1 (RTU)
16: 8, E, 2 (RTU)
17: 8, O, 2 (RTU)
Control by PC (Computer Link)
When using the RS-485 serial communication interface, you must specify each drive’s
communication address in Pr.09-00. The computer then implements control using the drives’
individual addresses.
Modbus ASCII (American Standard Code for Information Interchange): Each byte of data is the
combination of two ASCII characters. For example, one byte of data: 64 Hex, shown as ‘64’ in
ASCII, consists of ‘6’ (36Hex) and ‘4’ (34Hex).
1. Code Description
The communication protocol is in hexadecimal, ASCII: ”0”…“9”, “A”…“F”, every hexadecimal
value represents an ASCII code. The following table shows some examples:
Character ‘0’ ‘1’ ‘2’ ‘3’ ‘4’ ‘5’ ‘6’ ‘7’
ASCII code 30H 31H 32H 33H 34H 35H 36H 37H
2. Data Format
10-bit character frame (For ASCII):
(7, N, 2)
7-data bits
10-bits character frame
(7, E, 1)
7-data bits
10-bits character frame
12.1-09-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
(7, O, 1)
7-data bits
10-bits character frame
(8, E, 1)
(8, O, 1)
3. Communication Protocol
Communication Data Frame:
ASCII mode
STX Start character = ‘:’ (3AH)
Address Hi Communication address:
Address Lo one 8-bit address consists of 2 ASCII codes
Function Hi Command code:
Function Lo one 8-bit command consists of 2 ASCII codes
DATA (n-1) Contents of data:
……. n x 8-bit data consist of 2n ASCII codes
DATA 0 n ≤ 16, maximum of 32 ASCII codes
LRC Check High LRC checksum:
LRC Check Low one 8-bit checksum consists of 2 ASCII codes
END High End characters:
END Low END1= CR (0DH), END0= LF(0AH)
12.1-09-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
RTU mode
START Defined by a silent interval of more than 10 ms
Address Communication address: 8-bit address
Function Command code: 8-bit command
DATA (n-1)
Contents of data:
…….
n × 8-bit data, n ≤ 16
DATA 0
CRC Check Low CRC checksum:
CRC Check High one 16-bit checksum consists of 2 8-bit characters
END Defined by a silent interval of more than 10 ms
Example: Reading two continuous data from register address 2102H, AMD address is 01H.
ASCII mode:
Command Message: Response Message
STX ‘:’ STX ‘:’
‘0’ ‘0’
Address Address
‘1’ ‘1’
‘0’ ‘0’
Function Function
‘3’ ‘3’
‘2’ Number of register ‘0’
‘1’ (count by byte) ‘4’
Starting register
‘0’ ‘1’
‘2’ Content of starting ‘7’
‘0’ register 2102H ‘7’
Number of register ‘0’ ‘0’
(count by word) ‘0’ ‘0’
‘2’ Content of register ‘0’
‘D’ 2103H ‘0’
LRC Check
‘7’ ‘0’
CR ‘7’
END LRC Check
LF ‘1’
END CR
12.1-09-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
RTU mode:
Command Message: Response Message
Address 01H Address 01H
Function 03H Function 03H
21H Number of register
Starting data register 04H
02H (count by byte)
Number of register 00H Content of register 17H
(count by word) 02H address 2102H 70H
CRC Check Low 6FH Content of register 00H
CRC Check High F7H address 2103H 00H
CRC Check Low FEH
CRC Check High 5CH
ASCII mode:
Command Message: Response Message
STX ‘:’ STX ‘:’
‘0’ ‘0’
Address Address
‘1’ ‘1’
‘0’ ‘0’
Function Function
‘6’ ‘6’
‘0’ ‘0’
‘1’ ‘1’
Target register Target register
‘0’ ‘0’
‘0’ ‘0’
‘1’ ‘1’
‘7’ ‘7’
Register content Register content
‘7’ ‘7’
‘0’ ‘0’
‘7’ ‘7’
LRC Check LRC Check
‘1’ ‘1’
CR CR
END END
LF LF
RTU mode:
Command Message: Response Message
Address 01H Address 01H
Function 06H Function 06H
01H 01H
Target register Target register
00H 00H
17H 17H
Register content Register content
70H 70H
CRC Check Low 86H CRC Check Low 86H
CRC Check High 22H CRC Check High 22H
10H: write multiple registers (write multiple data to registers). The system can write up to 20 sets
of data simultaneously.
12.1-09-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
ASCII Mode
Command Message: Response Message
STX ‘:’ STX ‘:’
ADR 1 ‘0’ ADR 1 ‘0’
ADR 0 ‘1’ ADR 0 ‘1’
CMD 1 ‘1’ CMD 1 ‘1’
CMD 0 ‘0’ CMD 0 ‘0’
‘0’ ‘0’
‘4’ ‘4’
Target register Target register
‘0’ ‘0’
‘0’ ‘0’
‘0’ ‘0’
Number of register ‘0’ Number of register ‘0’
(count by word) ‘0’ (count by word) ‘0’
‘2’ ‘2’
Number of register ‘0’ ‘E’
LRC Check
(count by byte) ‘4’ ‘9’
‘1’ CR
END
‘3’ LF
The first data content
‘8’
‘8’
‘0’
The second data ‘F’
content ‘A’
‘0’
‘9’
LRC Check
‘B’
CR
END
LF
RTU mode:
Command Message: Response Message:
ADR 01H ADR 01H
CMD 10H CMD 1 10H
04H 04H
Target register Target register
00H 00H
Number of register 00H Number of register 00H
(Count by word) 02H (Count by word) 02H
Quantity of data (byte) 04 CRC Check Low 40H
13H CRC Check High F8H
The first data content
88H
The second data 0FH
content A0H
CRC Check Low ‘9’
CRC Check High ‘A’
Check sum
ASCII mode:
LRC (Longitudinal Redundancy Check) is calculated by summing up the values of the bytes from
ADR1 to last data character then calculating the hexadecimal representation of the
2’s-complement negation of the sum.
For example,
01H+03H+21H+02H+00H+02H=29H, the 2’s-complement negation of 29H is D7H.
12.1-09-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
RTU mode:
CRC (Cyclical Redundancy Check) is calculated by the following steps:
Step 1: Load a 16-bit register (called CRC register) with FFFFh.
Step 2: Exclusive OR the first 8-bit byte of the command message with the low order byte of the
16-bit CRC register, putting the result in the CRC register.
Step 3: Examine the LSB of CRC register.
Step 4: If the LSB of CRC register is 0, shift the CRC register one bit to the right, fill MSB with
zero, then repeat step 3. If the LSB of CRC register is 1, shift the CRC register one bit to
the right, fill MSB with zero, Exclusive OR the CRC register with the polynomial value
A001H, then repeat step 3.
Step 5: Repeat step 3 and 4 until you perform eight shifts. This processes a complete 8-bit byte.
Step 6: Repeat step 2 through 5 for the next 8-bit byte of the command message. Continue doing
this until all bytes are processed. The final contents of the CRC register are the CRC
value. When transmitting the CRC value in the message, the upper and lower bytes of the
CRC value must be swapped, that is, the lower order byte is transmitted first.
The following is an example of CRC generation using C language. The function takes two
arguments:
Unsigned char* data a pointer to the message buffer
Unsigned char length the quantity of bytes in the message buffer
The function returns the CRC value as a type of unsigned integer.
Unsigned int crc_chk(unsigned char* data, unsigned char length)
{
int j;
unsigned int reg_crc=0xffff;
while(length--){
reg_crc ^= *data++;
for(j=0;j<8;j++){
if(reg_crc & 0x01){ /* LSB(b0)=1 */
reg_crc=(reg_crc>>1) ^ 0xa001;
}else{
reg_crc=reg_crc >>1;
}
}
}
12.1-09-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
4. Address list
12.1-09-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Modbus
R/W Function
address
AC motor drive operation status
bit1–0 00B: Drive stops
01B: Drive decelerating
10B: Drive standby
11B: Drive operating
bit2 1:JOG Command
Operation Direction
bit4–3 00B: FWD run
01B: From REV run to FWD run
10B: From FWD run to REV run
2101H R
11B: REV run
bit8 1: Master frequency controlled by communication interface
12.1-09-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Modbus
RW Function
address
2206H R Display actual motor speed kW of U, V, W (XXXX.X kW)
Display motor speed in rpm estimated by the drive or encoder feedback
2207H R
(XXXXX rpm)
Display positive/negative output torque in %, estimated by the drive (XXX.X
2208H R
%)
2209H R Reserved
220AH R PID feedback value after enabling PID function (XXX.XX %)
Display signal of AVI1 analog input terminal, 0–10 V corresponds to
220BH R
0.00–100.00% (1.) (see NOTE 2 in Pr.00-04)
Display signal of ACI analog input terminal, 4–20 mA / 0–10 V corresponds
220CH R
to 0.00–100.00% (2.) (see NOTE 2 in Pr.00-04)
Display signal of AVI2 analog input terminal, -10 V–10 V corresponds to
220DH R
-100.00–100% (3.) (see NOTE 2 in Pr.00-04)
220EH R IGBT temperature of drive power module (XXX.X°C)
220FH R The temperature of capacitance (XXX.X°C)
The status of digital input (ON/OFF), refer to Pr.02-12
2210H R
(see NOTE 3 in Pr.00-04)
The status of digital output (ON/OFF), refer to Pr.02-18
2211H R
(see NOTE 4 in Pr.00-04)
2212H R The multi-step speed that is executing (S)
The corresponding CPU pin status of digital input (d.)
2213H R
(see NOTE 3 in Pr.00-04)
The corresponding CPU pin status of digital output (O.)
2214H R
(see NOTE 4 in Pr.00-04)
2215H R Reserved
2216H R Reserved
2217H R Reserved
2218H R Reserved
2219H R Display times of counter overload (XXX.XX %)
221AH R GFF (XXX.XX %)
221BH R DC bus voltage ripples (XXX.X V)
221CH R PLC register D1043 data (C)
221DH R Reserved
221EH R User page displays the value in physical measure
221FH R Output Value of Pr.00-05 (XXX.XX Hz)
Number of motor turns when drive operates (saves when drive stops, and
2220H R
resets to zero when operating)
Operating position of the motor (saves when drive stops, and resets to zero
2221H R
when operating)
2222H R Fan speed of the drive (XXX %)
2223H R Control mode of the drive 0: speed mode
2224H R Carrier frequency of the drive (XXXX kHz)
2225H R Reserved
Drive
00b: No direction
status
01b: Forward
bit1–0
10b: Reverse
01b: Drive ready
2226H R bit3–2
10b: Error
0b: Motor drive did not output
bit4
1b: Motor drive did output
0b: No alarm
bit5
1b: Alarm
2228H R Reserve
12.1-09-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Modbus
RW Function
address
2229H R kWh display (XXXX.X)
222AH R Reserve
222BH R Reserve
222CH R Reserve
222DH R Reserve
222EH R PID reference (XXX.XX %)
222FH R PID offset (XXX.XX %)
2230H R PID output frequency (XXX.XX Hz)
2231H R Hardware ID
Remote IO (26xx)
Modbus
RW Function
address
2601H R Each bit corresponds to different terminal input contact
2602H R Each bit corresponds to different terminal input contact
2603H
| R Reserved
2640H
2641H RW Each bit corresponds to different terminal output contact
2642H
| R Reserved
2660H
2661H R AVI1 proportional value
2662H R ACI proportional value
2663H R AVI2 proportional value
2664H
| R Reserved
266AH
266BH R Expansion card AI10, 0.0–100.0% (EMC-A22A)
266CH R Expansion card AI11, 0.0–100.0% (EMC-A22A)
266DH
| R Reserved
26A0H
26A1H RW AFM1 output proportional value
26A2H RW AFM2 output proportional value
26A3H
| R Reserved
26AAH
26ABH RW Expansion card AO10, 0.0–100.0% (EMC-A22A)
26ACH RW Expansion card AO11, 0.0–100.0% (EMC-A22A)
5. Exception response:
When the drive is using the communication connection, if an error occurs, the drive responds to
the error code and sets the highest bit (bit7) of code to 1 (function code AND 80H), then responds
to the control system to signal that an error occurred.
If the keypad displays “CE-XX” as a warning message, “XX” is the error code at that time. Refer
to the table of error codes for communication error for reference.
12.1-09-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Example:
ASCII mode: RTU mode:
STX ‘:’ Address 01H
‘0’ Function 86H
Address
‘1’ Exception code 02H
‘8’ CRC Check Low C3H
Function
‘6’ CRC Check High A1H
‘0’
Exception code
‘2’
‘7’
LRC Check
‘7’
CR
END
LF
Block Transfer 1
Block Transfer 2
Block Transfer 3
Block Transfer 4
Block Transfer 5
Block Transfer 6
Block Transfer 7
12.1-09-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Block Transfer 8
Block Transfer 9
Block Transfer 10
Block Transfer 11
Block Transfer 12
Block Transfer 13
Block Transfer 14
Block Transfer 15
Block Transfer 16
Default: 0000
Settings 0–FFFFh
There is a group of block transfer parameters available in the AC motor drive (Pr.09-11 to
Pr.09-26). Using communication code 03H, you can store the parameters (Pr.09-11–Pr.09-26)
that you want to read.
For example: according to the Address List (as shown in the table below), Pr.01-42 is shown as
012A. Set Pr.09-11 to 012Ah (the minimum voltage of Pr.01-42 M2 is 2.0 V), and use Pr.09-11
(communication address 090B) to read the communication parameter, the read value is 2.0.
AC motor drive GG is the parameter group, nn is the parameter number; for
GGnnH
parameters example, the address of Pr.04-10 is 040AH.
12.1-09-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
PLC Address
Default: 2
Settings 1–254
CANopen Slave Address
Default: 0
Settings 0: Disable
0–127
CANopen Speed
Default 0
Settings 0: 1 Mbps
1: 500 Kbps
2: 250 Kbps
3: 125 Kbps
4: 100 Kbps (Delta only)
5: 50 Kbps
CANopen Warning Record
Default: Ready only
Settings bit0: CANopen Guarding Time-out
bit1: CANopen Heartbeat Time-out
bit2: CANopen SYNC Time-out
bit3: CANopen SDO Time-out
bit4: CANopen SDO Buffer Overflow
bit5: CANopen hardware disconnection warning (Can Bus Off)
bit6: Error protocol of CANOPEN
bit8: The setting values of CANopen indexes are fail
bit9: The setting value of CANopen address is fail
bit10: The checksum value of CANopen indexes is fail
12.1-09-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-09-15
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-09-16
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
4: 125 Kbps
5: 250 Kbps
6: 500 Kbps
7: 800 Kbps
8: 1 Mbps
Other Communication Card Speed Setting (for DeviceNet)
Default: 0
Settings 0: Standard DeviceNet
In this mode, the baud rate can only be 125 Kbps, 250 Kbps, and 500 Kbps
in standard DeviceNet speed.
1: Nonstandard DeviceNet
In this mode, the baud rate of DeviceNet can be the same as that for
CANopen (0–8).
Use with Pr.09-71.
Setting 0: The baud rate can only be set to 125 Kbps, 250 Kbps and 500 Kbps.
Setting 1: The DeviceNet communication rate can be the same as that for CANopen (setting
0–8).
12.1-09-17
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-09-18
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-10-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
estimator measure the rotor right position and speed when running at the switch point
frequency.
If the switch point is too high, the active area of I/F is too wide, which generates more current
and cannot save energy. If the current value for Pr.10-31 is too high, the high switch point
makes the drive continue to output with the setting value for Pr.10-31).
Injection Frequency
Default: 500
Settings 0–1200 Hz
This parameter is a high frequency injection command in PM SVC control mode and usually you
do not need to adjust it. If a motor’s rated frequency (for example, 400 Hz) is too close to the
frequency setting for this parameter (that is, the default is 500 Hz), it affects the accuracy of the
12.1-10-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
angle detection. Refer to the setting for Pr.01-01 before you adjust this parameter.
If the setting value for Pr.00-17 is lower than Pr.10-51*10, then increase the frequency of the
carrier wave.
Pr.10-51 is valid only when Pr.10-53 = 2.
Injection Magnitude
Default:
15.0/ 30.0/ 30.0/ 30.0
Settings 0.0–200.0 V
230V Series: 0.0–100.0 V
460V Series: 0.0–200.0 V
575V Series: 0.0–200.0 V
690V Series: 0.0–200.0 V
The parameter is the magnitude command for the high frequency injection signal in PM SVC
control mode.
Increasing the parameter can increase the accuracy of the angle estimation, but the
electromagnetic noise might be louder if the setting value is too high.
The system uses this parameter after the motor auto-tunes parameters. This parameter
influences the angle estimation accuracy.
When the ratio of the salient pole (Lq/Ld) is lower, increase Pr.10-52 to make the angle
detection more accurate.
Pr.10-52 is valid only when Pr.10-53 = 2.
PM Initial Rotor Position Detection Method
Default: 0
Settings 0: Disable
1: Internal 1/4 rated current attracting the rotor to zero degrees
2: High frequency injection
3: Pulse injection
Set to 2 for IPM; set to 3 for SPM. If these settings cause problems, then set the parameter to
“1”.
12.1-10-3
12 Description of Parameter SettingCP2000
11 Advanced Parameters
12.1-11-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12 Pump Parameters
This parameter can be set during operation.
Circulation Control
Default: 0
Settings 0: No operation
1: Fixed Time Circulation (by time)
2: Fixed Quantity Circulation
3: Fixed Quantity Control
4: Fixed Time Circulation + Fixed Quantity Circulation
5: Fixed Time Circulation + Fixed Quantity Control
In this mode, the CP2000 can control up to eight motors at a time. The total number of motors is
determined by Pr.12-01. In accordance with the Fixed Time Circulation (Pr.12-02), you can adjust
the switching time between Start and Stop for each motor. When an operating motor reaches the
time setting for Pr.12-02, the CP2000 stops that motor. After the delay time setting for Pr.12-03,
next motor starts operating. See diagram below.
12.1-12-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Wiring: Fixed Time Circulation (by time) can control up to eight motors. Diagram 12-2 shows an
example of controlling four motors at the same time.
LN
VFD-CP2000
UVW
R6AA
MO3
MO6
MO5
MO4
MO2
MO1
RC3
RC2
RC1
RA2
RA3
RA1
RB1
M1
Contactor
M2
Contactor
M3
Contactor
M4
Contactor
12.1-12-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Pr.12-01 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08
Pr.02-13 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55
Pr.02-14 56 56 56 56 56 56 56
Pr.02-15 57 57 57 57 57 57
Pr.02-36 58 58 58 58 58
Pr.02-37 59 59 59 59
Pr.02-38 60 60 60
Pr.02-39 61 61
Pr.02-40 62
Table 1: Setting of Multi-function Output Terminal for Circulating Motors
Delay Time due to the Acceleration (or the Increment ) at Motor Switching (seconds)
Default: 1.0
Settings 0.0–3600.0 seconds
Sets the delay time when switching motors. When the currently running motors reach the time
setting for Pr.12-02, the CP2000 uses the delay time setting for Pr.12-03 and then switches to run
the next motors.
Delay Time due to the Deceleration (or the Decrement) at Motor Switching (seconds)
Default: 1.0
Settings 0.0–3600.0 seconds
12.1-12-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
To increase the flow quantity or pressure range, the CP2000 increases the first motor’s pressure
from 0 Hz to the largest operating frequency. If the output frequency reaches the frequency
setting for Pr.12-06 and delay time for Pr.12-05, the CP2000 delays the time setting for Pr.12-03.
CP2000 then switches to the next motor to use mains electricity and delays the time setting for
Pr.12-03 to run the next motor. If necessary, other motors are activated in sequence. See
sequential diagram of 12-3 and 12-4.
Diagram 12-3: Sequence of Fixed quantity circulation with PID – Increasing Demand
12.1-12-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Diagram 12-4: Sequence of switching motors at Fixed Quantity Circulation with PID
– Increasing Demands
12.1-12-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
However, if the decreasing demands for flow quantity and pressure are too big, the
CP2000 stops the current operating motors and waits for the delay time setting for Pr.12-04. It
continues doing this until the last motor stops using mains electricity. See sequential diagram
12-5 and 12-6 below.
Diagram 12-5: Sequence of Fixed Quantity Circulation with PID – Decreasing Demands
12.1-12-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Diagram 12-6: Sequence of switching motors at Fixed Quantity Circulation with PID
– Decreasing Demands
Parameter Setting
Parameter
Description
setting
Pr.12-00=2 Choose Fixed Quantity Circulation with PID
Number of Motors: maximum four motors. After you set the number of motors to be
connected at the same time, the multi-function output terminals automatically follow the
setting as shown in the table below.
Pr.12-01 01 01 02 02 03 03 04 04
Pr.02-13 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 Motor 1 by Drive
Pr.02-14 56 56 56 56 56 56 56 Motor 1 by Mains
Pr.12-01=X Pr.02-15 57 57 57 57 57 57 Motor 2 by Drive
Pr.02-36 58 58 58 58 58 Motor 2 by Mains
Pr.02-37 59 59 59 59 Motor 3 by Drive
Pr.02-38 60 60 60 Motor 3 by Mains
Pr.02-39 61 61 Motor 4 by Drive
Pr.02-40 62 Motor 4 by Mains
Table 2: Setting of Multi-function Output Terminal on Circulating Motors
Pr.12-03=X Delay Time due to the Acceleration (or the Increment) at Motor Switching (unit: sec.)
Pr.12-04=X Delay Time due to the Deceleration (or the Decrement) at Motor Switching (unit: sec.)
Pr.12-05=X Delay time while Fixed Quantity Circulation at Motor Switching with PID (unit: sec.)
Pr.12-06=X Frequency when switching motors at Fixed Quantity Circulation (Hz)
12.1-12-7
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
UVW
подключающих на сеть, и
R6AA
контакторов, подключающих к ПЧ
MO3
MO6
MO5
MO4
MO2
MO1
RC3
RC2
RC1
RA2
RA3
RA1
RB1
Contactor
M2
Contactor
Contactor
M3
Contactor
Contactor
M4
Contactor
Diagram 12-7
Frequency when Switching Motors at Fixed Quantity Circulation (Hz)
Default: 60.00
Settings 0.0–599.00 Hz
Sets the drive’s output frequency at which the system prepares to switch motors.
12.1-12-8
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Diagram 12-8: Sequence of Fixed Quantity Control with PID – Increasing Demand
12.1-12-9
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Diagram 12-9: Sequence of switching motors at Fixed Quantity Control with PID
– Increasing Demand
12.1-12-10
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
However, if the flow quantity or pressure is too large, the CP2000 stops, one by one, the motors use
mains electricity until the CP2000 decreases the main motor’s frequency to 0 Hz. See Diagram
12-10 and Diagram 12-11.
Diagram 12-10: Sequence of Fixed Quantity Control with PID – Decreasing Demand
12.1-12-11
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Diagram 12-11: Sequence of switching motors at Fixed Quantity Control with PID
– Decreasing Demand
Parameter setting:
Parameter
Description
Setting
Pr.12-00=3 Choose Fixed Quantity Control
Number of Motors: maximum of eight motors. After you set the number of connected
motors, the multi-function output terminals automatically follow the setting as shown in the
table below.
Pr.12-01 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08
Pr.02-13 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 55 Motor 1 by Mains
Pr.02-14 56 56 56 56 56 56 56 Motor 2 by Mains
12.1-12-12
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
VFD-CP2000
UVW
M0
R6AA
MO3
MO 6
MO 5
MO 4
MO2
MO1
RA2
RC2
RA 1
RA3
RC3
RB 1
RC1
Contactor
M1
Contactor
M2
Contactor
M3
Contactor
M4
Diagram 12-12
12.1-12-13
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Diagram 12-13 Fixed Time Circulation and Fixed Quantity Control with PID
12.1-12-14
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When all the motors are running and water pressure is sufficient, the fixed time circulation is not
enabled. If motor 1 and motor 2 run to reach a balance in water pressure and when the time reaches
the setting for Pr.12-02, motor 1 runs without using mains electricity (run by the motor drive). When
the time reaches the setting for Pr.12-03, motor 3 runs using mains electricity, and the operating time
of each motor resets. Once it reaches the time setting for Pr.12-02 again, motor 2 runs without using
mains electricity. Then when time reaches the setting for Pr.12-03, motor 4 runs using mains
electricity. The time sequence Diagram 12-14 is as shown below
Diagram 12-14: Fixed Time Circulation under Fixed Amount Control Balance
12.1-12-15
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-12-16
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-12-17
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
When the minimum operation time (Pr.12-27=1) is enabled, the drive sorts the operation hours
according to the amount of running motors at the moment, and then choose the motor that has
the minimum operation hour to start after RUN command.
As Example 1 below shows, the drive starts Motor 2, which having a minimum operation time
among all eight motors.
As Example 2 below shows, Motor 8 does not start though it has the minimum operation time,
because only Motor 1 to Motor 5 are started. Moreover, if more than one motors have the same
minimum operation hour, the number of the motor takes the priority. Therefore, Motor 3 starts
rather than Motor 5.
Motor operation time-Example 1
Motor No. / Motor Status Status Operating Hour Operating Min./ Sec.
Motor 1 ON 0 59 59
Motor 2 ON 0 12 12
Motor 3 ON 2 00 00
Motor 4 ON 0 43 11
Motor 5 ON 1 33 00
Motor 6 ON 3 50 05
Motor 7 ON 1 05 22
Motor 8 ON 10 20 21
12.1-12-18
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-13-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-13-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-13-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Default: 0.00
Settings 0.00–655.35
12.1-13-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-14-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
Function Chart
Settings Functions Descriptions
0 Output frequency (Hz) Maximum frequency Pr.01-00 is processed as 100%.
1 Frequency command (Hz) Maximum frequency Pr.01-00 is processed as 100%.
2 Motor speed (Hz) Maximum frequency Pr.01-00 is processed as 100%.
3 Output current (rms) (2.5 ᵡ rated current) is processed as 100%
4 Output voltage (2 ᵡ rated voltage) is processed as 100%
5 DC bus voltage 450V (900V)=100%
6 Power factor -1.000–1.000=100%
7 Power (2 ᵡ rated power) is processed as 100%
9 AVI1 0–10 V = 0–100%
10 ACI 4–20 mA = 0–100%
11 AVI2 -10–10 V = 0–100%
12.1-14-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-14-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.1-14-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
1. Control Diagram
PM SVC control diagram
12.2-00-1
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
2. PM SVC Adjustment Procedure (※ the number marked on the procedure corresponds to the
number of following adjustment explanations)
12.2-00-2
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
4. PM parameter auto-tuning:
5. Set Pr.05-00=5 (Rolling auto-tuning for PM) or 13 (Static auto-tuning for PM) and press “RUN”
key to finish motor auto-tuning, then you will get the following parameters:
Parameter Description
Pr.05-39 Stator resistance for a permanent magnet motor (Ω)
Pr.05-40 Permanent magnet motor Ld (mH)
Pr.05-41 Permanent magnet motor Lq (mH)
Ke parameter of a permanent magnet motor (Vphase,rms / krpm)
(When Pr.05-00=5, the Ke parameter is measured based on the actual
Pr.05-43 motor rotation.)
(When Pr.05-00=13, the Ke parameter is automatically calculated
based on the motor power, current and rotor speed.)
If an auto-tuning error (AUE) occurs, refer to Section 14 “Fault Codes and Descriptions” for
further treatment.
AUE Error (code) Description
AUE (40) Auto-tuning error
AUE1 (142) Auto-tuning error 1 (No feedback current error)
AUE2 (143) Auto-tuning error 2 (Motor phase loss error)
12.2-00-3
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
8. No-load
Running
SPM > Increase Pr.10-42 SPM > Decrease Pr.10-42
Initial angle detection pulse Initial angle detection pulse value
value
(Too high pulse bandwidth may
IPM > Increase Pr.10-52
Injection magnitude cause ocA)
角度偵測脈衝頻寬
YES
No-load current is
NO No-load running 10%~20% of rated
current is normal? current range
No-load current is too high
NO
Output frequency A3. Acceleration to
Periodic low-frequency wave rated frequency is Strongly high-frequency
stable? vibration of output frequency
YES
A4. Reach
NO
max. output
Motor stall at max.
rotor speed frequency?
YES
9. Running Test
with Load
8. Start the motor with no-load / light-load, and operates to 1/2 of the rated rotor speed
A1. Start operation direction:
a. If the start operation direction is wrong
SPM: increase the current proportion for Pr.10-42 (Initial angle detection pulse value) to
improve the accuracy of the angle detection.
IPM: Increase the voltage for Pr.10-52 (Injection magnitude) to improve the accuracy of the
angle detection.
12.2-00-4
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
b. If an ocA error occurs when pressing RUN to start the motor, decrease the current
proportion for Pr.10-42 (Initial angle detection pulse value). An excessive pulse current
may cause ocA error easily.
A2. Operates the motor in 1/2 of the rated rotor speed, adjust the no-load operating current
If the no-load operating current exceeds 20% of the rated current, increase Pr.07-26
(Torque compensation gain) and observe the no-load operating current.
A3. Accelerate to rated frequency and observe if the motor operates stably.
a. If the motor output rotor speed presents periodic low-frequency wave, increase Pr.10-34
(PM sensorless speed estimator low-pass filter gain), or increase Pr.10-32 (PM FOC
sensorless speed estimator bandwidth).
b. If the output frequency reflects high-frequency vibration, decrease Pr.10-34 or decrease
Pr.10-32.
A4. Accelerate the motor to the maximum rotor speed, and observe if it operates stably.
If the motor stalls when accelerating to the maximum rotor speed, then increase Pr.10-34
PM Sensorless Speed Estimator Low-pass Filter Gain, or increase Pr.00-17 Carrier
Frequency (you must set the carrier frequency larger than 10 times of the maximum output
frequency)
12.2-00-5
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.2-00-6
Chapter 12 Description of Parameter SettingsCP2000
12.2-00-7
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Communication error 1
1 (CE1)
RS-485 Modbus illegal function code
Communication error 2
2 (CE2)
RS-485 Modbus illegal data address
13-1
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Communication error 3
3 (CE3)
RS-485 Modbus illegal data value
Communication error 4
4 (CE4)
RS-485 Modbus data is written to read-only address
13-2
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Communication error
5 10 (CE10)
RS-485 Modbus transmission time-out
Save error 1
7 (SE1)
Keypad COPY error 1: Keypad copy time-out
Communication connection error SE1: The causes of error are mostly communication problems between the
keypad and control board. Potential causes include communication signal
interference and the unacceptable communication command to the Slave.
Keypad error
Check if the error occurs randomly, or only occurs when copying certain
parameters (the error displays on the upper right corner of the copy page). If you
Control board error cannot clear the error, please contact Delta.
13-3
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Save error 2
8 (SE2)
Keypad COPY error 2: parameter writing error
13-4
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Capacitor over-heat
10 warning (oH2)
The drive has detected over heat of the capacitor
13-5
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
oH warning
Model oH1 oH2
oH1 warning = (Pr. 06-15)
VFD110CP43B/4EB-21
VFD150CP43B/4EB-21
VFD185CP43B/4EB-21
VFD220CP43A/4EA-21
VFD370CP43B/4EB-21
VFD450CP43S-00/-21
VFD550CP43S-00/-21
VFD750CP43B-00/-21
VFD900CP43A-00/-21
VFD1100CP43A-00/-21
VFD1320CP43B-00/-21
VFD1600CP43A-00/-21
VFD1850CP43B-00/-21
90
VFD2200CP43A-00/-21
VFD2800CP43A-00/-21
VFD3150CP43A-00
VFD3150CP43C-00/-21
VFD3550CP43A-00
VFD3550CP43C-00/-21
VFD4000CP43A-00
VFD4000CP43C-00/-21
VFD5000CP43A-00
85
VFD5000CP43C-00/-21
VFD5600CP43A-00
Please contact Delta for more information
VFD5600CP43C-21
VFD6300CP43A-00
Please contact Delta for more information
VFD6300CP43C-21
VFD015CP53A-21
VFD022CP53A-21 85
VFD037CP53A-21
oH1 Warning = oH1 – 5
VFD055CP53A-21 100
oH2 Warning = oH2 – 5
VFD075CP53A-21
70
VFD110CP53A-21
VFD150CP53A-21
VFD185CP63A-21
VFD220CP63A-21
90 85
VFD300CP63A-21
VFD370CP63A-21
VFD450CP63A-00/-21
100
VFD550CP63A-00/-21
VFD750CP63A-00/-21
VFD900CP63A-00/-21 65
VFD1100CP63A-00/-21 oH1 Warning = oH1 – 5
VFD1320CP63A-00/-21 oH2 Warning = oH2 – 5
VFD1600CP63A-00/-21
VFD2000CP63A-00/-21
110
VFD2500CP63A-00/-21
VFD3150CP63A-00/-21
VFD4000CP63A-00/-21 70
VFD4500CP63A-00/-21
VFD5600CP63A-00/-21
VFD6300CP63A-00/-21
13-6
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
PID feedback error PID feedback loss (warning for analog feedback signal;
11 (PID) works only when PID enables)
ACI analog signal loss Analog input current loss (including all analog 4–20mA
12 (AnL) signals)
13-7
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Under current
13 (uC)
Low current
13-8
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Deviation Warning
18 (dAvE)
Over speed deviation warning
Mechanical brake is not released Check the active timing of the system.
Incorrect parameter setting of
torque limit Adjust to proper setting value.
(Pr.06-12, Pr.11-17–20)
Verify wiring of the control circuit, and wiring/grounding of the main circuit to
Malfunction caused by interference
prevent interference.
Phase loss
19 (PHL)
Input phase loss warning
13-9
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Over-torque 1
20 (ot1)
Over-torque 1 warning
13-10
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Over-torque
21 (ot2)
Over-torque 2 warning
13-11
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-12
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-13
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-14
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-15
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
CANopen guarding
36 time-out (CGdn)
CANopen guarding time-out 1
CANopen heartbeat
37 error (CHbn)
CANopen heartbeat error
13-16
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-17
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
CANopen station
41 address error (CAdn)
CANopen station address error (only supports 1–127)
CANopen memory
42 error (CFrn)
CANopen memory error
13-18
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
CANopen SDO
44 receives register CANopen SDO receives register overflow
overflow (CSbn)
13-19
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
RTC adjust
47 (PLrA)
PLC (RTC) is not adjusted
13-20
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
InnerCOM error
48 (PLiC)
InnerCOM error
13-21
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-22
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Function defect
53 (PLFn)
PLC download function code error
13-23
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Function defect
55 (PLFF)
Function code error during PLC operation
13-24
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Checksum error
56 (PLSn)
PLC checksum error
No end command
57 (PLEd)
PLC end command is missing
13-25
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-26
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-27
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-28
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-29
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-30
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-31
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-32
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
ExCom no power
74 (ECnP)
There is no power supply on the DeviceNet
13-33
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
ExCom Parameter
78 data error Profibus parameter data error
(ECPP)
ExCom configuration
79 data error Profibus configuration data error
(ECPi)
13-34
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Communication
Communication time-out for communication card and
81 time-out
the upper unit
(ECto)
Checksum error
82 (ECCS)
Checksum error for communication card and the drive
13-35
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Return defect
83 (ECrF)
Communication card returns to the default setting
13-36
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
EtherNet/IP over
85 (ECo1)
Ethernet/IP exceeds maximum communication value
13-37
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-38
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-39
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-40
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
13-41
Chapter 13 Warning CodesCP2000
Deceleration energy
123 backup (dEb)
Deceleration energy backup
13-42
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-1
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
The ocA occurs due to short circuit or ground fault at the output side of the drive.
Check for possible short circuits between terminals with the electric meter:
Hardware failure B1 corresponds to U, V and W; DC- corresponds to U, V and W;
corresponds to U, V and W.
If short circuit occur, return to the factory for repair.
Check if the setting for stall
Set the stall prevention to the proper value.
prevention is correct
14-2
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-3
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-4
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-5
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-6
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-7
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-8
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Over-voltage at stop
10 (ovS)
Over-voltage at stop
Low-voltage during
DC bus voltage is lower than Pr.06-00 setting value
11 acceleration
during acceleration
(LvA)
14-9
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Low-voltage during
DC bus voltage is lower than Pr.06-00 setting value
12 deceleration
during deceleration
(Lvd)
Low-voltage at
DC bus voltage is lower than Pr.06-00 setting value at
13 constant speed
constant speed
(Lvn)
14-10
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-11
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
IGBT overheating
16 (oH1)
IGBT temperature exceeds the protection level
14-12
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Heatsink overheating
17 (oH2)
Capacitance temperature exceeds the protection level
14-13
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
oH warning
Model oH1 oH2
oH1 warning = (Pr.06-15)
VFD185CP43B/4EB-21
VFD220CP43A/4EA-21
VFD370CP43B/4EB-21
VFD450CP43S-00/-21
VFD550CP43S-00/-21
VFD750CP43B-00/-21
VFD900CP43A-00/-21
VFD1100CP43A-00/-21
VFD1320CP43B-00/-21
VFD1600CP43A-00/-21
VFD1850CP43B-00/-21
90
VFD2200CP43A-00/-21
VFD2800CP43A-00/-21
VFD3150CP43A-00
VFD3150CP43C-00/-21
VFD3550CP43A-00
VFD3550CP43C-00/-21
VFD4000CP43A-00
VFD4000CP43C-00/-21
VFD5000CP43A-00
85
VFD5000CP43C-00/-21
VFD5600CP43A-00
Please contact Delta for more information
VFD5600CP43C-21
VFD6300CP43A-00
Please contact Delta for more information
VFD6300CP43C-21
VFD015CP53A-21
VFD022CP53A-21 85
VFD037CP53A-21
oH1 Warning = oH1 – 5
VFD055CP53A-21 100
oH2 Warning = oH2 – 5
VFD075CP53A-21
70
VFD110CP53A-21
VFD150CP53A-21
VFD185CP63A-21
VFD220CP63A-21
90 85
VFD300CP63A-21
VFD370CP63A-21
VFD450CP63A-00/-21
100
VFD550CP63A-00/-21
VFD750CP63A-00/-21
VFD900CP63A-00/-21 65
VFD1100CP63A-00/-21 oH1 Warning = oH1 – 5
VFD1320CP63A-00/-21 oH2 Warning = oH2 – 5
VFD1600CP63A-00/-21
VFD2000CP63A-00/-21
110
VFD2500CP63A-00/-21
VFD3150CP63A-00/-21
VFD4000CP63A-00/-21 70
VFD4500CP63A-00/-21
VFD5600CP63A-00/-21
VFD6300CP63A-00/-21
14-14
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
IGBT temperature
18 detection failure IGBT hardware failure in temperature detection
(tH1o)
Capacitor hardware
19 error Hardware failure in capacitor temperature detection
(tH2o)
14-15
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-16
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Electronics thermal
Electronics thermal relay 1 protection. The drive coasts
22 relay 1 protection
to stop once it activates.
(EoL1)
14-17
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Electronic thermal
Electronic thermal relay 2 protection. The drive coasts
23 relay 2 protection
to stop once it activates.
(EoL2)
14-18
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-19
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-20
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-21
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-22
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Under current
28 (uC)
Low current detection
14-23
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
U-phase error
33 (cd1)
U-phase current detection error when power is ON
14-24
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
W-phase error
35 (cd3)
W-phase current detection error when power ON
14-25
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
oc hardware error
37 (Hd1)
oc hardware protection error when power is ON
ov hardware error
38 (Hd2)
ov hardware protection error when power is ON
14-26
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Auto-tuning error
40 (AUE)
Motor auto-tuning error
14-27
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
PG feedback loss Pr.10-00 and Pr.10-02 is not set in the PG control mode.
43 (PGF2) When press “RUN” key, PGF2 fault occurs.
14-28
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-29
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
ACI loss Analog input loss (including all the 4–20 mA analog
48 (ACE) signal)
14-30
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Password is locked
52 (Pcod)
Entering the wrong password three consecutive times
14-31
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Illegal command
54 (CE1)
Communication command is illegal
14-32
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Data is written to
57 read-only address Data is written to read-only address
(CE4)
14-33
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Modbus transmission
58 time-out Modbus transmission time-out occurs
(CE10)
Brake transistor error The brake transistor of the motor drive is abnormal. (for
60 (bF) the models with built-in brake transistor)
14-34
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Y-connection /
Δ-connection
61 switch error
An error occurs when Y-Δ switches
(ydc)
14-35
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-36
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Reverse direction of
Rotating direction is different from the commanding
68 the speed feedback
direction detected by the sensorless
(SdRv)
14-37
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Large deviation of
A large deviation between the rotating speed and the
70 speed feedback
command detected by the sensorless
(SdDe)
14-38
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-39
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-40
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-41
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-42
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-43
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-44
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
Overload protection at
87 low frequency (oL3)
Low frequency and high current protection
Rotor position
89 detection error Rotor position detection error protection
(RoPd)
14-45
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-46
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
CANopen guarding
101 error (CGdE)
CANopen guarding error
CANopen heartbeat
102 error (CHbE)
CANopen heartbeat error
14-47
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-48
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
CANopen station
106 address error (CAdE)
CANopen station address error (only supports 1–127)
CANopen memory
107 error (CFrE)
CANopen memory error
14-49
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
PMLess shaft lock The drive has RUN command with output frequency, but
112 (SfLK) the permanent magnetic motor does not turn.
14-50
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
14-51
Chapter 14 Fault Codes and DescriptionsCP2000
C/B mismatch
170 (CBM)
Control board matching error
14-52
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
15-1
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
The built-in CANopen function is a kind of remote control. You can control the AC motor drive by
using CANopen protocol. CANopen is a CAN-based higher layer protocol. It provides standardized
communication objects, including real-time data (Process Data Objects, PDO), configuration data
(Service Data Objects, SDO) and special functions (Time Stamp, Sync message, and Emergency
message). It also has network management data, including Boot-up message, NMT message, and Error
Control message. Refer to CiA website http://www.can-cia.org/ for details. The content of this instruction
sheet may be revised without prior notice. Please consult our distributors or download the most updated
version at http://www.delta.com.tw/industrialautomation
Delta CANopen supporting functions:
Support CAN2.0A Protocol;
Support CANopen DS301 V4.02;
Support DSP-402 V2.0.
Delta CANopen supporting services:
PDO (Process Data Objects): PDO1–PDO4
SDO (Service Data Object):
Initiate SDO Download;
Initiate SDO Upload;
Abort SDO;
SDO message can be used to configure the slave node and access the Object Dictionary in every
node.
SOP (Special Object Protocol):
Support default COB-ID in Predefined Master/Slave Connection Set in DS301 V4.02;
Support SYNC service;
Support Emergency service.
NMT (Network Management):
Support NMT module control;
Support NMT Error control;
Support Boot-up.
Delta CANopen not supporting service:
Time Stamp service
15-2
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
OSI Layer 7
Application Communication Profile CiA DS-301
OSI Layer 2
CAN Controller CAN 2.0A
Data Link Layer
+ -
OSI Layer 1
Physical Layer + - ISO 11898
CAN bus
8~1
plug
15-3
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
The Network Management (NMT) follows a Master/Slave structure for executing NMT service. A
network has only one NMT master, and the other nodes are slaves. All CANopen nodes have a
present NMT state, and NMT master can control the state of the slave nodes. Following shows the
state diagram of a node:
15-4
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Use SDO to access the Object Dictionary in every CANopen node using the Client / Server model.
One SDO has two COB-ID (request SDO and response SDO) to upload or download data between
two nodes. There is no data limit for SDOs to transfer data, but it must transfer data by segment
when the data exceeds four bytes with an end signal in the last segment.
The Object Dictionary (OD) is a group of objects in a CANopen node. Every node has an OD in the
system, and OD contains all parameters describing the device and its network behavior. The access
path in the OD is the index and sub-index; each object has a unique index in the OD, and has a
sub-index if necessary.
PDO communication can be described by the producer / consumer model. Each node of the
network listens to the messages of the transmission node and distinguishes whether the message
has to be processed or not after receiving the message. A PDO can be transmitted from one device
to one another device or to many other devices. Every PDO has two PDO services: a TxPDO and
an RxPDO. PDOs are transmitted in a non-confirmed mode. All transmission types are listed in the
following table:
PDO
Type Number
Cyclic Acyclic Synchronous Asynchronous RTR only
0 ○ ○
1–240 ○ ○
241–251 Reserved
252 ○ ○
253 ○ ○
254 ○
255 ○
Type number 0 indicates the synchronous aperiodic message between two PDO transmissions.
Type number 1–240 indicates the number of SYNC message between two PDO transmissions.
Type number 252 indicates the data is updated (but not sent) immediately after receiving SYNC.
Type number 253 indicates the data is updated immediately after receiving RTR.
Type number 254 indicates that Delta CANopen does not support this transmission format.
Type number 255 indicates the data is an asynchronous aperiodic transmission.
All PDO transmission data must be mapped to index via Object Dictionary.
When errors occur inside the hardware, an emergency object is triggered. An emergency
object is only sent when an error occurs. As long as there is nothing wrong with the hardware, there
is no emergency object warning of an error message.
15-5
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Characteristic
line impedance
Characteristic
line impedance
15-6
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
There are two control modes for CANopen: the DS402 standard (Pr.09-40 set to 1) is the default,
and the Delta’s standard setting (Pr.09-40 set to 0). There are two control modes according to Delta’s
standard. One is the old control mode (Pr.09-30=0), this control mode can only control the motor
drive under frequency control. The other mode is a new standard (Pr.09-30=1); this new control
mode allows the motor drive to be controlled under multiple modes. The CP2000 currently only
supports speed mode. The following table shows the control mode definitions:
Control Mode
CANopen Control
Speed
Mode Selection
Index Description
DS402 standard 6042-00 Target rotating speed (rpm)
Pr.09-40=1 ----- -----
Delta Standard (Old definition)
2020-02 Target rotating speed (Hz)
Pr.09-40=0 Pr.09-30=0
Delta Standard (New definition) 2060-03 Target rotating speed (Hz)
Pr.09-40=0, Pr.09-30=1 2060-04 Torque Limit (%)
15-7
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
15-3-2-1 Related set up for an AC motor drive (following the DS402 standard)
If you want to use the DS402 standard to control the motor drive, follow these steps:
1. Wire the hardware (refer to Section 15-2 Wiring for CANopen)
2. Set the operation source: set Pr.00-21 to 3 for CANopen communication card control.
(Run/stop, forward/reverse run…etc.)
3. Set the frequency source: set Pr.00-20 to 6. Choose the source of the frequency command
from the CANopen setting.)
4. Set DS402 for the control mode: Pr.09-40=1
5. Set the CANopen station: set the CANopen station (range 1–127, 0 is to disable the CANopen
slave function) with Pr.09-36. Note: set Pr.00-02=7 to reset if the station number error CAdE or
CANopen memory error CFrE appears.
6. Set the CANopen baud rate: set Pr.09-37 (CANBUS Baud Rate: 1 Mbps(0), 500 Kbps(1), 250
Kbps (2), 125 Kbps (3), 100 Kbps (4) and 50 Kbps (5))
7. Set the multiple input functions to Quick Stop, you can also choose enable or disable; the
default setting is disabled. If it is necessary to enable the function, set MI terminal to 53 in one
of the following parameter: Pr.02-01–Pr.02-08 or Pr.02-26–Pr.02-31. (Note: This function is
available in DS402 only.)
15-3-2-2 The status of the motor drive (by following DS402 standard)
According to the DS402 definition, the motor drive is divided into 3 blocks and 9 statuses as
described below.
3 blocks
1. Power Disable: Without PWM output
2. Power Enable: With PWM output
3. Fault: One or more errors have occurred.
9 status
1. Start: Power On
2. Not ready to switch on: The motor drive is initiating.
3. Switch On Disable: occurs when the motor drive finishes initiating.
4. Ready to switch on: warming up before running.
5. Switch On: the motor drive has the PWM output now, but the reference command is not effective.
6. Operation Enable: able to control normally.
7. Quick Stop Active: when there is a Quick Stop request, stop running the motor drive.
8. Fault Reaction Active: the motor drive detects conditions that might trigger error(s).
9. Fault: One or more errors have occurred in the motor drive.
When the motor drive turns on and finishes the initiation, it remains in Ready to Switch On
status. To control the operation of the motor drive, change to Operation Enable status. To do this,
set the control word's bit0–bit3 and bit7 of the Index 6040H and pair with Index Status Word
(Status Word 0X6041). The control steps and index definition are described as below:
Index 6040
15–9 8 7 6–4 3 2 1 0
Enable Enable
Reserved Halt Fault Reset Operation Quick Stop Switch On
operation Voltage
15-8
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Index 6041
15–14 13–12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
Internal Switch
Target Quick Voltage Operation Switch Ready to
Reserved Operation limit Remote Reserved Warning on Fault
reached stop enabled enable on switch on
active disabled
Set command 6040=0xE, then set another command 6040 =0xF. Then you can switch the motor
drive to Operation Enable. The Index 605A determines the lines from Operation Enable when the
control mode changes from Quick Stop Active. When the setting value is 1–3, both lines are active,
but when the setting value of 605A is not 1–3, once the motor drive is switched to Quick Stop Active,
it is not be able to switch back to Operation Enable.
PDO
Index Sub Definition Default R/W Size Unit Mode note
Map
0: disable drive function
1: slow down on slow down ramp
2: slow down on quick stop ramp
3: slow down on the current limit
5: slow down on slow down ramp
605Ah 0 Quick stop option code 2 RW S16 No
and stay in QUICK STOP
6: slow down on quick stop ramp
and stay in QUICK STOP
7: slow down on the current limit
and stay in Quick stop
15-9
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
When the control section switches from Power Enable to Power Disable, use 605C to define parking
method.
PDO
Index Sub Definition Default R/W Size Unit Mode note
Map
0: Disable drive function
Disable operation option 1: Slow down with slow down
605Ch 0 code 1 RW S16 No
ramp; disable of the drive
function
4. To set acceleration and deceleration: Use 604F (Acceleration) and 6050 (Deceleration).
5. Trigger an ACK signal: in the speed control mode, the bit6–4 of Index 6040 needs to be controlled.
It is defined as below:
Index 6040
SUM
bit6 bit5 bit4
Speed mode
1 0 1 Locked at the current signal.
(Index 6060=2)
1 1 1 Run to reach targeting signal.
Other Decelerate to 0 Hz.
NOTE 01: Read 6043 to get the current rotation speed. (Unit: rpm)
NOTE 02: Read bit10 of 6041 to find if the rotation speed has reached the targeting value. (0: Not
reached; 1: Reached)
15-10
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
15-3-3 Using the Delta Standard (Old definition, only supports speed mode)
15-11
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Speed Mode
1. Set CP2000 to speed control mode: set Index6060 = 2.
2. Set the target frequency: set 2060-03, unit is Hz, with 2 decimal places. For example, 1000 is
10.00Hz.
3. Operation control: set 2060-01 = 008H for Server on, and set 2060-01 = 0081H for running.
15-12
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
To control the DO/AO of the motor drive through CANopen, follow the steps below:
1. Define the DO to be controlled by CANopen. For example, set Pr.02-14=50 to control RY2.
2. Define the AO to be controlled by CANopen. For example, set Pr.03-23=20 to control AFM2.
3. Control the mapping index of CANopen. To control DO, use control Index2026-41. To control AO,
you will need to control 2026-AX. To set RY2 as ON, set bit1 of Index 2026-41 =1, then RY2
outputs 1. To control AFM2 output = 50.00%, set Index 2026-A2 =5000, then AFM2 outputs 50%.
The following table shows the mapping of CANopen DI/ DO/ AI/ AO:
DI:
Terminal Related Parameters R/W Mapping Index
FWD == RO 2026-01 bit0
REV == RO 2026-01 bit1
MI 1 == RO 2026-01 bit2
MI 2 == RO 2026-01 bit3
MI 3 == RO 2026-01 bit4
MI 4 == RO 2026-01 bit5
MI 5 == RO 2026-01 bit6
MI 6 == RO 2026-01 bit7
MI 7 == RO 2026-01 bit8
MI 8 == RO 2026-01 bit9
MI 10 == RO 2026-01 bit10
MI 11 == RO 2026-01 bit11
MI 12 == RO 2026-01 bit12
MI 13 == RO 2026-01 bit13
MI 14 == RO 2026-01 bit14
MI 15 == RO 2026-01 bit15
DO:
Terminal Related Parameters R/W Mapping Index
RY1 Pr.02-13 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit0
RY2 Pr.02-14 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit1
RY3 Pr.02-15 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit2
MO10/RY10 Pr.02-36 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit5
MO11/RY11 Pr.02-37 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit6
RY12 Pr.02-38 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit7
RY13 Pr.02-39 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit8
RY14 Pr.02-40 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit9
RY15 Pr.02-41 = 51 RW 2026-41 bit10
AI:
Terminal Related Parameters R/W Mapping Index
AVI1 == RO Value of 2026-61
ACI == RO Value of 2026-62
AVI2 == RO Value of 2026-63
AO:
Terminal Related Parameters R/W Mapping Index
AFM1 Pr.03-20 = 21 RW Value of 26A0h
AFM2 Pr.03-23 = 21 RW Value of 26A1h
AFM10 Pr.14-12 = 21 RW Value of 26AAh
AFM11 Pr.14-13 = 21 RW Value of 26ABh
15-13
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
15-14
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Factory
Index Sub Definition R/W Size Note
Setting
bit1 1: Reset
bit2 1: Base Block (B.B) ON
bit15–3 Reserved
0 Number 10 R U8
High byte: Warn code
1 Error code 0 R U16
Low byte: Error code
00B: stop
01B: decelerate to stop
bit1–0 10B: waiting for operation
command
11B: in operation
bit2 1: JOG command
00B: run forward
01B: switch from run in reverse
to run forward
bit4–3
10B: switch from run forward to
run in reverse
11B: run in reverse
bit7–5 Reserved
2 AC motor drive status 0 R U16
1: master frequency command
bit8 controlled by communication
interface
1: master frequency command
bit9 controlled by analog signal
input
1: operation command
bit10 controlled by communication
2021H interface
bit11 1: Parameter lock
1: Enable the digital keypad
bit12
copy parameter function
bit15–13 Reserved
Freq. command
3 0 R U16
(XXX.XX Hz)
4 Output freq. (XXX.XX Hz) 0 R U16
5 Output current (XX.X A) 0 R U16
6 DC bus voltage (XXX.X V) 0 R U16
7 Output voltage (XXX.X V) 0 R U16
The current segment run by
8 the multi-segment speed 0 R U16
command
9 Reserved 0 R U16
A Display counter value (c) 0 R U16
Display output power angle
B 0 R U16
(XX.X°)
Display output torque
C 0 R U16
(XXX.X %)
Display actual motor speed
D 0 R U16
(rpm)
10 Power output (X.XXX kWh) 0 R U16
Multi-function display
17 0 R U16
(Pr.00-04)
0 Reserved 0 R U16
1 Display output current 0 R U16
2 Display counter value 0 R U16
2022H Display actual output
3 0 R U16
frequency (XXX.XX Hz)
Display DC bus voltage
4 0 R U16
(XXX.X V)
15-15
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Factory
Index Sub Definition R/W Size Note
Setting
Display output voltage
5 0 R U16
(XXX.X V)
Display output power angle
6 0 R U16
(XX.X°)
7 Display output power in kW 0 R U16
Display actual motor speed
8 0 R U16
(rpm)
Display estimate output
9 0 R U16
torque (XXX.X%)
Display PID feedback value
B after enabling PID function 0 R U16
in % (To 2 decimal places)
Display signal of AVI 1
C analog input terminal, 0–10 0 R U16
V corresponds to 0–100%
(To 2 decimal places)
Display signal of ACI analog
input terminal, 4–20 mA
D 0 R U16
/0–10 V corresponds to
0–100% (To 2 decimal places)
Display signal of AVI 2
analog input terminal, -10
E V–10 V corresponds to 0 R U16
-100–100% (To 2 decimal
places)
Display the IGBT
F temperature of drive power 0 R U16
module in oC
Display the temperature of
10 0 R U16
capacitance in oC
The status of digital input
11 0 R U16
(ON/OFF), refer to Pr.02-12
The status of digital output
12 0 R U16
(ON/OFF), refer to Pr.02-18
Display the multi-step
13 0 R U16
speed that is executing
The corresponding CPU pin
14 0 R U16
status of digital input
The corresponding CPU pin
15 0 R U16
status of digital output
Display times of counter
1A 0 R U16
overload (0.00–100.00%)
1B Display GFF in % 0 R U16
Display DC bus voltage
1C 0 R U16
ripples (Unit: VDC)
Display PLC register D1043
1D 0 R U16
data
Display Pole of Permanent
1E 0 R U16
Magnet Motor
User page displays the
1F 0 R U16
value in physical measure
20 Output Value of Pr.00-05 0 R U16
Number of motor turns
21 0 R U16
when drive operates
22 Operation position of motor 0 R U16
23 Fan speed of the drive 0 R U16
Control mode of the drive 0:
24 0 R U16
speed mode
Carrier frequency of the
25 0 R U16
drive
26 Reserved
27 Motor status
15-16
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
Factory
Index Sub Definition R/W Size Note
Setting
2A kWh display
Motor actual position
2D
low-word
Motor actual position
2E
high-word
2F PID reference target
30 PID bias value
31 PID output frequency
Index
bit0 bit1 bit2 bit3 bit4 bit5 bit6 bit7 bit8 bit9 bit10 bit11 bit12 bit13 bit14 bit15
2026-41
1 RY1 RY2 MO1 MO2
2 MO10 MO11
3 RY10 RY11 RY12 RY13 RY14 RY15
15-17
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
10–14 Reserved
15-18
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
DS402 Standard
Factory PDO
Index Sub Definition R/W Size Unit Mode Note
Setting Map
0: No action
6007h 0 Abort connection option code 2 RW S16 Yes 2: Disable Voltage
3: quick stop
603Fh 0 Error code 0 R0 U16 Yes
6040h 0 Control word 0 RW U16 Yes
6041h 0 Status word 0 R0 U16 Yes
6042h 0 vl target velocity 0 RW S16 rpm Yes vl
6043h 0 vl velocity demand 0 RO S16 rpm Yes vl
6044h 0 vl control effort 0 RO S16 rpm Yes vl
604Fh 0 vl ramp function time 10000 RW U32 1ms Yes vl
Unit must be: 100 ms, and
6050h 0 vl slow down time 10000 RW U32 1ms Yes vl
check if the setting is 0.
6051h 0 vl quick stop time 1000 RW U32 1ms Yes vl
0: disable drive function
1: slow down on slow down
ramp
2: slow down on quick stop
ramp
605Ah 0 Quick stop option code 2 RW S16 No 5: slow down on slow down
ramp and stay in QUICK
STOP
6: slow down on quick stop
ramp and stay in QUICK
STOP
0: Disable drive function
Disable operation option 1: Slow down with slow
605Ch 0 1 RW S16 No
code down ramp; disable of the
drive function
2: Velocity Mode
6060h 0 Mode of operation 2 RW S8 Yes
4: Torque Profile Mode
6061h 0 Mode of operation display 2 RO S8 Yes Same as above
15-19
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
15-20
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
15-21
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
Overload; the AC motor drive detects
excessive drive output current.
21 0015H NOTE: The AC motor drive can withstand up 1 2310H
to 150% of the rated current for a maximum of
60 seconds.
15-22
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
15-23
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
External Base Block; when the
multi-function input terminal (B.B.) is
51 0033H 5 9000H
active, the AC motor drive stops
output
15-24
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
15-25
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
15-26
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
CANopen
ID CANopen
Display Fault code Description fault register
No.* fault code
(bit0–7)
15-27
Chapter 15 CANopen Overview│CP2000
RUN LED:
LED status Condition CANopen State
OFF Initial
Blinking Pre-Operation
ON
200 200 1000
Single flash 單次閃爍 ms ms ms Stopped
OFF
ON Operation
ERR LED:
LED status Condition/ State
OFF No Error
One Message fail
Single ON
200 1000
flash 單次閃爍 ms ms
OFF
SYNC fail
Triple flash ON
200 200 200 200 200 1000
雙次閃爍 ms ms ms ms ms ms
OFF
Bus off
ON
15-28
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-3 Turn on
16-1
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
The following basic requirements that need to install WPLSoft editing software:
Item System requirements
Operating system Windows 95/98/2000/NT/ME/XP
CPU At least Pentium 90
Memory At least 16MB (we recommend at least 32MB)
Hard drive capacity: at least 100MB free space
Hard drive
One optical drive (for use in installing this software)
Resolution: 640×480, at least 16 colors; it is recommended that the screen
Display
area be set at 800×600 pixels
Mouse Ordinary mouse or Windows-compatible device
Printer Printer with a Windows driver program
RS-485 port Must have at least an RS-485 port to link to the PLC
16-2
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
3. The client can simultaneously access data from the converter and internal PLC, which is
performed through identification of the node. For instance, if the converter node is 1 and the
internal PLC node is 2, then the client command will be
01 (node) 03 (read) 0400 (address) 0001 (1 data item), indicating that it must read the data in
converter Pr.04-00.
02 (node) 03 (read) 0400 (address) 0001 (1 data item), indicating that it must read the data in
internal PLC X0
4. The PLC program will be disabled when uploading/ downloading programs.
5. Please note when using WPR commands to write in parameters, values may be modified up to
a maximum of 109 times, otherwise a memory write error will occur. The calculation of
modifications is based on whether the entered value has been changed. If the entered value is
left unchanged, the modifications will not increase afterwards. But if the entered value is
different from before, the number of modifications will increase by one. Those parameters listed
below are exceptions, please proceed to the next page for details:
Pr.00-11 Speed control mode
Pr.01-12–01-19 Acceleration / Deceleration time 1–4
Pr.02-12 Multi-function input mode selection
Pr.02-18 Multi-function output direction
Pr.04-50–04-59 PLC buffer 0–9
Pr.08-04 Upper limit of integral control
Pr.08-05 PID output command limit
16-3
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
6. When Pr.00-04 is set as 28, the displayed value is the value of PLC register D1043 (see figure
below):
Keypad KPC-CC01
Can display 0–65535
H 0.00Hz
A 0.00Hz
C _____
7. In the PLC Run and PLC Stop mode, the content 9 and 10 of Pr.00-02 cannot be set nor be
reset to the default value.
8. The PLC can be reset to the default value when Pr.00-02 is set as 6.
9. The corresponding MI function will be disabled when the PLC writes to input contact X.
10. When the PLC controls converter operation, control commands will be entirely controlled by the
PLC and will not be affected by the setting of parameter 00-21.
11. When the PLC controls converter frequency commands (FREQ commands), frequency
commands will be entirely controlled by the PLC, and will not be affected by the setting of
Pr.00-20 or the Hand ON/OFF configuration.
12. When the PLC controls the drive’s operation, if the keypad Stop setting is valid, this will trigger
an FStP error and cause stoppage.
16-4
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-3 Turn on
16-3-1 Connect to PC
Start operation of PLC functions in accordance with the following four steps
1. After pressing the Menu key and selecting 4: PLC on the KPC-CC01 digital keypad, press
the Enter key (see figure below).
2. Wiring: Connect the driver's RJ45 communications interface to a PC via the RS-485
When the external multifunctional input terminals (MI1–MI8) are in PLC Mode select bit0
(51) or PLC Mode select bit1 (52), and the terminal contact is closed or open, it will
compulsorily switch to the PLC mode, and keypad switching will be ineffective.
Corresponding actions are as follows:
16-5
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
PLC mode
PLC Mode select bit1(52) PLC Mode select bit0 (51)
Using KPC-CC01
Disable OFF OFF
PLC Run OFF ON
PLC Stop ON OFF
Maintain previous
ON ON
state
NOTE
16-6
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Output devices:
Serial
Y0 Y1 Y2 Y3 Y4 Y5 Y6 Y7 Y10 Y11 Y12 Y13 Y14 Y15 Y16 Y17
No.
1 RY1 RY2 RY3
2 MO10 MO11
3 RY10 RY11 RY12 RY13 RY14 RY15
1: Control I/O
2: Extension card: EMC-D42A (D1022=5)
3: Extension card: EMC-R6AA (D1022=6)
16-7
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Step 2: The WPLSoft editing window appears (see figure 16-2 below). When running WPLSoft for the
first time, before "New file" has been used, only the "File (F)," "Communications (C)," View
(V)," "Options (O)," and "Help (H)" columns will appear on the function toolbar.
Figure 16-2
NOTE After running WPLSoft for the second time, the last file edited will open and be displayed
in the editing window. The following figure 16-3 provides an explanation of the WPLSoft editing
software window:
Figure 16-3
16-8
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Step 3: Click on the icon on the toolbar: opens new file (Ctrl+N), see figure 16-4 below
Figure 16-4
NOTE You can also find “New file (N) (Ctrl+N)” in the "File (F)", as shown in figure 16-5 below.
Figure 16-5
Step 4: The "Device settings" window will appear after clicking, see figure 16-6 below. You can now
enter the project title and filename, and select the device and communication settings to be
used.
Figure 16-6
Communications settings: Perform settings in accordance with the desired communications method.
See figure 16-7 below.
Figure 16-7
16-9
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Step 5: Press Confirm after completing settings and begin program editing. There are two program
editing methods; you can choose whether to perform editing in the command mode or the
ladder diagram mode (see figure 16-8 below).
Figure 16-8
NOTE In ladder diagram mode, you can perform program editing using the buttons on the
function icon row (see figure 16-9 below).
Figure 16-9
16-10
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Basic Operation-Example
Input the ladder diagram as the figure below. The following steps can be operated through the mouse
or function key (F1–F12) on the keyboard.
Figure 16-10
Step 1: The following screen will appear after a new file is established:
Figure 16-11
Step 2: Click on the always-open switch icon or press the function key F1. After the name of the
input device and the comment dialog box have appeared, the device name (such as "M"),
device number (such as "10"), and input comments (such as "auxiliary contact") can be
selected; press the OK button when finished (see figure 16-12 and 16-13 below).
Figure 16-12
16-11
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Figure 16-13
Step 3: Click on the output coil icon or press function key F7. After the name of the input device
and the comment dialog box have appeared, the device name (such as "Y"), device number
(such as "0"), and input comments (such as "output coil") can be selected; press the OK button
when finished (see figure 16-14 and 16-15 below).
Figure 16-14
Figure 16-15
16-12
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Step 4: Press “ENTER” button, when the “Input Instructions” window appears, key in “END” in the
field and press the OK button (see figure 16-16 and 16-17 below).
Figure 16-16
Figure 16-17
Step 5: Click on the “Ladder diagram => Code” icon, which will compile the edited ladder
diagram as a command program. After compiling, the number of steps will appear on the left
side of the busbar (see figure 16-18 below).
Figure 16-18
16-13
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
After inputting a program using WPLSoft, select compile . After completing compilation, select
the to download a program. WPLSoft will perform program download with the online PLC in the
While confirming that the PLC is in the Run mode, after downloading a program, click on in the
communications menu and select start ladder diagram control (see figure below)
16-14
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-15
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-16
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Parallel NO OR X、Y、M、T、C
Positive edge-triggered
LDP X、Y、M、T、C
switch
Negative edge-triggered
LDF X、Y、M、T、C
switch
Positive edge-triggered
ANDP X、Y、M、T、C
series
Negative edge-triggered
ANDF X、Y、M、T、C
series
Positive edge-triggered
ORP X、Y、M、T、C
parallel
Negative edge-triggered
ORF X、Y、M、T、C
parallel
MPS
Multiple outputs MRD N/A
MPP
16-17
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Ladder diagram
Explanation of commands Command Using Device
structures
Coil driven output
OUT Y、M
commands
Some basic
Some basic commands, commands
applications commands Applications
commands
Inverted logic INV N/A
X0 X1 X2 X3 X4 X5 X6 X7 X10 C0 C1
00000
X11 X12 X13
00000 Y0
Row Number
The ladder diagram programming method involves scanning from the upper left corner to the
lower right corner. The coils and applications command computing box are handled in the output, and
the ladder diagram is placed on the farthest right. Taking the figure below as an example, we can
gradually analyze the procedural sequence of the ladder diagram. The number in the upper right
corner gives the sequential order.
1 LD X0
2 OR M0
3 AND X1
4 LD X3
X0 X1 Y1 X4
AND M1
ORB Y1
5 LD Y1 M0 T0 M3
TMR T0 K10
AND X4
6 LD T0 X3 M1
AND M3
ORB
7 ANB
8 OUT Y1
TMR T0 K10
16-18
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
LDP and LDF have this command structure, but there are differences in their action state. LDP, LDF
only act at the rising or falling edge of a conducting contact. (see figure below):
AND (ANI) command: A series configuration in which a single device is connected with one device
or a block.
ANDP, ANDF also have structures like this, but their action occurs at the rising and falling edge.
ORP, ORF also have identical structures, but their action occurs at the rising and falling edge.
ANB command: A configuration in which one block is in series with one device or block.
16-19
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
ORB command: A configuration in which one block is in parallel with one device or block.
In the case of ANB and ORB operations, if a number of blocks are connected, they should be
combined to form a block or network from the top down or from left to right.
MPS, MRD, MPP commands: Branching point memory for multiple outputs, enabling multiple,
different outputs. The MPS command begins at a branching point, where the so-called branching
point refers to the intersection of horizontal and vertical lines. We have to rely on the contact status
along a single vertical line to determine whether the next contact can give a memory command.
While each contact is basically able to give memory commands, in view of convenience and the
PLC's capacity restrictions, this can be omitted from some places when converting a ladder diagram.
The structure of the ladder diagram can be used to judge what kinds of contact memory commands
are used.
MPS can be distinguished by use of the "┬" symbol; this command can be used consecutively
for up to 8 times. The MRD command is read from branching point memory; because logic states
along any one vertical line must be the same, in order to continue analysis of other ladder diagrams,
the original contact status must be read.
MRD can be distinguished by use of the "├" symbol. The MPP command is read from the
starting state of the uppermost branching point, and it is read from the stack (pop); because it is the
final command along a vertical line, it indicates that the state of the vertical line can be concluded.
MPP can be distinguished by use of the "└" symbol. Although there should basically be no errors
when using the foregoing analytical approach, the compiling program may sometimes omit identical
state output, as shown in the following figure:
MPS
( )
( )
( )
( )
MRD
( )
MPP ( )
( )
16-20
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Y1 X2
Y1
STOP
X1
START
X1 X2
Y1
START STOP
Y1
16-21
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
X1 X3
Y1 X1
Y1 X3
X2
X2 X4 Y1
Y2 X4
Y2
Y1
Y2
X1 X3 Y2
Y1 X1
Y1 X3
X2
X2 X4 Y1
Y2 X4
Y2
Y1
Y2
16-22
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Y1
X2 X4 Y1
Y2
Y2
Y1
Y1 Y1
T T
X0 Y1
TMR T0 Kn X0
T0
Y1
Y1
nT T
16-23
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
X0
M0 X0
M0 Y1 T
Y1 M0
M0 Y1
Y1
16-24
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Example 11: The open/close delay circuit is composed of two timers; output Y4 will have a delay
whether input X0 is On or Off.
X0
TMR T5 K50 X0
T5 T6 5秒
Y4 T5
Y4
Y4
Y4 X0 T6
TMR T6 K30 3秒
Y1
(n1+n2)*T
16-25
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-26
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
The PLC can use five types of numerical values to implement calculations based on its control tasks;
the following is an explanation of the missions and functions of different numerical values.
Binary Number, BIN
The PLC's numerical operations and memory employ binary numbers. Binary nibbles and relevant
terms are explained as follows:
bit bits are the fundamental units of binary values, and have a state of either 1 or 0
Comprised of a series of 4 bits (such as b3–b0); can be used to express a
Nibble
one-nibble decimal number 0–9 or hexadecimal number: 0–F.
Comprised of a series of two nibbles (i.e. 8 bits, b7–b0); can express a
Byte
hexadecimal number: 00–FF.
Comprised of a series of two bytes (i.e. 16 bits, b15–b0); can express a
Word
hexadecimal number with four nibbles: 0000–FFFF.
Comprised of a series of two words (i.e. 32 bits, b31–b0); can express a
Double Word
hexadecimal number with eight nibbles: 00000000–FFFFFFFF
16-27
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Relationship between bits, digits, nibbles, words, and double words in a binary system (see figure
below):
Constant K
Decimal numbers are usually prefixed with a "K" in a PLC system, such as K100. This indicates that it
is a decimal number with a numerical value of 100.
Exceptions: K can be combined with bit device X, Y, M, or S to produce data in the form of a nibble,
byte, word, or double word, such as in the case of K2Y10 or K4M100. Here K1 represents a
4-bit combination, and K2-K4 variously represent 8-, 12-, and 16-bit combinations.
Constant H
Hexadecimal numbers are usually prefixed with the letter "H" in a PLC system, such as in the case of
H100, which indicates a hexadecimal number with a numerical value of 100.
16-28
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Output contact When the count reaches the set value, the contact comes On and stays On
The current value reverts to 0 when an RST command is executed, and the
Reset
contact reverts to Off
Contact actuation All are actuated after the end of scanning
Counter functions
When a counter's counting pulse input signal goes OFF→ON, if the counter's current value is
equal to the set value, the output coil will become ON. The setting value will be a decimal K values,
and the data register D can also serve as a setting value.
16-bit counter C0–C79:
16-bit counter setting range: K0–K32,767. (when K0 and K1 are identical, the output contact
will immediately be ON during the first count.)
The current counter value will be cleared from an ordinary counter when power is shut off to the
PLC.
If the MOV command or WPLSoft is used to transmit a value greater than the set value to the
C0 current value register, when the next X1 goes from OFF→ON, the C0 counter contact will
change to On, and the current value will change to the set value.
A counter's setting value may be directly set using a constant K or indirectly set using the value
in register D (not including special data registers D1000–D1199 or D2000–D2799).
If the set value employs a constant K, it may only be a positive number; the set value may be
either a positive or a negative number if the value in data register D is used. The current
counter value will change from 32,767 to -32,768 as the count continues to accumulate.
16-29
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Example
LD X0
X0
RST C0 RST C0
LD X1 X1
CNT C0 K5
CNT C0 K5
C0
LD C0 Y0
OUT Y0
1. When X0=On and the RST command is
executed, the current value of C0 will
revert to 0, and the output contact will
revert to Off.
2. When X1 changes from Off→On, the
current value of the counter will execute
an increase (add one).
3. When the count of counter C0 reaches the
set value K5, the contact C0 will come On,
and the current value of C0= set value
=K5. Afterwards, signal C0 triggered by X1
cannot be received, and the current value
of C0 will remain K5.
16-30
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-31
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Special
Description of Function R/W *
M
M1045
| -- --
M1047
M1048 -- --
M1049 -- --
M1050 -- --
M1051 -- --
M1052 Lock frequency (lock, frequency locked at the current operating frequency) RW
M1053 -- --
M1054 -- --
M1055 -- --
M1056 Excitation ready (Servo On Ready) RO
M1057 -- --
M1058 On Quick Stopping RO
M1059 CANopen Master setting complete RO
M1060 CANopen Currently initializing slave station RO
M1061 CANopen Slave station initialization failure RO
M1062 -- --
M1063 -- --
M1064 -- --
M1065 Read/write CANOpen data time out RO
M1066 Read/write CANopen data complete RO
M1067 Read/write CANopen data successful RO
M1068 Calendar calculation error RO
M1069 -- --
M1070 -- --
M1071 -- --
M1072
| -- --
M1075
M1076 Calendar time error or refresh time out RO
M1077 485 Read/write complete RO
M1078 485 Read-write error RO
M1079 485 Communications time out RO
M1090 OFF (refer to parameter descriptions for Pr.00-29) RO
M1091 HAND (refer to parameter descriptions for Pr.00-29) RO
M1092 AUTO (refer to parameter descriptions for Pr.00-29) RO
M1100 LOCAL (refer to parameter descriptions for Pr.00-29) RO
M1101 REMOTE (refer to parameter descriptions for Pr.00-29) RO
M1168 SMOV BCD and BIN mode switch RW
M1260 PLC PID1 Enable RW
M1262 PLC PID1 Positive integral value limit RW
M1270 PLC PID2 Enable RW
M1272 PLC PID2 Positive integral value limit RW
16-32
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-33
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Special
Description of Function R/W *
D
D1046
| -- --
D1049
Actual Operation Mode
D1050 RO
0: Speed
D1051 -- --
D1052 -- --
D1053 -- --
D1054 -- --
D1055 -- --
D1056 -- --
D1057 -- --
D1058 -- --
D1059 -- --
Operation Mode setting
D1060 RW
0: Speed
D1061 485 COM1 communications time out time (ms) RW
D1062 Torque command (torque limit in speed mode) RW
D1063 Year (Western calendar) (display range 2000-2099) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1064 Week (display range 1-7) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1065 Month (display range 1-12) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1066 Day (display range 1-31) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1067 Hour (display range 0-23) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1068 Minute (display range 0-59) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1069 Second (display range 0-59) (must use KPC-CC01) RO
D1100 Target frequency RO
D1101 Target frequency (must be operating) RO
D1102 Reference frequency RO
D1103 -- --
D1104 -- --
D1105 -- --
D1106 -- --
D1107 π(Pi) Low word RO
D1108 π(Pi) High word RO
D1109 Random number RO
Internal node communications number (set number of slave stations to be
D1110 RW
controlled)
D1111 -- --
D1112 -- --
D1113 -- --
Numbering of the operating motors:
D1114 1: Motor 1 RO
2: Motor 2
D1115 Internal node synchronizing cycle (ms) RO
D1116 Internal node error (bit0 = Node 0, bit1 = Node 1,…bit7 = Node 7) RO
Internal node online correspondence (bit0 = Node 0, bit1 = Node 1,…bit7 = Node
D1117 RO
7)
D1118 -- --
D1119 -- --
D1120 Internal node 0 control command RW
D1121 Internal node 0 mode RW
D1122 Internal node 0 reference command L RW
D1123 Internal node 0 reference command H RW
D1124 -- --
D1125 -- --
16-34
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Special
Description of Function R/W *
D
D1126 Internal node 0 status RO
D1127 Internal node 0 reference status L RO
D1128 Internal node 0 reference status H RO
D1129 -- --
D1130 Internal node 1 control command RW
D1131 Internal node 1 mode RW
D1132 Internal node 1 reference command L RW
D1133 Internal node 1 reference command H RW
D1134 -- --
D1135 -- --
D1136 Internal node 1 status RO
D1137 Internal node 1 reference status L RO
D1138 Internal node 1 reference status H RO
D1139 -- --
D1140 Internal node 2 control command RW
D1141 Internal node 2 mode RW
D1142 Internal node 2 reference command L RW
D1143 Internal node 2 reference command H RW
D1144 -- --
D1145 -- --
D1146 Internal node 2 status RO
D1147 Internal node 2 reference status L RO
D1148 Internal node 2 reference status H RO
D1149 -- --
D1150 Internal node 3 control command RW
D1151 Internal node 3 mode RW
D1152 Internal node 3 reference command L RW
D1153 Internal node 3 reference command H RW
D1154 -- --
D1155 -- --
D1156 Internal node 3 status RO
D1157 Internal node 3 reference status L RO
D1158 Internal node 3 reference status H RO
D1159 -- --
D1160 Internal node 4 control command RW
D1161 Internal node 4 mode RW
D1162 Internal node 4 reference command L RW
D1163 Internal node 4 reference command H RW
D1164 -- --
D1165 -- --
D1166 Internal node 4 status RO
D1167 Internal node 4 reference status L RO
D1168 Internal node 4 reference status H RO
D1169 -- --
D1170 Internal node 5 control command RW
D1171 Internal node 5 mode RW
D1172 Internal node 5 reference command L RW
D1173 Internal node 5 reference command H RW
D1174 -- RW
D1175 -- --
D1176 Internal node 5 status --
D1177 Internal node 5 reference status L RO
D1178 Internal node 5 reference status H RO
D1179 -- --
D1180 Internal node 6 control command RW
16-35
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Special
Description of Function R/W *
D
D1181 Internal node 6 mode RW
D1182 Internal node 6 reference command L RW
D1183 Internal node 6 reference command H RW
D1184 -- --
D1185 -- --
D1186 Internal node 6 status RO
D1187 Internal node 6 reference status L RO
D1188 Internal node 6 reference status H RO
D1189 -- --
D1190 Internal node 7 control command RW
D1191 Internal node 7 mode RW
D1192 Internal node 7 reference command L RW
D1193 Internal node 7 reference command H RW
D1194 -- --
D1195 -- --
D1196 Internal node 7 status RO
D1197 Internal node 7 reference status L RO
D1198 Internal node 7 reference status H RO
D1199 -- --
Special
Description of Function Default R/W*
D
PID1 mode:
D1200 0 RW
0: Basic mode
PID1 target selection:
0: Refer to D1202
D1201 1: AVI1 0 RW
2: ACI
3: AVI2
D1202 PID1 target value (0.00%–100.00%) 5000 RW
PID1 feedback selection
0: Refer to D1204
D1203 1: AVI1 1 RW
2: ACI
3: AVI2
D1204 PID1 feedback value (0.00%–100.00%) 0 RW
D1205 PID1 P value (decimal point 2) 10 RW
D1206 PID1 I value (decimal point 2) 1000 RW
D1207 PID1 D value (decimal point 2) 0 RW
D1209 Max. limit of PID1 10000 RW
D1215 Counting value of PID1 (decimal point 2) 0 RO
PID2 mode:
D1220 0 RW
0: Basic mode
PID2 target selection:
0: Refer to D1202
D1221 1: AVI1 0 RW
2: ACI
3: AVI2
D1222 PID2 target value (0.00%–100.00%) 5000 RW
PID2 feedback selection
0: Refer to D1204
D1223 1: AVI1 1 RW
2: ACI
3: AVI2
D1224 PID2 feedback value (0.00%–100.00%) 0 RW
16-36
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Special
Description of Function Default R/W*
D
D1225 PID1 P value (decimal point 2) 10 RW
D1226 PID2 I value (decimal point 2) 1000 RW
D1227 PID2 D value (decimal point 2) 0 RW
D1229 Max. limit of PID2 10000 RW
D1235 Counting value of PID2 (decimal point 2) 0 RO
The following is CANopen Master's special D (can be written in only with PLC in Stop state)
※ CP2000 does not have torque and position mode. As CANopen master, however, CP2000 can
issue torque and position commands to CANopen slaves.
n=0–7
Power
PDO
Special D Description of Function off Default: R/W
Map
Memory
Channel opened by CANopen initialization
D1070 NO NO 0 R
(bit0=Machine code0 …….)
Error channel occurring in CANopen initialization
D1071 NO NO 0 R
process (bit0=Machine code0 …….)
D1072 Reserved - - -
D1073 CANopen break channel (bit0=Machine code0 …….) NO NO R
Error code of master error
0: No error
D1074 NO NO 0 R
1: Slave station setting error
2: Synchronizing cycle setting error (too small)
D1075 Reserved - - -
D1076 SDO error message (main index value) NO NO R
D1077 SDO error message (secondary index value) NO NO R
D1078 SDO error message (error code) NO NO R
D1079 SDO error message (error code) NO NO R
D1080 Reserved - - -
D1081 -
| Reserved - -
D1086
D1087
| Reserved - - -
D1089
D1090 Synchronizing cycle setting NO YES 4 RW
Sets slave station On or Off (bit0–bit7 correspond to
D1091 NO YES FFFFH RW
slave stations number 0–7)
D1092 Delay before start of initialization NO YES 0 RW
D1093 Break time detection NO YES 1000ms RW
D1094 Break number detection NO YES 3 RW
D1095
| Reserved - - -
D1096
16-37
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Power
PDO
Special D Description of Function off Default: R/W
Map
Memory
Corresponding real-time transmission type (PDO)
D1097 NO YES 1 RW
Setting range: 1–240
Corresponding real-time receiving type (PDO)
D1098 NO YES 1 RW
Setting range: 1–240
Initialization completion delay time
D1099 NO YES 15 sec. RW
Setting range: 1 to 60000 sec
Station number n of slave station
D2000+100*n Setting range: 0–127 NO YES 0 RW
0: No CANopen function
The CP2000 supports 8 slave stations under the CANopen protocol; each slave station
occupies 100 special D locations; stations are numbered 1–8, total of 8 stations.
Explanation of Slave station no. 1 D2000 Node ID
slave station D2001 Slave station no. 1 torque restrictions
number | |
D2099 Address 4(H) corresponding to receiving
channel 4
Slave station no. 2 D2100 Node ID
D2101 Slave station no. 2 torque restrictions
| |
D2199 Address 4(H) corresponding to receiving
channel 4
Slave station no. 3 D2200 Node ID
D2201 Slave station no. 3 torque restrictions
| |
D2299 Address 4(H) corresponding to receiving
channel 4
Slave station no. 8 D2700 Node ID
D2701 Slave station no. 8 torque restrictions
| |
D2799 Address 4(H) corresponding to receiving
channel 4
2. ●Indicates PDOTX, ▲Indicates PDORX; unmarked special D can be refreshed using the
CANFLS command
16-38
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Basic definitions
CAN PDO Default:
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
Index 1 2 3 4
Communications break handling method of
D2006+100*n 0 6007H-0010H RW
slave station number n
D2007+100*n Error code of slave station number n error 0 603FH-0010H R
D2008+100*n Control word of slave station number n 0 6040H-0010H ● ● ● RW
D2009+100*n Status word of slave station number n 0 6041H-0010H ▲ ▲ ▲ R
D2010+100*n Control mode of slave station number n 2 6060H-0008H RW
D2011+100*n Actual mode of slave station number n 2 6061H-0008H R
Velocity Control
Slave station number n=0–7
CAN PDO Default:
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
Index 1 2 3 4
D2001+100*n Torque restriction on slave station number n 0 6072H-0010H RW
D2012+100*n Target speed of slave station number n 0 6042H-0010H ● RW
D2013+100*n Actual speed of slave station number n 0 6043H-0010H ▲ R
D2014+100*n Error speed of slave station number n 0 6044H-0010H R
D2015+100*n Acceleration time of slave station number n 1000 604FH-0020H R
D2016+100*n Deceleration time of slave station number n 1000 6050H-0020H RW
20XXH correspondences: MI / MO / AI / AO
Slave station number n=0–7
CAN PDO Default:
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
Index 1 2 3 4
D2026+100*n MI status of slave station number n 0 2026H-0110H ▲ RW
D2027+100*n MO setting of slave station number n 0 2026H-4110H ● RW
D2028+100*n AI1 status of slave station number n 0 2026H-6110H ▲ RW
D2029+100*n AI2 status of slave station number n 0 2026H-6210H ▲ RW
D2030+100*n AI3 status of slave station number n 0 2026H-6310H ▲ RW
D2031+100*n AO1 status of slave station number n 0 2026H-A110H ● RW
D2032+100*n AO2 status of slave station number n 0 2026H-A210H ● RW
D2033+100*n AO3 status of slave station number n 0 2026H-A310H ● RW
16-39
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
NOTE
When PLC functions have been activated, the CP2000 can match PLC and driver parameters; this method employs
different addresses, drivers (default station number is 1, PLC sets station number as 2)
16-40
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Output command
Command Execution
Function OPERAND
code speed (us)
OUT Drive coil Y、M 1
SET Action continues (ON) Y、M 1
RST Clear contact or register Y、M、T、C、D 1.2
Timer, counter
Command Execution
Function OPERAND
code speed (us)
TMR 16-bit timer T-K or T-D commands 1.1
CNT 16-bit counter C-K or C-D (16-bit) 0.5
16-41
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Stop command
Command Execution
Function OPERAND
code speed (us)
END Program conclusion N/A 0.2
Other commands
Command Execution
Function OPERAND
code speed (us)
NOP No action N/A 0.2
INV Inverse of operation results N/A 0.2
P Index P 0.3
Command Function
LDI Load contact b
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The LDI command is used for contact b starting at the left busbar or contact b starting
at a contact circuit block; its function is to save current content and save the acquired
contact status in the cumulative register.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 X1
Y1 LDI X0 Load Contact b of X0
Create series
AND X1 connection to contact a
of X1
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
16-42
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
AND Connect contact a in series
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The AND command is used to create a series connection to contact a; first reads
current status of the designated series contact and logical operation results before
contact in order to perform "AND" operation; saves results in cumulative register.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X1 X0 LDI X1 Load Contact b of X1
Y1 Create series
AND X0 connection to contact a
of X0
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
ANI Connect contact b in series
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The ANI command is used to create a series connection to contact b; its function is to
first read current status of the designated series contact and logical operation results
before contact in order to perform "AND" operation; saves results in cumulative
register.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X1 X0
Y1 LD X1 Load Contact a of X1
Create series
ANI X0 connection to contact b
of X0
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
OR Connect contact a in parallel
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The OR command is used to establish a parallel connection to contact a; its function is
to first read current status of the designated series contact and logical operation
results before contact in order to perform "OR" operation; saves results in cumulative
register.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
Y1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
X1 Create series
OR X1 connection to contact a
of X1
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
16-43
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
ORI Connect contact b in parallel
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The ORI command is used to establish a parallel connection to contact b; its function
is to first read current status of the designated series contact and logical operation
results before contact in order to perform "OR" operation; saves results in cumulative
register.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
Y1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
X1 Create series
ORI X1 connection to contact b
of X1
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
ANB Series circuit block
Operand N/A
ANB performs an "AND" operation on the previous saved logic results and the current
cumulative register content.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 X1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
ANB
Y1 Establish parallel
ORI X2 connection to contact b
X2 X3 of X2
LDI X1 Load Contact b of X1
Block A Block B Establish parallel
OR X3 connection to contact a
of X3
ANB Series circuit block
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
ORB Parallel circuit block
Operand N/A
ORB performs an "OR" operation on the previous saved logic results and the current
cumulative register content.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 X1 Block A LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
Y1 Establish parallel
ANI X1 connection to contact b
X2 X3 of X1
ORB
LDI X2 Load Contact b of X2
Block B Establish parallel
AND X3 connection to contact a
of X3
ORB Parallel circuit block
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
16-44
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
MPS Save to stack
Operand N/A
Save current content of cumulative register to the stack. (Add one to stack pointer)
Command Function
MRD Read stack (pointer does not change)
Operand N/A
Reads stack content and saves to cumulative register. (Stack pointer does not
change)
Command Function
MPP Read stack
Operand N/A
Retrieves result of previously-save logical operation from the stack, and saves to
cumulative register. (Subtract one from stack pointer)
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
MPS LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
X0 X1 MPS Save to stack
Y1 Create series connection
AND X1
to contact a of X1
X2 OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
MRD M0 Read stack (pointer does
MRD
not change)
Y2 Create series connection
AND X2
to contact a of X2
MPP
OUT M0 Drive M0 coil
END MPP Read stack
OUT Y2 Drive Y2 coil
END Program conclusion
Command Function
OUT Drive coil
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
- - - -
Outputs result of logical operation before OUT command to the designated element.
Coil contact action:
Out command
Result: Access Point:
Coil
Contact a (N.O.) Contact b (N.C.)
FALSE Off Not conducting Conducting
TRUE On Conducting Not conducting
16-45
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
SET Action continues (ON)
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
- - - -
When the SET command is driven, the designated element will be set as On, and will
be maintained in an On state, regardless of whether the SET command is still driven.
The RST command can be used to set the element as Off.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 Y0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
SET Y1 Establish parallel
ANI Y0 connection to contact b
of Y0
SET Y1 Action continues (ON)
Command Function
RST Clear contact or register
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
When the RST command is driven, the action of the designated element will be as
follows:
Element Mode
Y, M Both coil and contact will be set as Off.
The current timing or count value will be set as 0, and both the coil
T, C
and contact will be set as Off.
D The content value will be set as 0.
If the RST command has not been executed, the status of the designated element will
remain unchanged.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
RST Y5 Clear contact or
RST Y5
register
Command Function
TMR 16-bit timer
T-K T0–T159, K0–K32,767
Operand
T-D T0–T159, D0–D399
When the TMR command is executed, the designated timer coil will be electrified, and
the timer will begin timing. The contact's action will be as follows when the timing
value reaches the designated set value (timing value >= set value):
NO (Normally Open) contact Closed
NC (Normally Close) contact Open
If the RST command has not been executed, the status of the designated element will
remain unchanged.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
TMR T5 K1000 T5 timer
TMR T5 K1000
Set value as K1000
16-46
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
CNT 16-bit counter
C-K C0–C79, K0–K32,767
Operand
C-D C0–C79, D0–D399
When the CNT command is executed from OFF→ON, this indicates that the
designated counter coil goes from no power → electrified, and 1 will be added to the
counter's count value; when the count reaches the designated value (count value =
set value), the contact will have the following action:
N.O. (Normally Open) contact Closed
N.C. (Normally Close) contact Open
After the count value has been reached, the contact and count value will both remain
unchanged even if there is continued count pulse input. Please use the RST
command if you wish to restart or clear the count.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
CNT C2 K100 C2counter
CNT C2 K100
Set value as K100
16-47
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
MC/MCR Connect/release a common series contact
Operand N0–N7
MC is the main control initiation command, and any commands between MC and
MCR will be executed normally. When the MC command is OFF, any commands
between MC and MCR will act as follows:
Determination of commands Description
The timing value will revert to 0, the coil will lose
Ordinary timer
power, and the contact will not operate
The coil will lose power, and the count value and
Counter
contact will stay in their current state
Coil driven by OUT command None receive power
Elements driven by SET, RST
Will remain in their current state
commands
Applications commands None are actuated
MCR is the main control stop command, and is placed at the end of the main control
program. There may not be any contact commands before the MCR command.
The MC-MCR main control program commands support a nested program structure
with a maximum only 8 levels; use in the order N0-N7, please refer to the following
program:
Command Description:
Ladder diagram: code:
X0
MC N0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
Connection of N0 common series
X1 MC N0
contact
Y0
LD X1 Load Contact a of X1
X2 OUT Y0 Drive Y0 coil
MC N1 :
X3 LD X2 Load Contact a of X2
Y1 Connection of N1 common series
MC N1
contact
MCR N1 LD X3 Load Contact a of X3
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
MCR N0 :
MCR N1 Release N1 common series contact
X10
:
MC N0
MCR N0 Release N0 common series contact
X11 :
Y10
LD X10 Load Contact a of X10
Connection of N0 common series
MC N0
MCR N0 contact
LD X11 Load Contact a of X11
OUT Y10 Drive Y10 coil
:
MCR N0 Release N0 common series contact
16-48
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
LDP Start of forward edge detection action
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The LDP command has the same usage as LD, but its action is different; its function is
to save current content, while also saving the detected state of the rising edge of the
contact to the cumulative register.
Command Description:
Ladder diagram: code:
X0 X1
Y1 Start of X0 forward edge detection
LDP X0
action
Create series connection to
AND X1
contact a of X1
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in series for the scope
of usage of each operand.
A rising edge contact will be TRUE after power is turned on if the rising edge contact is
On before power is turned on to the PLC.
Command Function
LDF Start of reverse edge detection action
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The LDF command has the same usage as LD, but its action is different; its function is
to save current content while also saving the detected state of the falling edge of the
contact to the cumulative register.
Command code: Description:
Ladder diagram:
X0 X1 Start of X0 reverse
LDF X0
Y1 edge detection action
Create series
AND X1 connection to contact a
of X1
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
ANDP Forward edge detection series connection
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The ANDP command used for a contact rising edge detection series connection.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 X1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
Y1 X1 Forward edge
ANDP X1 detection series
connection
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
16-49
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
ANDF Reverse edge detection series connection
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The ANDF command is used for a contact falling edge detection series connection.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0 X1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
Y1 X1 Reverse edge
ANDF X1 detection series
connection
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
ORP Forward edge detection parallel connection
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The ORP command is used for a contact rising edge detection parallel connection.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
Y1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
X1 X1 Forward edge
ORP X1 detection parallel
connection
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
ORF Reverse edge detection parallel connection
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
-
The ORF command is used for contact falling edge detection parallel connection.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
Y1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
X1 Reverse edge
X1
ORF X1 detection parallel
connection
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
16-50
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
PLS Upper differential output
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
- - - -
Upper differential output commands. When X0=OFF→ON (positive edge-triggered),
the PLS command will be executed, and M0 will send one pulse, with a pulse length
consisting of one scanning period.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
PLS M0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
M0 M0 Upper differential
PLS M0
SET Y0 output
Time sequence diagram: LD M0 Load Contact a of M0
X0 Y0 Action continues
SET Y0
(ON)
M0 Time for one scan cycle
Y0
Command Function
PLF Lower differential output
X0–X17 Y0–Y17 M0–M799 T0–159 C0–C79 D0–D399
Operand
- - - -
Lower differential output command. When X0= On→Off (negative edge-triggered), the
PLF command will be executed, and M0 will send one pulse, with pulse length
consisting of one scanning period.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
PLF M0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
M0 M0 Lower differential
PLF M0
SET Y0 output
Time sequence diagram: LD M0 Load Contact a of M0
X0 Y0 Action continues
SET Y0
(ON)
M0 Time for one scan cycle
Y0
Command Function
END Program conclusion
Operand N/A
An END command must be added to the end of a ladder diagram program or
command program. The PLC will scan from address 0 to the END command, and will
return to address 0 and begins scanning again after execution.
16-51
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Command Function
NOP No action
Operand N/A
The command NOP does not perform any operation in the program. Because
execution of this command will retain the original logical operation results, it can be
used in the following situation: the NOP command can be used to replace a command
that is deleted without changing the program length.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
NOP command will be simplified and not
displayed when the ladder diagram is LD X0 Load Contact b of X0
displayed.
NOP No action
X0
NOP Y1 OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
INV Inverse of operation results
Operand N/A
Saves the result of the logic inversion operation prior to the INV command in the
cumulative register.
Ladder diagram: Command code: Description:
X0
Y1 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
Inverse of operation
INV
results
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
Command Function
P Index
Operand P0–P255
Pointer P is used to subprogram call command API 01 CALL. Use does not require
starting from zero, but the number cannot be used repeatedly, otherwise an
unpredictable error will occur.
Command code: Description:
Ladder diagram:
X0 LD X0 Load Contact a of X0
CALL P10 CALL P10 Call command CALL to
P10
X1
P10 Y1 :
P10 Pointer P10
LD X1 Load Contact a of X1
OUT Y1 Drive Y1 coil
16-52
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-53
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-54
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-55
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
SRET - Conclusion of subprogram
02 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (1 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D Continuous
FEND - -
execution type
16-56
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
FEND - Conclusion a main program
06
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (1 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D Continuous
FEND - -
execution type
This command indicates the end of the main program. It is the same as
the END command when the PLC executes this command.
The CALL command program must be written after the FEND command,
and the SRET command added to the end of the subprogram.
When using the FEND command, an END command is also needed.
However, the END command must be placed at the end, after the main
program and subprogram.
16-57
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
CMP S1 S2 D Compares set output
10 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D CMP Continuous CMPP Pulse
S1 * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * * DCMP Continuous DCMPP Pulse
execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
The operand D occupies three consecutive points Flag signal: none
Y2
If K10<D10, Y2= On
RST M1
RST M2
16-58
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ZCP S1 S2 S D Range comparison
11 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ZCP Continuous ZCPP Pulse
S1 * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
32-bit command (17 STEP)
S * * * * * * * * DZCP Continuous DZCPP Pulse
D * * execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
The content value of operand S1 is less than the content value of Flag signal: none
S2 operand
The operand D occupies three consecutive points
When the comparative value S is compared with the lower limit S1 and
upper limitS2 , the results of comparison are expressed in D .
When lower limit S1 > upper limit S2 , the command will use the lower limit
S1 to perform comparison with the upper and lower limit.
Size comparison is performed algebraically. All data is compared in the form of
numerical binary values. Because this is a 16-bit command, when b15 is 1, this
indicates a negative number.
When the designated device is M0, it automatically occupies M0, M1 and M2.
When X0=On, the ZCP command executes, and M0, M1 or M2 will be On. When
X0=Off, the ZCP command will not execute, and the state of M0, M1 or M2 will
remain in the state prior to X0=Off.
If ≥, ≤, or ≠ results are needed, they can be obtained via series/parallel
connections of M0-M2.
X0
ZCP K10 K100 C10 M0
M0
If C10 < K10, M0 = On
M1
If K10 =
< C10 =
< K100, M1 = On
M2
If C10 > K100, M2 = On
To clear results of comparison, use the RST or ZRST command.
X0 X0
RST M0 ZRST M0 M2
RST M1
RST M2
16-59
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
MOV S D Data movement
12 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D MOV Continuous MOVP Pulse
S * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
D * * * * *
32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: none
DMOV Continuous DMOVP Pulse
execution type execution type
Flag signal:
16-60
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API n
SMOV S m1 m2 D Nibble movement
13 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (11 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D MOV Continuous SMOVP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * * * *
S : Data source. m1
: The data source transfers starting bit number.
m2
:The data source transfers individual bit number. D : Transfer destination.
n
Transferring starting bit number of the destination.
BCD mode (M1168 = Off):
SMOV enables and operates BCD under this mode, the operation is similar to the
way SMOV operates decimal numbers. The command copies specific bit number
of arithmetic element S (S is a 4-figure decimal number), and sends the bit
number to arithmetic element D (D is also a 4-figure decimal number). The current
data on the target register will be covered.
m1 range: 1–4
m2 range: 1–m1 (m2 cannot be larger than m1)
n range: m2–4 (n cannot be smaller than m2)
When M1168 = Off (BCD mode), X0 is ON, the instruction transfers two digits of
the decimal number starting from the fourth digit of the decimal number (the digit
in the thousands place of the decimal number) in D10 to the two digits of the
decimal number starting from the third digit of the decimal number (the digit in the
hundreds place of the decimal number) in D20. After the instruction is executed,
the digits in the thousands place of the decimal number (103) and the ones place
of the decimal number (100) in D20 are unchanged.
16-61
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
When M1168 is On (BIN mode), and the SMOV command is executed, D10 and
D20 do not change in BCD mode, but send 4 digits as a unit in BIN mode.
16-62
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
BMOV S D n Send all
15 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D BMOV Continuous BMOVP Pulse
S * * * * * * execution type execution type
D * * * * *
n * * * * 32-bit command
Notes on operand usage: - - - -
n operand scope n = 1 to 512
Flag signal: none
If the designated bit devices KnX, KnY, and KnM are sent, S and D must
have the same number of nibbles, which implies that n must be identical.
16-63
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
BCD S D BIN to BCD transformation
18 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D BCD Continuous BCDP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * *
Arithmetic elements S and D use the F device, it can only use 16-bit command.
When X0 is ON, and the BIN value of D10 is transformed to BCD value, the digit is
saved in 4-bit element of K1Y0 (Y0–Y3).
X0
BCD D10 K1Y0
If D10 = 001E (Hex) = 0030 (Decimal), the executed result will be Y0–Y3=0000
(BIN).
16-64
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
BIN S D BCD to BIN transformation
19 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D BIN Continuous BINP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * *
When PLC reads a BCD type switch-off from the outside, it has to use the BIN
command to transform the read data to BIN value, then saves the value into PLC.
16-65
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ADD S1 S2 D BIN addition
20 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ADD Continuous ADDP Pulse
S1 * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * * * * * DADD Continuous DADDP Pulse
Notes on operand usage: none execution type execution type
Using two data sources: The result of adding S1 and S2 using the BIN
method will be stored in D .
The highest bit of any data is symbolized as bit 0 indicating (positive) 1 indicating
(negative), enabling the use of algebraic addition operations. (for instance:
3+(-9)=-6)
Flag changes connected with the addition.
1. When calculation results are 0, the zero flag M1020 will be On.
2. When calculation results are less than –32,768, the borrow flag M1021 will be
On.
3. When calculation results are greater than 32,767, the carry flag M1022 will be
On.
16-bit BIN addition: When X0=On, the result of the content of addend D0 plus the
content of augend D10 will exist in the content of D20.
X0
ADD D0 D10 D20
16-66
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
SUB S1 S2 D BIN subtraction
21 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D SUB Continuous SUBP Pulse
S1 * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * * * * * Continuous Pulse
Notes on operand usage: none DSUB DSUBP
execution type execution type
Using two data sources: The result of subtraction of S1 and S2 using the
BIN method is stored in D .
The highest bit of any data is symbolized as bit 0 indicating (positive) 1 indicating
(negative), enabling the use of algebraic subtraction operations.
Flag changes connected with subtraction.
1. When calculation results are 0, the zero flag M1020 will be On.
2. When calculation results are less than –32,768, the borrow flag M1021 will be
On.
3. When calculation results are greater than 32,767, the carry flag M1022 will be
On.
16-bit BIN subtraction: When X0=On, the content of D10 is subtracted from the
content of D0, and the difference is stored in D20.
X0
SUB D0 D10 D20
16-67
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
MUL S1 S2 D BIN multiplication
22 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D MUL Continuous MULP Pulse
S1 * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * * * * * DMUL Continuous DMULP Pulse
Notes on operand usage: execution type execution type
The 16-bit command operand D will occupy 2 consecutive points
Flag signal: none
Using two data sources: When S1 and S2 are multiplied using the BIN
method, the product is stored in D .
16-bit BIN multiplication operation:
16-68
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
DIV S1 S2 D BIN division
23 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D DIV Continuous DIVP Pulse
S1 * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * * * * * DDIV Continuous DDIVP Pulse
Notes on operand usage: execution type execution type
The 16-bit command operand D will occupy 2 consecutive points
Flag signal: none
Using two data sources: The quotient and remainder will be stored in D when
S1 and S2 are subjected to division using the BIN method. The sign bit for
S1 , S2 and D must be kept in mind when performing a 16-bit operation.
16-bit BIN division:
16-69
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
INC D BIN add one
24 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (3 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D INC Continuous INCP Pulse
D * * * * * execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage: none
32-bit command (5 STEP)
DINC Continuous DINCP Pulse
execution type execution type
D : Destination device.
If a command is not the pulse execution type, when the command is executed, the
program will add 1 to the content of device D for each scanning cycle.
This command is ordinarily used as a pulse execution type command (INCP).
During 16-bit operation, 32,767 +1 will change the value to -32,768. During 32 bit
operation, 2,147,483,647 +1 will change the value to -2,147,483,648.
When X0=Off→On, 1 is automatically added to the content of D0.
X0
INCP D0
16-70
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
DEC D BIN subtract one
25 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (3 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D DEC Continuous DECP Pulse
D * * execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage: none
32-bit command (5 STEP)
DDEC Continuous DDECP Pulse
execution type execution type
D : Destination device.
If a command is not the pulse execution type, when the command is executed, the
program will add 1 to the content of device D for each scanning cycle.
This command is ordinarily used as a pulse execution type command (DECP).
During 16-bit operation, -32,768 -1 will change the value to 32,767. During 32 bit
operation, -2,147,483,648 -1 will change the value to 2,147,483,647.
When X0=Off→On, 1 is automatically subtracted from the content of D0.
X0
DECP D0
16-71
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ROR D n Right rotation
30 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ROR Continuous RORP Pulse
D * * * * * execution type execution type
n * *
32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DROR Continuous DRORP Pulse
Only K4 (16-bit) will be valid if the operand D is designated as KnY execution type execution type
or KnM.
n operand n=K1-K16 (16-bit) Flag signal: M1022 Carry flag
16-72
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ROL D n Left rotation
31 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ROL Continuous ROLP Pulse
D * * * * * execution type execution type
n * *
32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage:
DROL Continuous DROLP Pulse
Only K4 (16-bit) will be valid if the operand D is designated as KnY
execution type execution type
or KnM.
n operand n=1 to 16 (16-bit) Flag signal: M1022 Carry flag
16-73
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ZRST D1 D2 Clear range
40 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ZRST Continuous ZRSTP Pulse
D1 * * * * * execution type execution type
D2 * * * * *
Notes on operand usage: 32-bit command
Number of operand D1 operand ≤ number of operand D2 - - - -
Operands D1, D2 must designate the same type of device
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
D1: Clear range's initial device. D2: Clear range's final device.
When the number of operand D1 > number of operand D2, only the operand
designated by D2 will be cleared.
When X0 is On, auxiliary relays M300–M399 will be cleared and changed to Off.
When X1 is On, 16-bit counters C0–C127 will all be cleared. (Writes 0, and clears
and changes contact and coil to Off).
When X10 is On, timer T0–T127 will all be cleared. (Writes 0, and clears and
changes contact and coil to Off).
When X3 is On, the data in data registers D0–D100 will be cleared and set as 0.
X0
ZRST M300 M399
X1
ZRST C0 C127
X10
ZRST T0 T127
X3
ZRST D0 D100
Devices can independently use the clear command (RST), such as bit device Y, M
and word device T, C, D.
X0
RST M0
RST T0
RST Y0
16-74
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
DECO S D n Decoder
41 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D DECO Continuous DECOP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * * * *
X2 X1 X0
0 1 1
4 2 1
3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
M107 M106 M105 M104 M103 M102 M101 M100
When D is word device, the valid range of n is 0< n ≦4. If n = 0 or n > 4, the fault
occurs.
When n = 4, the maximum decoding will be 24 = 16 points.
When M200 switches from Off to On, the content of D10 (b2–b0) is decoded to
D20 (b7–b0). The unused digits (b15–b8) of D20 become 0.
The lower 3 digits of D10 are decoded and saved in the lower 8 digits of D20, the
upper 8 digits are 0.
When the command is executed, M200 turns to Off. The ones that are decoded
and outputted act as usual.
M200
DE COP D10 D20 K3
16-75
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ENCO S D n Encoder
42 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ENCO Continuous ENCOP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * *
When S is word device, the valid range of n is 0< n ≦4. If n = 0 or n > 4, the fault
occurs.
When n = 4, the maximum decoding will be 24 = 16 points.
When X0 switches from Off to On, 23 digit data of D10 (b0–b7) is encoded and
saved in the lower 3 digits (b2–b0) of D20. The unused digits (b15–b3) of D20
become 0. (b8–b15 in D10 are invalid data)
When the command is executed, X0 turns to Off. The data in D is unchanged.
M200
DE COP D10 D20 K3
16-76
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
SUM ON bit number
43 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D SUM Continuous SUMP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * * * *
0 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 3
D0 D2
16-77
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
BON S D n ON bit judgement
44 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D BON Continuous BONP Pulse
execution type execution type
S * * * * * * * *
b15 b0
0 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 M0=Off
D0
b15 b0
1 0 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 M0=On
D0
16-78
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-79
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ECMP Comparison of binary floating point numbers
110 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S1 * * *
S2 * * * 32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * DECMP Continuous DECMP Pulse
Notes on operand usage: execution type P execution type
The operand D occupies three consecutive points
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
S1: Comparison of binary floating point numbers value 1. S2: Comparison of
binary floating point numbers value 2. D: Results of comparison, occupies 3
consecutive points.
When binary floating point number 1 is compared with comparative binary
floating point number 2, the result of comparison (>, =, <) will be expressed in D.
If the source operand S1 or S2 designates a constant K or H, the command will
transform the constant to a binary floating-point number for the purpose of
comparison.
When the designated device is M10, it will automatically occupy M10~M12.
When X0=On, the DECMP command executes, and one of M10~M12 will be On.
When X0=Off, the DECMP command will not execute, and M10~M12 will remain
in the X0=Off state.
If results in the form of ≥, ≤, or ≠ are needed, they can be obtained by series and
parallel connection of M10-M12.
Please use the RST or ZRST command to clear the result.
16-80
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
EZCP Comparison of binary floating point number range
111 D P
Bit device Word device
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D 16-bit command
S1 * * * - - - -
S2 * * *
32-bit command (17 STEP)
S * * *
DEZCP Continuous DEZCP Pulse
D * * execution type P execution type
Notes on operand usage:
The operand D occupies three consecutive points Flag signal: none
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
series for the scope of device usage
S1: Lower limit of binary floating point number in range comparison. S2: Upper
limit of binary floating point number in range comparison. S: Comparison of
binary floating point numerical values. D: Results of comparison, occupies 3
consecutive points.
Comparison of binary floating point numerical value S with binary floating point
number lower limit value S1 and binary floating point number upper limit value S2;
the results of comparison are expressed in D.
If the source operand S1 or S2 designates a constant K or H, the command will
transform the constant to a binary floating-point number for the purpose of
comparison.
When the lower limit binary floating point number S1 is greater than the upper
limit binary floating point number S2, a command will be issued to perform
comparison with the upper and lower limits using the binary floating point number
lower limit value S1.
When the designated device is M0, it will automatically occupy M0~ M2.
When X0=On, the DEZCP command will be executed, and one of M0~M2 will be
On. When X0=Off, the EZCP command will not execute, and M0~M2 will
continue in the X0=Off state.
Please use the RST or ZRST command to clear the result.
16-81
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
RAD Angle → Radian
116 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DRAD Continuous DRADP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
When X0=On, the angle of the designated binary floating point number (D1, D0)
will be converted to radians and stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting
of a binary floating point number.
X0
DRAD D0 D10
16-82
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
DEG Radian → Angle
117 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DDEG Continuous DDEGP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
When X0=On, angle of the designated binary floating point number (D1, D0) in
radians will be converted to an angle and stored in (D11, D10), with the content
consisting of a binary floating point number.
X0
DDEG D0 D10
16-83
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
EADD Adding binary floating point numbers
120 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S1 * * *
S2 * * * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
D * DEADD Continuous DEADDP Pulse
execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
S1: augend. S2: addend. D: sum.
When the content of the register designated by S2 is added to the content of the
register designated by S1, and the result is stored in the register designated by D.
Addition is performed entirely using binary floating-point numbers.
If the source operand S1 or S2 designates a constant K or H, the command will
transform that constant into a binary floating point number for use in addition.
In the situation when S1 and S2 designate identical register numbers, if a
"continuous execution" command is employed, when conditional contact is On,
the register will perform addition once during each scan. Pulse execution type
commands (DEADDP) are generally used under ordinary circumstances.
When X0=On, a binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be added to a binary
floating point number (D3, D2), and the results stored in (D11, D10).
X0
DEADD D0 D2 D10
When X2 =On, a binary floating point number (D11, D10) will be added to K1234
(which has been automatically converted to a binary floating-point number), and
the results stored in (D21, D20).
X2
DEADD D10 K1234 D20
16-84
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ESUB Subtraction of binary floating point numbers
121 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S1 * * *
S2 * * * 32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * DESUB Continuous DESUBP Pulse
execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
S1: minuend. S2: subtrahend. D: difference.
When the content of the register designated by S2 is subtracted from the content
of the register designated by S1, the difference will be stored in the register
designated by D; subtraction is performed entirely using binary floating-point
numbers.
If the source operand S1 or S2 designates a constant K or H, the command will
transform that constant into a binary floating point number for use in subtraction.
In the situation when S1 and S2 designate identical register numbers, if a
"continuous execution" command is employed, when conditional contact is On,
the register will perform addition once during each scan. Pulse execution type
commands (DESUBP) are generally used under ordinary circumstances.
When X0=On, a binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be subtracted to a
binary floating point number (D3, D2), and the results stored in (D11, D10).
X0
DESUB D0 D2 D10
When X2 =On, the binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be subtracted from
K1234 (which has been automatically converted to a binary floating-point
number), and the results stored in (D11, D10).
X2
DESUB K1234 D0 D10
16-85
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
EMUL Multiplication of binary floating point numbers
122 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S1 * * *
S2 * * * 32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * DEMUL Continuous DEMULP Pulse
execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
S1: multiplicand. S2: multiplier. D: product.
When the content of the register designated by S1 is multiplied by the content of
the register designated by S2, the product will be stored in the register
designated by D; multiplication is performed entirely using binary floating-point
numbers.
If the source operand S1 or S2 designates a constant K or H, the command will
transform that constant into a binary floating point number for use in
multiplication.
In the situation when S1 and S2 designate identical register numbers, if a
"continuous execution" command is employed, when conditional contact is On,
the register will perform multiplication once during each scan. Pulse execution
type commands (DEMULP) are generally used under ordinary circumstances.
When X1=On, the binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be multiplied by the
binary floating point number (D11, D10), and the product will be stored in the
register designated by (D21, D20).
X1
DEMUL D0 D10 D20
When X2 =On, the binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be multiplied from
K1234 (which has been automatically converted to a binary floating-point
number), and the results stored in (D11, D10).
X2
DEMUL K1234 D0 D10
16-86
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
EDIV Division of binary floating point numbers
123 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S1 * * *
S2 * * * 32-bit command (13 STEP)
D * DEDIV Continuous DEDIVP Pulse
execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
S1: dividend. S2: divisor. D: quotient and remainder.
When the content of the register designated by S1 is divided by the content of the
register designated by S2, the quotient will be stored in the register designated
by D; division is performed entirely using binary floating-point numbers.
If the source operand S1 or S2 designates a constant K or H, the command will
transform that constant into a binary floating point number for use in division.
When X1=On, the binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be divided by the
binary floating point number (D11, D10), and the quotient stored in the register
designated by (D21, D20).
X1
DEDIV D0 D10 D20
When X2 =On, the binary floating point number (D1, D0) will be divided by
K1,234 (which has been automatically converted to a binary floating-point
number), and the results stored in (D11, D10).
X2
DEDIV D0 K1234 D10
16-87
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
EXP Binary floating point number obtain exponent
124 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DEXP Continuous DEXPP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
Valid regardless of whether the content of S has a positive or negative value. The
designated register D must have a 32-bit data format. This operation is
performed using floating-point numbers, and S must therefore be converted to a
floating point number.
Content of operand D =e S ; e=2.71828, S is the designated source data
When M0 is On, the value of (D1, D0) will be converted to a binary floating point
number, which will be stored in register (D11, D10).
When M1 is On, the EXP operation is performed on the exponent of (D11, D10);
its value is a binary floating point number stored in register (D21, D20).
M0
DFLT D0 D10
M1
DEXP D10 D20
16-88
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
LN Binary floating point number obtain logarithm
125 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DLN Continuous DLNP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
Valid regardless of whether the content of S has a positive or negative value. The
designated register D must have a 32-bit data format. This operation is performed
using floating-point numbers, and S must therefore be converted to a floating
point number.
Content of operand D =e S ; e=2.71828, S is the designated source data
When M0 is On, the value of (D1, D0) will be converted to a binary floating point
number, which will be stored in register (D11, D10).
When M1 is On, the EXP operation is performed on the exponent of (D11, D10);
its value is a binary floating point number stored in register (D21, D20).
M0
DFLT D0 D10
M1
DLN D10 D20
16-89
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ESQR Binary floating point number find square root
127 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DESQR Continuous DESQR Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type P execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: source device for which square root is desired D: result of finding square root.
When the square root is taken of the content of the register designated by S, the
result is temporarily stored in the register designated by D. Taking square roots
is performed entirely using binary floating-point numbers.
If the source operand S refers to a constant K or H, the command will transform
that constant into a binary floating point number for use in the operation.
When X0=On, the square root is taken of the binary floating point number (D1,
D0), and the result is stored in the register designated by (D11, D10).
X0
DESQR D0 D10
When X2 =On, the square root is taken of K1,234 (which has been automatically
converted to a binary floating-point number), and the results stored in (D11,
D10).
X2
DESQR K1234 D10
16-90
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
When X0=On, the binary floating point number (D1, D0) is transformed into a
BIN whole number, and the result is stored in (D10); the BIN whole number
floating point number will be discarded.
X0
DINT D0 D10
16-91
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
SIN Binary floating point number SIN operation
130 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DSIN Continuous DSINP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in series execution type execution type
for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
When X0=On, the SIN value of the designated binary floating point number (D1,
D0) in radians (RAD) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DSIN D0 D10
16-92
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
COS Binary floating point number COS operation
131 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DCOS Continuous DCOSP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
When X0=On, the COS value of the designated binary floating point number (D1,
D0) in radians will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a binary
floating point number.
X0
DCOS D0 D10
16-93
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TAN Binary floating point number TAN operation
132 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DTAN Continuous DTANP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
When X0=On, the TAN value of the designated binary floating point number (D1,
D0) in radians (RAD) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DTAN D0 D10
16-94
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ASIN Binary floating point number ASIN operation
133 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DASIN Continuous DASINP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: the designated source (binary floating point number). D: the ASIN value result.
ASIN value =sin-1
The figure below shows the relationship between input data and result:
When X0=On, the ASIN value obtained from the designated binary floating point
number (D1, D0) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DASIN D0 D10
16-95
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ACOS Binary floating point number ACOS operation
134 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DACOS Continuous DACOS Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type P execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: the designated source (binary floating point number). D: the ACOS value result.
ACOS value =cos-1
The figure below shows the relationship between input data and result:
When X0=On, the ACOS value obtained from the designated binary floating point
number (D1, D0) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DACOS D0 D10
16-96
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ATAN Binary floating point number ATAN operation
135 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DATAN Continuous DATANP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: the designated source (binary floating point number). D: the ATAN value result.
ATAN value =tan-1
The figure below shows the relationship between input data and result:
When X0=On, the TAN value obtained from the designated binary floating point
number (D1, D0) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DATAN D0 D10
16-97
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
SINH Binary floating point number SINH operation
136 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DSINH Continuous DSINHP Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: the designated source (binary floating point number). D: the SINH value result.
SINH value =(es-e-s)/2
When X0=On, the SINH value obtained from the designated binary floating point
number (D1, D0) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DSINH D0 D10
16-98
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
COSH Binary floating point number COSH operation
137 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DCOSH Continuous DCOSH Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type P execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: the designated source (binary floating point number). D: the COSH value result.
COSH value =(es+e-s)/2
When X0=On, the COSH value obtained from the designated binary floating point
number (D1, D0) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a
binary floating point number.
X0
DCOSH D0 D10
16-99
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TANH Binary floating point number TANH operation
138 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D - - - -
S * * *
D * 32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage: DTANH Continuous DTANH Pulse
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in execution type P execution type
series for the scope of device usage
Flag signal: none
S: the designated source (binary floating point number). D: the TANH value result.
tanh value =(es-e-s)/(es+e-s)
When X0=On, the TANH value obtained from the designated binary floating point
number (D1, D0) will be stored in (D11, D10), with the content consisting of a binary
floating point number.
X0
DTANH D0 D10
16-100
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
SWAP Exchange the up/down 8 bits
147 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (3 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D SWAP Continuous SWAPP Pulse execution
execution type type
S * * * * * *
Notes on operand usage: none 32-bit command (5 STEP)
DSWAP Continuous DSWAPP Pulse execution
execution type type
16-101
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
MODRW Modbus data read/write
150 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D MODRW Continuous MODRW Pulse
S1 * * * execution type P execution type
S2 * * *
S3 * * * 32-bit command
- - - -
S *
n * * * Flag signal: M1077 M1078 M1079
S1: online device address. S2: communications function code. S3: address of
data to read/write. S: register for data to be read/written is stored. N: length of data
to be read/written.
COM1 must be defined as controlled by the PLC (set P9-31 = -12) before using
this command, and the corresponding communications speed and format must
also be set (set P09-01 and P09-04). S2: communications function code.
Currently only supports the following function code; the remaining function code
cannot be executed.
Function Description
H 02 Input read
H 03 Read word
H 06 Write single word
H 0F Write multiple coils
H10 Write single word
After executing this command, M1077, M1078 and M1079 will be immediately
changed to 0.
As an example, when CP2000 must control another converter and PLC, if the
converter has a station number of 10 and the PLC has a station number of 20, see
the following example:
Control slave device converter
MODRW command
Seria S1 S2 S3 S4 n
Example
l No.
Function
Node ID Address Register Length
code
Reads 4 sets of data comprising the
converter slave device parameters
1 K10 H3 H100 D0 K4
P01-00 to P01-03, and saves the read
data in D0 to D3
Reads 3 sets of data comprising the
converter slave device addresses
2 K10 H3 H2100 D5 K3
H2100 to H2102, and saves the read
data in D5 to D7
Reads 3 sets of data comprising the
converter slave device parameters
3 K10 H10 H500 D10 K3
P05-00 to P05-03, and writes the
values as D10 to D12
Writes 2 sets of data comprising the
converter slave device addresses
4 K10 H10 H2000 D15 K2
H2000 to H2001, and writes the values
as D15 to D16
16-102
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-103
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Will trigger M0 On when the PLC begins to operate, and sends instruction to
execute one MODRW command.
After receiving the slave device's response, if the command is correct, it will
execute one ROL command, which will cause M1 to be On.
After receiving the slave device's response, will trigger M50 = 1 after a delay of 10
PLC scanning cycles, and then execute one MODRW command.
After again receiving the slave device's response, if the command is correct, it will
execute one ROL command, and M2 will change to On at this time (and M2 can
be defined as a repeat of M); K4M0 will change to K1, and only M0 will remain 1.
Transmission can proceed in a continuous cycle. If you wish to add a command,
merely add the desired command in the empty frame, and change repeat M to
Mn+1.
16-104
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TCMP Comparison of calendar data
160 P
Bit device Word device
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D 16-bit command (11 STEP)
S1 * * * * * * * * TCMP Continuous TCMPP Pulse
execution type execution type
S2 * * * * * * * *
S3 * * * * * * * * 32-bit command
S * * * - - - -
D * *
Notes on operand usage: Flag signal: none
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
series for the scope of device usage
S1: Sets the hours of the comparison time, setting range is "K0–K23." S2: Sets the
minutes of the comparison time, setting range is "K0–K59." S3: Sets the seconds of
the comparison time, setting range is "K0–K59." S: current calendar time. D:
Results of comparison.
Compares the time in hours, minutes, and seconds set in S1–S3 with the current
calendar time in hours, minutes, and seconds, with the results of comparison
expressed in D.
S The hour content of the current calendar time is "K0–K23." S +1 comprises the
minutes of the current calendar time, and consists of "K0–K59." S +2 comprises the
seconds of the current calendar time, and consists of "K0–K59."
The current calendar time designated by S is usually compared using the TCMP
command after using the TRD command to read the current calendar time. If the
content value of S exceeds the range, this is considered an operating error, the
command will not execute, and M1068=On.
When X10=On, the command will execute, and the current calendar time in
D20–D22 will be compared with the preset value of 12:20:45; the results will be
displayed in M10–M12. When X10 On→Off, the command will not be executed, but
the On/Off status prior to M10–M12 will be maintained.
If results in the form of ≥, ≤, or ≠ are needed, they can be obtained by series and
parallel connection of M10–M12.
16-105
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TZCP Comparison of calendar data
161 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D TZCP Continuous TZCPP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
S * * * 32-bit command
D * * - - - -
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in Flag signal: none
series for the scope of device usage
S1: Sets the lower limit of the comparison time. S2: Sets the upper limit of the
comparison time. S: current calendar time. D: Results of comparison.
Performs range comparison by comparing the hours, minutes, and seconds of the
current calendar time designated by S with the lower limit of the comparison time
set as S1 and the upper limit of the comparison time set as S2, and expresses the
results of comparison in D.
S1、S1 +1、S1 +2: Sets the hours, minutes, and seconds of the lower limit of the
comparison time.
S2、S2 +1、S2 +2: Sets the hours, minutes, and seconds of the upper limit of the
comparison time.
S、S +1、S +2: The hours, minutes, and seconds of the current calendar time
When X10=On, the TZCP command executes, and one of M10-M12 will be On.
When X10=Off, the TZCP command will not execute, and M10-M12 will remain in
the X10=Off state.
16-106
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TADD Calendar data addition
162 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D TADD Continuous TADDP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
32-bit command
D * * *
- - - -
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
series for the scope of device usage Flag signal: M1020 Zero flag
M1022 Carry flag
M1068 Calendar error
S1: time addend. S2: time augend. D: time sum.
The calendar data in hours, minutes, and seconds designated by S2 is added to the
calendar data in hours, minutes, and seconds designated by S1, and the result is
stored as hours, minutes, and seconds in the register designated by D.
If the value of S1 or S2 exceeds the range, this is considered an operating error, the
command will not execute, M1067, M1068=On, and D1067 will record the error
code 0E1A (HEX).
If the results of addition are greater than or equal to 24 hours, carry flag
M1022=On, and D will display the results of addition minus 24 hours.
If the results of addition are equal to 0 (0 hours, 0 minutes, 0 seconds), zero flag
M1020=On.
When X10=On, the TADD command will be executed, and the calendar data in
hours, minutes, and seconds designated by D0 to D2 will be added to the calendar
data in hours, minutes, and seconds designated by D10 to D12, and the results are
stored as a total number of hours, minutes, and seconds in the registers
designated by D20 to D22.
X10
TADD D0 D10 D20
16-107
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TSUB Calendar data subtraction
163 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D TSUB Continuous TSUBP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
32-bit command
D * * *
- - - -
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in
series for the scope of device usage Flag signal: M1020 Zero flag
M1022 Carry flag
M1068 Calendar error
S1: time minuend. S2: time augend. D: time sum.
Subtracts the calendar data in hours, minutes, and seconds designated by S2 from
the calendar data in hours, minutes, and seconds designated by S1, and the result
is temporarily stored as hours, minutes, and seconds in the register designated by
D.
If the value of S1 or S2 exceeds the range, this is considered an operating error, the
command will not execute, M1067, M1068=On, and D1067 will record the error
code 0E1A (HEX).
If subtraction results in a negative number, borrow flag M1021=On, and the result of
that negative number plus 24 hours will be displayed in the register designated by
D.
If the results of subtraction are equal to 0 (0 hours, 0 minutes, 0 seconds), zero flag
M1020=On.
When X10=On, the TADD command will be executed, and the calendar data in
hours, minutes, and seconds designated by D10 to D12 will be subtracted from the
calendar data in hours, minutes, and seconds designated by D0 to D2, and the
results are stored as a total number of hours, minutes, and seconds in the registers
designated by D20 to D22.
X10
TSUB D0 D10 D20
16-108
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
TRD Calendar data read
166 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (3 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D TRD Continuous TRDP Pulse
D * * * execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in 32-bit command
series for the scope of device usage - - - -
Special General
Item Content Item
D D
Year Year
D1063 00–99 D0
(Western) (Western)
D1064 Weeks 1–7 D1 Weeks
D1065 Month 1–12 D2 Month
D1066 Day 1–31 D3 Day
D1067 Hour 0–23 D4 Hour
D1068 Minute 0–59 D5 Minute
D1069 Second 0–59 D6 Second
16-109
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
GRY BIN→GRAY code transformation
170 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D GRY Continuous GRYP Pulse
S * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
D * * * * *
32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in DGRY Continuous DGRYP Pulse
series for the scope of device usage execution type execution type
16-110
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
GBIN GRAY code →BIN transformation
171 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D GBIN Continuous GBINP Pulse
S * * * * * * * * execution type execution type
D * * * * *
32-bit command (9 STEP)
Notes on operand usage:
Please refer to the function specifications table for each device in DGBIN Continuous DGBINP Pulse
series for the scope of device usage execution type execution type
X17 K4X0 X0
b15 b0
H1971=K6513 0 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 0 1 1 1 0 0 0 1
16-111
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
215– LD# S1 S2 Contact form logical operation LD#
217 D
|: logical OR operation.
When the content of C0 and C10 is subjected to the logical AND operation, and
the result is not equal to 0, Y10=On.
When the content of D200 and D300 is subjected to the logical OR operation, and
the result is not equal to 0, and X1=On, Y11=On and remains in that state.
LD & C0 C10 Y10
X1
LD I D200 D300 SET Y11
16-112
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
218– AND# S1 S2 Contact form logical operation AND#
220 D
16-113
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
221– OR# S1 S2 Contact form logical operation OR#
223 D
OR & C0 C10
X2 M30
M60
16-114
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
224– LD※ S1 S2 Contact form compare LD*
230 D
X1
LD> D200 K-30 SET Y11
M3
16-115
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
232– AND※ S1 S2 Contact form compare AND*
238 D
X1
AND<> K-10 D0 SET Y11
X2
DAND> K678493 D10 M50
M3
16-116
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
240– OR※ S1 S2 Contact form compare OR*
246 D
X2 M30
M60
16-117
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
275– FLD※ S1 S2 Floating point number contact form compare LD*
280
X1
FLD<= D200 F1.2 SET Y21
16-118
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
281– FAND※ S1 S2 Floating point number contact form compare AND*
286
X1
FAND<> F1.2 D0 SET Y21
16-119
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
287– FOR※ S1 S2 Floating point number contact form compare OR*
292
16-120
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
WPR S1 S2 Write servo parameter
140 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D WPR Continuous WPRP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
Notes on operand usage: none 32-bit command
- - - -
Flag signal: none
Recommendation Take care when using the WPR command. When writing parameters, because
most parameters are recorded as they are written, these parameters may only be
revised 109 times; a memory write error may occur if parameters are written more
than 109 times.
Because the following commonly-used parameters have special processing, there
are no restrictions on the number of times they may be written.
16-121
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Calculation of the number of times written is based on whether the written value is
modified. For instance, writing the same value 100 times at the same time counts
as writing only once.
When writing a PLC program, if unsure of usage of the WPR command, we
recommend that you use the WPRP command.
16-122
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
FPID S1 S2 S3 S4 Driver PID control mode
141 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D FPID Continuous FPIDP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
32-bit command
S3 * * *
- - - -
S4 * * *
Notes on operand usage: none Flag signal: none
M1
FPID H0 H1 H0 H0
M2
FPID H1 H1 H0 H0
M1000
MOV D1027 D1
END
16-123
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
FREQ S1 S2 S3 Driver speed control mode
142 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (7 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D FREQ Continuous FREQP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
32-bit command
S3 * * *
- - - -
Notes on operand usage: none
Flag signal: M1015
M1025: Driver RUN (On) / STOP (Off), M1026: driver operating direction FWD (Off) / REV
(On). M1015: frequency reached.
When M10=On, sets the driver frequency command K300 (3.00 Hz), with an
acceleration/deceleration time of 0.
When M11=On, sets the driver frequency command K3000 (30.00 Hz), with an
acceleration time of 50 (0.5 sec.) and deceleration time of 60 (0.6 sec.). (When
Pr.01-45=0)
When M11=Off, the driver frequency command will now change to 0
M1000
M1025
M11
M1026
M1000
M1040
M12
M1042
M13
M1044
M14
M1052
M10 M11
FREQP K300 K0 K0
M11 M10
FREQ K3000 K50 K60
END
Pr.09-33 are defined on the basis of whether the reference commands have been cleared
before PLC operation.
bit0: Prior to PLC scanning procedures, whether the target frequency has been cleared is
0. (This will be written to the FREQ command when the PLC is ON).
16-124
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
END
If we force M0 to be 1, the frequency command will be 20.00 Hz; but when M0 is set as 0,
there will be a different situation.
Case 1: When the bit0 of Pr.09-33 is 0, and M0 is set as 0, the frequency command remains
at 20.00 Hz.
Case 2: When the bit0 of Pr.09-33 is 1, and M0 is set as 0, the frequency command changes
to 0.00 Hz.
The reason is that when the Pr.09-33 bit0 is 1 prior to the PLC scanning procedures, the
frequency will firstly revert to 0.
When the Pr.09-33 bit0 is 0, the frequency will not revert to 0.
16-125
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
CANRX S1 S2 S3 D Read CANopen slave station data
261 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D CANRX Continuous CANRX Pulse
S1 * * execution type P execution type
S2 * *
32-bit command
S3 * *
- - - -
D * * *
Notes on operand usage: none Flag signal
M1002: When the PLC runs, the command will be triggered once and will set
K4M400 = K1
Afterwards, each time M1066 is 1, it will switch to a different message.
16-126
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
CANTX S1 S2 S3 S4 Write CANopen slave station data
264 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D CANTX Continuous CANTXP Pulse
S1 * * execution type execution type
S2 * * * * *
32-bit command
S3 * *
- - - -
S4 * *
Notes on operand usage: none Flag signal
API
CANFLS D Refresh special D corresponding to CANopen
265 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (3 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D CANFLS Continuous CANFLSP Pulse
D * * execution type execution type
Notes on operand usage: none
32-bit command
- - - -
Flag signal
D : Special D to be refreshed.
The CANFLS command can refresh special D commands. When is a read only
attribute, executing this command will send a message equivalent to that of CANRX
to the slave station, and the number of the slave station will be transmitted back and
refreshed to this special D. When there is a read/write attribute, executing this
command will send a message equivalent to that of CANTX to the slave station, and
the value of this special D will be written to the corresponding slave station.
When M1066 and M1067 are both 0, and M1066 is set as 1 after reading, if the slave
station gives a correct response, the value will be written to the designated register,
and M1067 will be set as 1. If the slave station's response contains an error, then
M1067 will be set as 0, and an error message will be recorded to D1076-D1079.
API
ICOMR D Internal communications read
320 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ICOMR Continuous ICOMRP Pulse
S1 * * * execution type execution type
S2 * * *
32-bit command (17 STEP)
S3 * * * DICOMR Continuous DICOMRP Pulse
D * * * execution type execution
Notes on operand usage: none type
Flag signal: M1077 M1078 M1079
16-127
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
ICOMW D Internal communications write
321 D P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (9 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D ICOMW Continuous ICOMW Pulse
S1 * * * execution type P execution type
S2 * * *
32-bit command (17 STEP)
S3 * * * DICOM Continuous DICOM Pulse
D * * * W execution type WP execution type
Notes on operand usage: none
Flag signal: M1077 M1078 M1079
16-128
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
API
WPRA S1 S2 Drive parameters write-in
323 P
Bit device Word device 16-bit command (5 STEP)
X Y M K H KnX KnY KnM T C D WORA Continuous WORAP Pulse
execution type execution type
S1 * * *
S2 * * * 32-bit command
- - - -
Notes on operand usage: none
Flag signal: none
Read the data of CP2000 drive’s parameter H01.00 and write into D0, read data
of H01.01 and write into D1.
When M0 is ON, write the content of D10 into CP2000 drive’s Pr.04-00 (1st step
speed frequency).
When parameter writes-in successfully, M1017 is ON.
The WPR command does not support the write-in of 20XX address, but the RPR
command supports the read-out of 21XX and 22XX.
When WPRA executes, the data is only written into the RAM area, and will get
back to previous record when the power is off.
16-129
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-130
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-131
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
After leaving the PLC register window, the register setting screen will appear, as shown
below:
If there is a new PLC program and no settings have yet been made, you can read default data
from the converter, and merely edit it to suit the current application. If settings have already been
made, however, the special D in the CANopen area will display the saved status (the CANopen
D area is located at D1090 to D1099 and D2000 to D2799). Assuming it is a new program, we
will first read the default data from the converter; check the communications format if there is no
communications link (the default PLC station number is 2, 9600, 7N2, ASCII). Perform the
following steps: 1. Switch the PLC to Stop status; 2. Press the transmit button; 3. click on read
memory after exiting the window; 4. Ignore D0-D399; and 5. click on the confirm button.)
16-132
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
After reading the data, it is necessary to perform some special D settings. Before proceeding, we
will first introduce the special D implications and setting range. The CANopen Master's special
D range is currently D1070 to D1099 and D2000 to D2799; this range is divided into 3 blocks:
The first block is used to display CANopen's current status, and has a range of D1070 to D1089;
the second block is used for CANopen's basic settings, and has a range of D1090 to D1099;
the third block is the slave station mapping and control area, and has a range of D2000 to
D2799;
These areas are therefore introduced as follows:
16-133
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
For instance, when communications speed is 500Kbps, TXPDO + RXPDO have 8 sets,
and synchronizing time will require more than 4 ms
We must also define how many slave stations will be open. D1091 is the channel for
defining station opening, and D2000+100*n is the station number defining this channel. See the
detailed explanation below.
Slave station number n=0-7
Special D Description of Function R/W
Sets slave station On or Off (bit0–bit 7 correspond to
D1091 RW
slave stations number 0–7)
D2000+100*n Slave station number RW
16-134
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
If slave devices have a slow start-up, the master can delay for a short time before performing
slave station configuration; this time delay can be set via D1092.
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
D1092 Delay before start of initialization 0 RW
With regard to slave device initialization, a delay time can be set to judge whether failure has
occurred. If the communications speed is relatively slow, the delay time can be adjusted to judge
whether initialization has been completed, which will ensure that there is time to perform slave
device initialization.
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
Initialization completion delay time
D1099 15 sec. RW
Setting range: 1 to 60000 sec
After communication is successful, the system must detect whether there is a break in
communications with the slave station. D1093 is used to set detection time, and D1094 sets the
number of consecutive errors that will trigger a break error.
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
D1093 Break time detection 1000ms RW
D1094 Break number detection 3 RW
The packet type transmitted by PDO is set before establishing normal communications and
generally does not require adjustment.
Special D Description of Function Default: R/W
Corresponding real-time transmission type
D1097 (PDO) 1 RW
Setting range: 1–240
Corresponding real-time receiving type (PDO)
D1098 1 RW
Setting range: 1–240
The third block is the slave station mapping and control area.
CANopen provides a PDO method to perform mapping of the master and slave station memory,
and enables the master to directly access read/write data in a certain memory area. The master
will automatically perform data exchange with the corresponding slave device, and the
read/write values can be seen directly from the special D area after real-time exchange (M1034
= 1 time) has been established. The CP2000 currently supports real-time mapping of four PDOs,
and there are two types of PDO RXPDO (reads slave device information) and TXPDO (writes to
slave device). In addition, in order to facilitate control, the CP2000 cannot perform mapping of
commonly used registers; the following is an overview of the current PDO mapping situation:
TX PDO
PDO2 (Remote I/O) PDO1 (Speed)
Description Special D Description Special D
Slave device DO D2027+100*n Controller word D2008+100*n
16-135
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
RXPDO
PDO2 (Remote I/O) PDO1 (Speed)
Description Special D Description Special D
Slave device DI D2026+100*n Mode word D2009+100*n
Slave device AI1 D2028+100*n Actual frequency D2013+100*n
Slave device AI2 D2029+100*n
Slave device AI3 D2030+100*n
Because usage requires only simple to open the corresponding PDO, where TXPDO
employs D2034+100*n settings and RXPDO employs D2067+100*n settings.
PDO2 PDO1
Definition Remote I/O Speed
bit 7 6–4 3 2–0
Definition 0 0 1 2
D2067+100*n =000Ah
TX PDO
Length PDO2 PDO1
Description Special D Description Special D
1 Slave device DI D2026+100*n Controller word D2009+100*n
2 Slave device AI1 D2028+100*n Actual frequency D2013+100*n
3 Slave device AI2 D2029+100*n
4 Slave device AI3 D2030+100*n
PDO2 PDO1
Definition Remote I/O Speed
bit 7 6–4 3 2–0
Definition 0 0 1 2
Switch the PLC to Run after completing settings. Now wait for successful initialization of
CANopen (M1059 = 1 and M1061 = 0), and then initiate CANopen memory mapping (M1034 = 1).
The control word and frequency command will now automatically refresh to the corresponding
slave device (D2008+n*100 and D2012+n*100), and the slave device's status word and currently
frequency will also be automatically sent back to the master station (D2009+n*100 and
16-136
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
D2013+n*100). This also illustrates how the master can handle these tasks through read/write
operations in the special D area.
Furthermore, it should be noted that the remote I/O of PDO2 can obtain the slave device's
current DI and AI status, and can also control the slave device's DO and AO status. Nevertheless,
after introducing a fully automatic mapping special D, the CP2000 CANopen master also provides
additional information refreshes. For instance, while in speed mode, acceleration/deceleration
settings may have been refreshed. The special D therefore also stores some seldom-used
real-time information, and these commands can be refreshed using the CANFLS command. The
following is the CP2000's current CANopen master data conversion area, which has a range of
D2001+100*n - D2033+100*n, as shown below:
1. The range of n is 0-7
2. ●Indicates PDOTX, ▲Indicates PDORX; unmarked special D can be refreshed using the
CANFLS command
PDO Default
Special D Description of Function Default R/W
1 2
Station number n of slave station
D2000+100*n Setting range: 0–127 0 RW
0: No CANopen function
D2002+100*n Manufacturer code of slave station number n (L) 0 R
Basic definitions
PDO Default
Special D Description of Function Default R/W
1 2
Communications break handling method of slave
D2006+100*n 0 RW
station number n
D2007+100*n Error code of slave station number n error 0 R
Velocity Control
PDO
Special D Description of Function Default Default R/W
1 2
D2001+100*n Torque restriction on slave station number n 0 RW
D2012+100*n Target speed of slave station number n (rpm) 0 ● RW
D2013+100*n Actual speed of slave station number n (rpm) 0 ▲ R
D2014+100*n Error speed of slave station number n (rpm) 0 R
D2015+100*n Acceleration time of slave station number n (ms) 1000 RW
D2016+100*n Deceleration time of slave station number n (ms) 1000 RW
16-137
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Remote I/O
PDO Default
Special D Description of Function Default R/W
1 2
D2026+100*n MI status of slave station number n 0 ▲ R
D2027+100*n MO setting of slave station number n 0 ● RW
D2028+100*n AI1 status of slave station number n 0 ▲ R
D2029+100*n AI2 status of slave station number n 0 ▲ R
D2030+100*n AI3 status of slave station number n 0 ▲ R
RW
D2031+100*n AO1 setting of slave station number n 0 ●
RW
D2032+100*n AO2 setting of slave station number n 0 ●
RW
D2033+100*n AO3 setting of slave station number n 0 ●
16-138
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Another method can be used to set D1091: Determine which of slave stations 0 to 7 will not be
needed, and set the corresponding bits to 0. For instance, if it is not necessary to control slave
stations 2, 6 and 7, merely set D1091 = 003B, and the setting method is the same as
described above: Use WPL to initiate communications > use register edit (T C D) function
to perform settings.
Step 3: Set the master's communications station number and communications speed
When setting the master's station number (Pr.09-46, default is set as 100), make sure
not to use the same number as a slave station.
Set the CANopen communications speed (Pr. 09-37); regardless of whether the driver
is defined as a master or slave station, the communications speed is set via this
parameter.
When using CANRX, CANTX or CANFLS, internal implementation commands will wait until M1066 is
completed before executing the next CANRX, CANTX or CANFLS.
Afterwards, download program to the driver (Please note that the PLC's default communications
format is ASCII 7N2 9600, and the station number is 2. The WPL must therefore be modified,
and the WPL setting pathway is settings > communications settings)
Step 5: Set the slave stations' station numbers, communications speed, control source, and
command source
Delta's CP2000 and EC series devices currently support the CANopen communications
interface driver, and the corresponding slave station numbers and communications speed
parameters are as follows:
16-139
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Corresponding device
parameters Value Definition
CP2000 E-C
Slave station 0 Disable CANopen hardware interface
09-36 09-20
address 1–127 CANopen Communication address
0 1 Mbps
1 500 Kbps
Communication 2 250 Kbps
09-37 09-21
speed 3 125 Kbps
4 100 Kbps
5 50 Kbps
Delta's A2 Servo currently supports the CANopen communications interface, and the
corresponding slave station numbers and communications speed parameters are as follows:
Corresponding device
parameters Value Definition
A2
Slave station
Pr.03-00 1–127 CANopen Communication address
address
R= 0 125 Kbps
R= 1 250 Kbps
Communication
Pr.03-01 bit8–11 XRXX R= 2 500 Kbps
speed
R= 3 750 Kbps
R= 4 1 Mbps
Control/command
Pr.01-01 B
source
Terminal Terminal
Resistor Resistor
16-140
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Step 3: Set the master's communications station number and communications speed
When setting the master's station number (Pr.09-46, default is set as 100), make sure
not to use the same number as a slave station.
Set the CANopen communications speed as 1M (Pr.09-37=0); regardless of whether
the driver is defined as a master or slave station, the communications speed is set
via this parameter.
16-141
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Refresh command:
Use CANFLS command to refresh (if there are RW attributes, the master will write to
the slave station; if there are RO attributes, the slave station will return the read values
to the master); M1066 will be 1 if refresh has been completed; M1067 will be 1 if
refresh is successful, and M1067 will be 0 if an error has occurred.
NOTE
When using CANRX, CANTX or CANFLS, internal implementation commands will wait until
M1066 is completed before executing the next CANRX, CANTX or CANFLS.
Afterwards, download program to the driver (Please note that the PLC's default
communications format is ASCII 7N2 9600, and the station number is 2. The WPL must
therefore be modified, and the WPL setting pathway is settings > communications
settings)
Step 5: Set the slave stations' station numbers and communications speed
Slave station no. 1: Pr.09-37 = 0 (Speed 1M) Pr.09-36=10 (Node ID 10)
Slave station no. 2: Pr.09-37 = 0 (Speed 1M) Pr.09-36=10 (Node ID 11)
Terminal Terminal
resistor resistor
16-142
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Control special M
Special M Description of Function Attributes
M1025 Driver frequency = set frequency (ON)/driver frequency =0 (OFF) RW
M1026 Driver operating direction FWD(OFF)/REV(ON) RW
M1040 Hardware power (Servo On) RW
M1042 Quick stop RW
M1044 Pause (Halt) RW
M1052 Lock frequency (lock, frequency locked at the current operating frequency) RW
Status special M
Special M Description of Function Attributes
M1015 Frequency attained (when used together with M1025) RO
M1056 Servo On Ready RO
M1058 On Quick Stopping RO
Control special D
Special D Description of Function Attributes
D1060 Mode setting (speed mode is 0) RW
Status special D
Special D Description of Function Attributes
D1037 Converter output frequency (0.00–600.00) RO
D1050 Actual operating mode (speed mode is 0) RO
Target speed The first acceleration time setting The first deceleration time setting
16-143
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
7. M1042 can be used to perform quick stop, and deceleration will be as quick as possible
without giving rise to an error. (There may still be a jump error if the load is too large.)
8. Control user rights: M1040(Servo ON) > M1042(Quick Stop) >M1044(Halt) >M1052(LOCK)
16-144
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Internal communications have a master-slave structure. The initiation method is very simple:
Slave device:
Set Pr.09-31 = -1 to -8 in order to access 8 nodes, and set Pr.00-20 = 1 to define the control
source as 485 and access the reference sources that must be controlled, namely speed command
(Pr.00-21 = 2). This will complete slave device settings. (PLC functions do not need to be activated)
System:
Setting the master is even simpler; it is only necessary to set Pr.09-31 = -10, and enable the PLC.
Hardware wiring:
The master and slave stations are connected via the 485 serial port. The CP2000 provide two types
of 485 serial port interfaces, see the figure below: (please refer to Section 06 Control terminals
concerning detailed terminal connections)
16-145
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Control special M
Special M Description of Function Attributes
M1035 Initiates internal communications control RW
Control special D
Special D Description of Function Attributes
Internal node communications number 1–8 (set the station number of the slave
D1110 RW
station to be controlled)
Reverse rotation
1 4
requirements
2 4 -
3 3 Temporary pause
4 4 Frequency locking
D1120 + 10*NInternal node N control command 5 4 JOG RW
6 2 Quick Stop
7 1 Servo ON
11–8 4 Speed interval switching
14 4 Enable bit13–8
Speed command
D1122 + 10*NInternal node N reference command L RW
(no number)
Status special D
Special D Description of Function Attributes
D1115 Internal node synchronizing cycle (ms) RO
Internal node error (bit0 = slave device 1, bit1 = slave device 2,…bit7 = slave device
D1116 RO
8)
Internal node online correspondence (bit0 = slave device 1, bit1 = slave device
D1117 RO
2,…bit7 = slave device 8)
16-146
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Example: Assume it is desired to control slave station 1 operation at frequencies of 30.00 Hz and
60.00 Hz, status, and online node correspondences:
When it is judged that slave station 1 is online, delay 3 sec. and begin control
16-147
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
It is required slave station 1 maintain forward rotation at 30.00 Hz for 1 sec., and maintain reverse
rotation at 60.00 Hz for 1 sec., and repeat this cycle continuously.
16-148
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
After implementing MODRW, the status will be displayed in M1077 (485 read/write complete), M1078
(485 read/write error), and M1079 (485 read/write time out). M1077 is defined so as to immediately
revert to 0 after the MODRW command has been implemented. However, any of three situations—a
report of no error, a data error report, or time out with no report—will cause the status of M1077 to
change to On.
0 M1002
MOV K1 K4M0
On only for 1 scan a
16-149
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
When the reported message indicates no error, it will switch to the next transmitted command
If time out occurs or an error is reported, the M1077 will change to On. At this time, after a delay of 30
scanning cycles, it will re-issue the original command once
14 M1077
ADD D30 K1 D30
485 R/W rite is co
( M200 )
Delay cycle
33 M1002
( M100 )
ON only for 1 scan a ReqTXOnce
M200
Delay cycle
36 M100 M0
MODRW K2 H1 H500 D200
ReqTXOnce M1
MODRW K2 HF H500 D100
M2
MODRW K2 H2 H410 D201
M3
MODRW K3 H3 H2100 D300
M4
MODRW K2 H2 H410 D201
102 M5
MOV K1 K4M0
INC D1
121
END
Practical applications:
Actual use to control the RTU-485 module.
Step 1: Set the communications format. Assume that the communications format is 115200, 8,N,2,
RTU
CP2000:The default PLC station number is set as 2 (Pr.09-35)
Pr.09-31=-12 (COM1 is controlled by the PLC), Pr.09-01=115.2 (The communications speed is
115200)
Pr.09-04=13 (The format is 8,N,2, RTU)
16-150
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 PA3 PA2 PA1 PA0 DR2 DR1 DR0 A/R
0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 1 1 1 0
Communication station #:
ID0~ ID7 are defined as 2 0 , 2 1, 2 2 ...2 6 , 2 7
Communication protocol
Communication Protocol
Communicaton Speed
16-151
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
CP200 0
16-152
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-153
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
AD DA testing: It can be discovered that D200 and D201 are roughly twice of the D300, and continue
to increase progressively. For their part, the D202 and D203 are roughly twice of the
D301, and continue to decrease progressively.
16-154
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-155
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-156
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
Practical applications:
We will perform a demo of simple applications.
We first correct the keypad time. After pressing Menu on the keypad, select the 9th time setting
option. After selection, set the current time.
We set converter on during the period of 8:00–17:20, which allows us to write the following example
At K16
Normally open
contact of
operation
At K16
monitoring (a)
Servo on
Motor drive
Run (ON)/ Stop(OFF)
Normally open
contact of
operation
monitoring (a)
16-157
Chapter 16 PLC Function Applications│CP2000
16-158
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
1. About BACnet:
BACnet is an ASHRAE communication protocol for building automation and control networks.
(ASHRAE: American Society of Heating, Refrigerating and Air-Conditioning Engineers, Inc.).
CP2000’s BACnet is based on version 2004.
BACnet’s regulations are related to several kinds of physical layers’ interfaces. The physical layer built
inside CP2000 is achieved via MS/TP interface.
The BACnet of CP2000 supports a device type called B-ASC. B-ASC supports six types of services such
as DS-RP-B, DS-RPM-B, DS-WP-B, DM-DDB-B, DM-DOB-B and DM-DCC-B.
17-1
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Object Type
Property ID
Device Analog Value Binary Value
#104 RELINQUISH DEFAULT V *3 V *3
#107 SEGMENTATION_SUPPORTED V
#111 STATUS FLAGS V V
#112 SYSTEM_STATUS V
#117 UNITS V
#120 VENDOR_IDENTIFIER V
#121 VENDOR_NAME V
#139 PROTOCOL_REVISION V
#155 DATABASE_REVISION V
*1. The Object_ID and Object_Name Properties of Device are writeable.
*2. The Present_Value Property of some AV and BV objects is commandable.
*3. Only Commandable objects support Priority_Array and Relinquish_Default.
The AV objects, we have commandable and read-only cases.
Commendable case: We can use Write_Service to access the Present_Value property of commandable
AV objects. Thus, the commandable AV objects are linking to the Control_Word and Pr_Word in CP2000.
Readonly case: We can use Read_Service to access the Present_Value property of readonly AV objects.
Thus, these readonly AV objects are linking to the Status_Word in CP2000.
The BV objects, we also have commandable and readonly cases.
Commandable case: We can use Write_Service to access the Present_Value property of commendable
BV objects. Thus, the commandable BV objects are linking to the Control_Bit in CP2000.
Readonly case: We can use Read_Service to access the Present_Value property of readonly BV objects.
Thus, these readonly BV objects are linking to the Status_Bit in CP2000.
17-2
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Object
R/W Object Name Object Description Unit
Number
AV 010 RW Reserved Reserved UNITS_NO_UNITS
AV 011 RW (P9-11 map set) AV11 will modify data which is P9-11 mapping to Depends
AV 012 RW (P9-12 map set) AV12 will modify data which is P9-12 mapping to Depends
AV 013 RW (P9-13 map set) AV13 will modify data which is P9-13 mapping to Depends
AV 014 RW (P9-14 map set) AV14 will modify data which is P9-14 mapping to Depends
AV 015 RW (P9-15 map set) AV15 will modify data which is P9-15 mapping to Depends
AV 016 RW (P9-16 map set) AV16 will modify data which is P9-16 mapping to Depends
AV 017 RW (P9-17 map set) AV17 will modify data which is P9-17 mapping to Depends
AV 018 RW (P9-18 map set) AV18 will modify data which is P9-18 mapping to Depends
AV 019 RW (P9-19 map set) AV19 will modify data which is P9-19 mapping to Depends
AV 020 RW (P9-20 map set) AV20 will modify data which is P9-20 mapping to Depends
AV 021 RW (P9-21 map set) AV21 will modify data which is P9-21 mapping to Depends
AV 022 RW (P9-22 map set) AV22 will modify data which is P9-22 mapping to Depends
AV 023 RW (P9-23 map set) AV23 will modify data which is P9-23 mapping to Depends
AV 024 RW (P9-24 map set) AV24 will modify data which is P9-24 mapping to Depends
AV 025 RW (P9-25 map set) AV25 will modify data which is P9-25 mapping to Depends
AV 026 RW (P9-26 map set) AV26 will modify data which is P9-26 mapping to Depends
17-3
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Object
R/W Object Name Object Description Unit
Number
AV 043 R Error code Error code UNITS_NO_UNITS
AV 044 R Output current Display output current (Amp) UNITS_AMPERES
AV 045 R DC bus voltage Display DC bus voltage (Volt) UNITS_VOLTS
AV 046 R Output Voltage Display output voltage of U, V, W (Volt) UNITS_VOLTS
AV 047 R Count Value Display counter value of TRG terminal UNITS_NO_UNITS
UNITS_POWER_FA
AV 048 R Power Angle Display output power angle of U, V, W
CTOR
AV 049 R Output Power Display actual output power of U, V, W (kw) UNITS_KILOWATTS
UNITS_DEGREES_
AV 050 R IGBT temperature Display the IGBT temperature
CELSIUS
Temperature of UNITS_DEGREES_
AV 051 R Display the temperature of capacitance
driver CELSIUS
Real carry
AV 052 R Display real carrier frequency of the drive (kHz) UNITS_KILOHERTZ
frequency
PID feedback
AV 053 R Display PID feedback value (%) UNITS_PERCENT
value
AV 054 R Overload rate Display overload condition (%) UNITS_PERCENT
Ground fail detect
AV 055 R Display GND fail detect level (%) UNITS_PERCENT
level
AV 056 R DC bus ripple Display DC bus voltage ripples (Volt) UNITS_VOLTS
AV 057 R Fan Speed Fan speed of the drive (%) UNITS_PERCENT
Output UNITS_REVOLUTIO
AV 058 R Output speed(rpm)
speed(rpm) NS_PER_MINUTE
AV 059 R kW per Hour kW per Hour UNITS_KILOWATTS
AV 060 R Multi-speed switch Real multi-speed switch UNITS_NO_UNITS
AV 061 R AVI1 input value 0–10 V corresponds to 0–100% UNITS_PERCENT
AV 062 R ACI input value 4–20 mA/0–10 V corresponds to 0–100% UNITS_PERCENT
AV 063 R AVI2 input value 0–10 V corresponds to 0–100% UNITS_PERCENT
AV 064 R Digital input status Refer to Pr.02-12 UNITS_NO_UNITS
Digital output
AV 065 R Refer to Pr.02-18 UNITS_NO_UNITS
status
CPU pin status of
AV 066 R Corresponding CPU pin status of digital input UNITS_NO_UNITS
DI
CPU pin status of
AV 067 R Corresponding CPU pin status of digital output UNITS_NO_UNITS
DO
AV 068 R PLC D1043 value PLC D1043 value UNITS_NO_UNITS
17-4
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
17-5
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Object
R/W Object Name Object Description
Number
BV 029 R Reserved Reserved
BV 030 R Reserved Reserved
BV 031 R Reserved Reserved
17-6
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
PS. In CP2000, base on different Pr setting or IO setting, we can make FreqCmd with different source of Reference Value.
Please check the usage of Keypad, Pr and IO setting for more detail information.
17-7
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
17-8
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Product Description:
Delta VFD-CP2000 is a Variable Frequency AC motor Drive with BACnet embedded.
Segmentation Capability:
Segmented requests supported Window Size
Segmented responses supported Window Size
Object instantiation is static. Refer to table at end of this document for object details.
17-9
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Networking Options:
Router, Clause 6 - List all routing configurations, e.g., ARCNET-Ethernet, Ethernet-MS/TP, etc.
Annex H, BACnet Tunneling Router over IP
BACnet/IP Broadcast Management Device (BBMD)
Does the BBMD support registrations by Foreign Devices? Yes No
If this product is a communication gateway, describe the types of non-BACnet equipment/networks(s) that
the gateway supports:
___________________________________________________________________________________________
____
___________________________________________________________________________________________
____
17-10
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
17-11
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
AV 011 RW AV_011_P9-11 map set= ----- AV11 will modify data which is P9-11 mapping to Depends
AV 012 RW AV_012_P9-12 map set= ----- AV12 will modify data which is P9-12 mapping to Depends
AV 013 RW AV_013_P9-13 map set= ----- AV13 will modify data which is P9-13 mapping to Depends
AV 014 RW AV_014_P9-14 map set= ----- AV14 will modify data which is P9-14 mapping to Depends
AV 015 RW AV_015_P9-15 map set= ----- AV15 will modify data which is P9-15 mapping to Depends
AV 016 RW AV_016_P9-16 map set= ----- AV16 will modify data which is P9-16 mapping to Depends
AV 017 RW AV_017_P9-17 map set= ----- AV17 will modify data which is P9-17 mapping to Depends
AV 018 RW AV_018_P9-18 map set= ----- AV18 will modify data which is P9-18 mapping to Depends
AV 019 RW AV_019_P9-19 map set= ----- AV19 will modify data which is P9-19 mapping to Depends
AV 020 RW AV_020_P9-20 map set= ----- AV20 will modify data which is P9-20 mapping to Depends
AV 021 RW AV_021_P9-21 map set= ----- AV21 will modify data which is P9-21 mapping to Depends
AV 022 RW AV_022_P9-22 map set= ----- AV22 will modify data which is P9-22 mapping to Depends
AV 023 RW AV_023_P9-23 map set= ----- AV23 will modify data which is P9-23 mapping to Depends
AV 024 RW AV_024_P9-24 map set= ----- AV24 will modify data which is P9-24 mapping to Depends
AV 025 RW AV_025_P9-25 map set= ----- AV25 will modify data which is P9-25 mapping to Depends
AV 026 RW AV_026_P9-26 map set= ----- AV26 will modify data which is P9-26 mapping to Depends
17-12
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
UNITS_POWER_FACT
AV 048 R AV_048_Power Angle Display output power angle of U, V, W
OR
UNITS_DEGREES_CE
AV 050 R AV_050_IGBT temperature Display the IGBT temperature
LSIUS
UNITS_DEGREES_CE
AV 051 R AV_051_Temperature of driver Display the temperature of capacitance
LSIUS
AV 052 R AV_052_Real carry frequency Display real carrier frequency of the drive(KHz) UNITS_KILOHERTZ
AV 053 R AV_053_PID feedback value Display PID feedback value (%) UNITS_PERCENT
AV 055 R AV_055_Ground fail detect level Display GND fail detect level (%) UNITS_PERCENT
UNITS_REVOLUTION
AV 058 R AV_058_Output speed(rpm) Output speed(rpm)
S_PER_MINUTE
17-13
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
Object
R/W Object Name Object Description Unit
Number
AV 066 R AV_066_CPU pin status of DI Corresponding CPU pin status of digital input UNITS_NO_UNITS
AV 067 R AV_067_CPU pin status of DO Corresponding CPU pin status of digital output UNITS_NO_UNITS
17-14
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
17-15
Chapter 17 Introduction to BACnet │CP2000
17-16
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function │CP2000
18-4 Parameter
18-1
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function│CP2000
18-2
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function │CP2000
18-3-2 In the figure below, the default setting for +24V-STO1-STO2 and SCM1-SCM2-DCM is short
circuit:
18-3
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function│CP2000
18-4
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function │CP2000
18-4 Parameter
STO Alarm Latch
Default: 0
Settings 0:STO Alarm Latch
1:STO Alarm no Latch
Pr.06-44=0 STO Alarm Latch: after the reason of STO Alarm is cleared, you need a Reset
command to clear STO Alarm.
Pr.06-44=1 STO Alarm no Latch: after the reason of STO Alarm is cleared, the STO Alarm will be
cleared automatically.
The STL1–STL3 error are all “Alarm latch” mode (in STL1–STL3 mode, the Pr.06-44 function is
no effective).
Multi-function Output 1 (Relay1)
Default: 11
Multi-function Output 2 (Relay2)
Default: 1
Multi-function Output 3 (Relay3)
Default: 66
Settings
66: SO N.O. logic A output
68: SO N.C. logic B output
18-5
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function│CP2000
Figure 1
Figure 2
18-5-2-2 STO, Pr.06-44=0, Pr.02-35=1
As shown in Figure 3: the same as figure 2. However, due to the setting for Pr.02-35 is 1, if the
operating command still exists after the Reset command, the drive will immediately execute the run
command again.
Figure 3
18-6
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function │CP2000
Figure 4
18-5-4 STL1
Figure 5
18-5-4 STL2
Figure 6
18-7
Chapter 18 Safe Torque Off Function│CP2000
18-8
Appendix A. Revision HistoryCP2000
A-1
Appendix A. Revision History CP2000
Updated information
Description Related part
Nameplate information, the decription of RFI jumper, dimensions of the drives
Chapter 1
and the keypad.
The decriptions of unpacking and using the lifting hook and the figure. Chpater 3
The wiring diagrams of all frame sizes, and the wiring of SINK (NPN) /
Chpater 4
SOURCE (PNP) mode.
The wiring diagrams of mair circuit terminals for all frame sizes, the
Chpater 5
descriptions of the main circuit termials.
The specifications of the control terminals and the wiring precautions. Chpater 6
EMC filter model list, the specifications and the assembly of DC reactor, the
model list and the descriptions of zero-phase reactor, the torque value, the Chapter 7
figures, applicable models and assembly/disassembly of fan.
The figures of extension cards, the figures to assembly / disassembly, the
figure to illustrate the positon of the terminating resistor and the extension Chapter 8
cards.
Delete communication card CMC-MOD01, and update the description for
Chapter 8
communication card CMC-EIP01.
The general specifications, the descriptons of environmental characteristics,
Chpater 9
and the derating curve.
Describe the functions which are listed on the MENU. Delete information of
Chapter 10
KPC-CE01.
Update desciptions of the following parameters:
Parameter group 00: 00-00, 00-01, 00-04, 00-11, 00-20, 00-24, 00-25,
00-29
Parameter group 01: 01-02, 01-07, 01-09, 01-11, 01-12–01-21, 01-22,
01-24–01-27, 01-43, 01-44
Parameter group 02: 02-00, 02-01–02-08, 02-13–02-15, 02-18, 02-34,
02-36–02-46, 02-38–02-41, 02-42–02-46, 02-49, 02-50–02-53, 02-70,
02-73
Parameter group 03: 03-00, 03-02, 03-07–03-09, 03-10–03-14, 03-18,
Chapter 11,
03-19, 03-20, 03-22, 03-23, 03-25, 03-30, 03-51–03-61, 03-68
Section 12-1
Parameter group 05: 05-00–05-09, 05-13–05-15, 05-17–05-21,
05-28–05-30, 05-34–05-43. Delete 05-42
Parameter group 06: 06-00–06-04, 06-07, 06-10, 06-14, 06-16–06-22,
06-23–06-26, 06-28, 06-29, 06-44, 06-48, 06-52, 06-55, 06-58–06-60,
06-71, 06-73, 06-80, 06-87. Delete 06-12.
Parameter group 07: 07-01, 07-02, 07-07–07-09, 07-12, 07-13, 07-18,
07-19, 07-23, 07-26, 07-31
Parameter group 08: 08-00–08-02, 08-06, 08-09, 08-20, 08-22
Parameter group 09: 09-04, 09-09, 09-11–09-26, 09-33, 09-39, 09-40,
A-2
Appendix A. Revision HistoryCP2000
Updated information
Description Related part
09-60, 09-72, 09-75
Parameter group 10: 10-32, 10-34, 10-39, 10-40, 10-41, 10-49, 10-52,
Parameter group 12: 12-00, 12-05, 12-08
The descriptions of the adjustment and application for AC drive. Section 12-2
The descriptions of the warning codes Chpater 13
The descriptions of the fault codes Chpater 14
The descriptions of the bit setting for 2060H, 2020H and 2022H.
The descriptions of DO mapping index and DO terminals. And the descriptions Chpater 15
of speed mode, PDO type no. 0.
The function description of Special D Chpater 16
The installation of WPLSoft and the descriptions of program writing. Chpater 16
Delete descriptions of KPC-CE01, CMC-MOD01, D1208, D1228 and torque /
Chapter 16
position / homing control.
A-3